P O R T A B L E
M O B I L E
Q U A D - B A N D
P H O N E
User Manual
Please read this manual before operating your
phone and keep it for future reference.
GH68-37463A Printed in Korea
THE BREACH OF THE EXPRESS WARRANTY, INCLUDING INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, OR LOSS OF ANTICIPATED PROFITS OR BENEFITS.
SAMSUNG IS NOT LIABLE FOR PERFORMANCE ISSUES OR INCOMPATIBILITIES CAUSED BY YOUR EDITING
OF REGISTRY SETTINGS, OR YOUR MODIFICATION OF OPERATING SYSTEM SOFTWARE.
USING CUSTOM OPERATING SYSTEM SOFTWARE MAY CAUSE YOUR DEVICE AND APPLICATIONS TO WORK
IMPROPERLY.
Samsung Telecommunications America (STA), LLC
Headquarters:
1301 E. Lookout Drive
Richardson, TX 75082
Customer Care Center:
1000 Klein Rd.
Plano, TX 75074
Toll Free Tel: 1.888.987.HELP (4357)
Internet Address:
©2012 Samsung Telecommunications America, LLC. Samsung is a registered trademark of Samsung
Electronics Co., Ltd.
Do you have questions about your Samsung Mobile Device?
For 24 hour information and assistance, we offer a new FAQ/ARS System (Automated Response System)
at:
Nuance®, VSuite™, T9® Text Input, and the Nuance logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Nuance Communications, Inc., or its affiliates in the United States and/or other countries.
ACCESS® and NetFront™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of ACCESS Co., Ltd. in Japan and
other countries.
The Bluetooth® word mark, figure mark (stylized “B Design”), and combination mark (Bluetooth word
mark and “B Design”) are registered trademarks and are wholly owned by the Bluetooth SIG.
microSD™ and the microSD logo are Trademarks of the SD Card Association.
Openwave® is a registered Trademark of Openwave, Inc.
Google, the Google logo, Android, the Android logo, Android Market, Gmail, Google Mail, Google Maps,
Google Music, Google Talk, Picasa, YouTube and other marks are trademarks of Google Inc.
Wi-Fi is a registered trademark of the Wireless Fidelity Alliance, Inc.
Swype and the Swype logos are trademarks of Swype, Inc. © 2010 Swype, Inc. All rights reserved.
Dynamic Noise Suppression from Audience
Your phone is equipped with an advanced voice processing chip that delivers clear mobile calls by
suppressing background noise, intermittent sounds (like a siren or nearby conversation), and echoes,
allowing you to hear and be heard nearly anywhere.
How Does It Work?
Based on the intelligence of the human hearing system, the technology:
•
•
•
•
Captures, evaluates and distinguishes all the sound signals surrounding your phone, and the person you're
speaking with.
Then isolates the primary voice in conversation and filters out the background noise - so the person you're calling
hears only your voice, without disturbing background noise.
Dynamically equalizes and adjusts voice volume to optimize your calling experience, so you can hear clearly and
don't need to speak louder to overcome surrounding noise.
The noise suppression technology is built-in and already enabled in your new mobile phone. So it's ready to
provide unsurpassed voice clarity with every call.
Table of Contents
Section 4: Call Functions and
Retrieving your Google Account
Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Section 2: Understanding
Your Phone ......................................20
Contacts List ....................................52
1
Adding more Contacts via Accounts
and Sync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Section 9: Applications and
Development ..................................132
2
Enable Downloading for Web
Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
3
Samsung Mobile Products and
Section 12: Changing Your
Settings ..........................................183
Section 13: Health and Safety
Recycling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility (HAC)
Regulations for Wireless Devices . 230
Restricting Children's Access to
Your Mobile Device . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
End User License Agreement for
Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION TO
Information ....................................213
Exposure to Radio Frequency (RF)
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Specific Absorption Rate (SAR)
Certification Information . . . . . . . . 217
THIRD PARTIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
4
CHAT ROOMS AND OTHER
PUBLIC AREAS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
ACCURACY OF THE INFORMATION WE
COLLECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Social Hub End User License
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
5
Section 1: Getting Started
This section explains how to get started with
your phone by installing and charging the
battery, installing the SIM card and optional
memory card, and setting up your voice mail.
Note: Instructions in this manual are based on
default settings, and may vary from your
phone, depending on the software version
on your phone, and any changes to the
phone’s Settings.
Before using your phone for the first time, you’ll
need to install and charge the battery and install
the SIM card. The SIM card is loaded with your
subscription details, such as your PIN, available
optional services, and many other features. If
desired, you can also install an SD card to store
media for use with your phone.
Unless stated otherwise, instructions in this
User Manual start with the phone unlocked,
at the Home screen.
All screen images in this manual are
simulated. Actual displays may vary,
depending on the software version of your
phone and any changes to the phone’s
Settings.
Understanding this User
Manual
The sections of this manual generally follow the
features of your phone. A robust index for
features begins on page 260.
Special Text
Also included is important safety information that
you should know before using your phone. This
information is available near the back of the
guide, beginning on page 213.
Throughout this manual, you’ll find text that is
set apart from the rest. These are intended to
point out important information, share quick
methods for activating features, to define terms,
and more. The definitions for these methods are
as follows:
This manual provides navigation instructions
according to the default display settings. If you
select other settings, navigation may be
different.
•
Notes: Presents alternative options for the current
feature, menu, or sub-menu.
Unless otherwise specified, all instructions in this
manual assume you are starting from the Home
screen and using the available keys.
•
Tips: Provides quick or innovative methods, or
useful shortcuts.
6
•
•
Important: Points out important information about
the current feature that could affect performance.
Warning: Brings to your attention important
information to prevent loss of data or functionality,
or even prevent damage to your phone.
Battery Cover
The battery, SIM card and SD card are installed
under the battery cover.
Important! Before removing or replacing the
battery cover, make sure the phone is
switched off. To turn the phone off,
Text Conventions
This manual provides condensed information
about how to use your phone. To make this
possible, the following text conventions are used
to represent often-used steps:
hold down the
power-off image displays, then tap
Power off
key until the
.
Caution! Do not bend or twist the back cover
excessively during instllation or removal.
Doing so may damage the cover.
➔
Arrows are used to represent the
sequence of selecting successive
options in longer, or repetitive,
procedures.
To remove the battery cover:
1. Hold the device firmly and locate the cover
release latch.
Example: “From the Home screen, press
Menu Settings Wireless and
network Bluetooth settings
(
)
➔
➔
2. Place your fingernail in the opening (1) and
firmly “pop” the cover off the device
(similar to a soda can) (2).
➔
.
3. Carefully remove the cover (3).
Getting Started
7
Release Latch
To replace the battery cover:
1. Align the cover tabs into their respective
slots along the top of the battery
compartment (1).
2. Carefully slide the cover into the top of the
phone (2).
3. Press down on the back of the battery
cover until you hear a click (3).
4. Squeeze along the edges of the cover to
guarantee a secure fit.
8
To remove the SIM card:
SIM Card Overview
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Carefully place your fingernail into the end
of the SIM slot and push the card slightly
out.
Important! Before removing or replacing the SIM
card, make sure the phone is switched
off. To turn the phone off, hold down
the
key until the power-off
3. Carefully slide the SIM card out of the SIM
card socket.
image displays, then tap Power off
.
The SIM card is loaded with your subscription
details such as your telephone number, PIN,
available optional services, and many other
features.
Note: If the card is not inserted correctly, the
phone will not detect it and no service will
be available. If this happens, turn off the
phone, remove the card, and reinstall the
card in the correct orientation.
Important! The SIM card and its information can
be easily damaged by scratching or
bending, so be careful when handling,
inserting, or removing the card. Keep
all SIM cards out of reach of small
children.
Installing and Removing the SIM card
To install the SIM card:
1. Carefully slide the SIM card into the SIM
card socket until the card clicks into place.
2. Make sure that the card’s gold contacts
face into the phone and that the upper-left
angled corner of the card is positioned as
shown.
Correct
Incorrect
Getting Started
9
Installing the microSD Memory Card
Your phone supports an optional (external)
microSD™ or microSDHC™ memory card for
storage of media such as music, pictures, video
and other files. The SD card is designed for use
with this mobile phone and other devices.
Note: The microSD memory cards include
capacities of up to 2GB.
microSDHC™ memory card types can
range from 4GB to up to 32GB.
Correct
Note: This device supports up to a 32GB
Incorrect
microSDHC memory card.
Removing the microSD Memory Card
1. Remove the battery cover.
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Locate the microSD card slot on the inside
of the device.
2. Firmly press the card into the slot and
release it. The card should pop partially out
of the slot.
3. Orient the card with the gold strips facing
down.
3. Remove the card from the slot.
4. Replace the battery cover.
4. Firmly press the card into the slot and
make sure that it catches with the push-
click insertion. For more information on
Important! Be sure to align the gold contact pins
on the card with the phone’s contacts.
10
Battery
Before using your phone for the first time, install
the battery and charge it fully.
Installing Battery
Important! Before removing or replacing the
battery, make sure the phone is
switched off. To turn the phone off,
hold down the
power-off image displays, then tap
Power off
key until the
.
Installing the Battery
1. Slide the battery into the compartment (1)
so that the tabs on the end align with the
slots at the bottom of the phone, making
sure the connectors align.
2. Gently press down to secure the battery
(2).
Removing Battery
Removing the Battery
ꢀ
Grip the battery at the top end (3) and lift it
up and out of the battery compartment (4).
Charging the Battery
Your phone is powered by a rechargeable Li-ion
battery. A wall charger, which is used for
charging the battery, is included with your
phone. Use only approved batteries and
chargers. Ask your local Samsung dealer for
further details.
Before using your phone for the first time, you
must fully charge the battery. A discharged
battery recharges fully in approximately 4 hours.
Getting Started
11
Note: Verify that the battery is installed prior to
connecting the wall charger. If both the wall
charger is connected and the battery is not
installed, the handset will power cycle
continuously and prevent proper operation.
Failure to unplug the wall charger before
you remove the battery, can cause the
phone to become damaged.
Important! It is recommended you fully charge the
battery before using your device for
the first time.
Correct
1. Locate the Charger/Accessory jack and
slide open the cover (1).
Incorrect
2. Insert the USB cable into the device’s
Charger/Accessory jack (2).
Note: This illustration displays both the correct
and incorrect orientation for connecting the
charger. If the charger is incorrectly
connected, damage to the accessory port
will occur therefore voiding the phone’s
warranty.
3. Plug the charging head into a standard AC
power outlet. The device turns on with the
screen locked and indicates both its
charge state and percent of charge.
4. When charging is finished, first unplug the
charger’s power plug from the AC wall
outlet, then disconnect the charger’s
connector from the phone.
12
•
•
Deactivate the GPS when not needed. Most
applications using this function will periodically
query the GPS satellites for your current location;
each query drains your battery.
Important! If your handset has a touch screen
display, please note that a touch
screen responds best to a light touch
from the pad of your finger or a non-
metallic stylus. Using excessive force
or a metallic object when pressing on
the touch screen may damage the
tempered glass surface and void the
warranty. For more information, refer
Do not wait until your battery is completely depleted
before charging your device. Repeating this process
of a complete discharge and recharge can over time
reduce the storage capacity of any battery.
Turn off Automatic application sync.
•
•
Use the Power Savings Widget to deactivate
hardware functions such as Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, GPS,
Synchronization, or LCD brightness setting.
Check the Battery use screen to review what
features or functions have been consuming your
battery resources.
Low Battery Indicator
•
When the battery level is low and only a few
minutes of talk time remain, a warning tone
sounds and the “Low battery” message repeats
at regular intervals on the display. In this
condition, your phone conserves its remaining
battery power, by dimming the backlight.
•
•
Check the Running Services and close any
unnecessary applications.
Use the Task Manager feature to end/shutdown
background applications that are still running.
These minimized applications can, over time, cause
your device to “slow down”.
When the battery level becomes too low, the
phone automatically turns off.
Extending Your Battery Life
Active applications, light levels, Bluetooth usage,
and GPS functionality all act to drain your
battery. The following is a list of helpful tips that
can help conserve your battery power:
•
•
Turn off any streaming services after use (see
Running Services).
Animated wallpapers use processing power,
memory, and more power. Change your Live
Wallpaper to a non-animated Wallpaper gallery or
Gallery image.
•
•
•
Reduce your backlight on time.
Turn Bluetooth off when not in use.
Turn Wi-Fi off when not in use.
Getting Started
13
Power Savings
Note: A green bar displayed beneath the icon
means the application is active (turned on).
The green bar is removed from beneath the
icon when the feature is deactivated (turned
off).
Active applications, Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, GPS,
Synchronization, Location consent, or the LCD
Brightness functionality all act to drain your
battery.
The Power Savings application was designed to
quickly activate (turn on), or deactivate (turn off)
those functions or applications that use the most
battery power.
1. From the
Home screen,
touch and
Initial Phone Configuration
1. Tap the on-screen Android icon to begin
the setup process.
2. Tap Skip to ignore the Wi-Fi connection
setup process.
3. Select/deselect the desired Google location
hold an empty
area until the
Add to Home
screen menu
displays.
services and tap Next
4. Configure the Data and Time settings and
tap Next
.
.
Note: Enabling Google location services can drain
battery power. For more information, refer
2. Tap Widgets
➔
Power
savings. The
Power Control
5. Press and hold
until the Phone
shortcut is
options screen appears.
added to the current screen.
3. Tap any of the icons on the Power Savings
shortcut bar to activate/deactivate the
feature.
6. Tap Power off
(
).
14
Switching the Phone On or Off
If you have not already configured your phone
after an initial firmware update, you will be
prompted with a series of configuration screens.
Locking and Unlocking the
Phone
By default, the phone screen locks when the
backlight turns off.
Once the phone has been configured, you will
not be prompted with these screens again.
ꢀ
Place your finger on the screen and swipe
the glass in any of the directions shown
unlock the phone.
Important! Before the initial configuration, you
quickly access emergency services by
tapping Emergency call and using the
on-screen dialer.
1. Press and hold
until the phone
switches on.
The phone searches for your network and
after finding it, you can make or receive
calls.
Note: The display language is preset to English at
the factory. To change the language, use the
Language menu. For more information,
2. Press and hold
until the Phone
options screen appears.
3. Tap Power Off
(
).
Getting Started
15
Note: You can choose to configure lock settings to
prevent unauthorized use of your phone. For
Note: If you already have a Google account, you
only need to sign in.
To create a new Google Account from the Web:
1. From a computer, launch a Web browser
Creating a New Google
Account
and navigate to www.google.com
.
2. On the main page, click Sign-in
➔
Create
You should create a Google™ Account when you
first use your device in order to fully utilize the
functionality. This account provides access to
several device features such as Gmail, Google
Maps, Google Search, and the Android Market
applications. Before you are able to access
Google applications, you must enter your
account information. These applications sync
between your device and your online Google
account.
an account now
.
3. Follow the on-screen prompts to create
your free account.
4. Look for an email from Google in the email
box you provided, and respond to the email
to confirm and activate your new account.
Signing into Your Google
Account
1. Launch an application that requires a
Google account (such as Android Market or
Gmail).
To create a new Google Account from your phone:
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Market).
2. Read the introduction and tap Next
➔
2. Click Next
➔
Sign in.
Create to begin.
3. Tap the Username and Password fields and
enter your information.
3. Follow the on-screen instructions to create
a Google Account.
– or –
4. Tap Sign in. Your device communicates
with the Google servers to confirm your
information.
If this is not the first time you are starting
the phone, tap
➔
(Gmail).
5. If prompted, create a new Gmail username
by entering a prefix for your @gmail.com
email address.
16
Retrieving your Google
Account Password
Note: Voicemail setup may be different depending
on your network.
A Google account password is required for
Google applications. If you misplace or forget
your Google Account password, follow these
instructions to retrieve it:
1. From your computer, use an Internet
browser and navigate to http://google.com/
1. From the Home screen, tap
and then
touch and hold the
key until the
1
phone dials voice mail. You may be
prompted to enter a password.
2. Follow the tutorial to create a password, a
greeting, and a display name.
2. Click on the Can’t access your account?
link.
Accessing Your Voice Mail
You can access your Voice Mail by either
3. Enter your full Gmail address and click
Submit. Follow the password recovery
procedure.
pressing and holding
on the keypad, or by
1
using the phone’s Application icon, then touching
the Voice Mail application.
Voice Mail
To access Voice Mail using the menu:
1. From the Home screen, tap
and then
Setting Up Your Voice Mail
touch and hold
voice mail.
until the phone dials
1
Your device automatically transfers all
unanswered calls to voicemail, even if your
device is in use or turned off. As soon as your
battery is charged and the SIM card inserted,
activate your voicemail account.
1
Note: Touching and holding
will launch
Visual voicemail if it is already active on
your phone.
Important! Always use a password to protect
2. When connected, follow the voice prompts
against unauthorized access.
from the voice mail center.
For new users, follow the instructions below to
set up voice mail:
Getting Started
17
Accessing Your Voice Mail From
Another Phone
1. Dial your wireless phone number.
2. When you hear your voicemail greeting,
press the asterisk key on the phone you
are using.
Task Manager
Your phone can run applications simultaneously,
with some applications running in the
background.
Sometimes your device might seem to slow
down over time, and the biggest reason for this
are background applications. These are
applications that were not properly closed or
shutdown and are still active but minimized. The
Task Manager not only lets you see which of
these applications are still active in the
background but also easily lets you choose
which applications are left running and which
are closed.
3. Enter your passcode.
Visual Voicemail
Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of
people who left a voicemail message, and listen
to the any message they want without being
limited to chronological order.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔ Visual Voicemail
(
).
Note: The larger the number of applications
running on your phone, the larger the
energy drain on your battery.
2. Read the on-screen information and tap
Next.
3. Enter your new PIN code and tap Next to
activate Visual Voicemail if this is the first
time it was accessed. A list of the
voicemail messages displays.
Task Manger Overview
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
(Applications) ➔ Task manager
(
).
– or –
Note: You must subscribe to Visual Voicemail
service to use this feature. Charges may
apply. Please contact your service provider
for further details.
Press and hold
manager. This screen contains the
following tabs:
then tap Task
• Active applications display those currently
active applications running on your phone.
4. Tap an on-screen voicemail message to
play it back.
18
• Downloaded displays any installed packages or
applications from the Market that are taking up
memory space. Tap Uninstall to remove them
from your phone.
• RAM, which displays the amount of current RAM
(Random Access Memory) currently being used
and allow you to Clear Memory for either Level
1 or Level 2 (both Level memory locations).
• Storage displays a visual graph indicating the
available and used space within the Random
Access Memory (RAM), Program, and External
SD card.
• Help provides additional battery saving
techniques.
Shutting Down an Currently Active
Application
1. From the Home screen, tap
manager ).
➔Task
(
2. From the Active applications tab, tap Exit to
close selected applications or tap Exit all to
close all background running applications.
Getting Started
19
Section 2: Understanding Your Phone
®
This section outlines key features of your phone.
It also describes the phone’s keys, screen and
the icons that display when the phone is in use.
•
•
•
Pre-loaded Games including Bejeweled 2 and
®
Tetris
Over 250,000 Apps available to download from the
Android Market™
Features of Your Phone
®
Your phone is lightweight, easy-to-use and offers
many significant features. The following list
outlines a few of the features included in your
phone.
Pre-loaded e-reader applications such as: Blio and
®
Zinio
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Social Networking capabilities
®
Polaris Office for document viewing and editing
•
Touch screen with virtual (on-screen) QWERTY
keyboard
Assisted GPS (TeleNav GPS Navigation)
Webkit-based browser
•
High Speed Packet Access Plus (HSPA+) delivering
data speeds faster than the current 3G network
technology.
Downloadable applications from Android Market
Up to 32GB expandable memory slot
Front Facing camera for Video Chat
Mobile Hotspot Capability
•
•
•
•
•
•
Android 2.3, Gingerbread Platform
®
®
Compatible with Adobe Flash technology
®
®
Lookout Anti-Virus (Security, Backup, Missing
Wi-Fi Capability
Device capabilities)
USB Tethering-capable
®
•
•
•
T-Mobile TV HD
Bluetooth enabled
®
Slacker Radio
Full Integration of Google Mobile™ Services (Gmail,
YouTube, Google Maps, Google Voice Search)
Multiple Messaging Options: Text/Picture/Video
Messaging, Google Talk, and SWYPE™
Corporate and Personal Email
Wi-Fi Calling
•
•
•
3 Megapixel Camera and Camcorder with autofocus
and multi-shot
•
MP3 Player with multitasking features
20
•
While talking on the phone, the sensor detects
talk activity and locks the keypad to prevent
accidental key presses.
Front View
The following illustrations show the main
elements of your phone:
2. microSD Card Slot (internal) allows you use
a microSD card to expand the memory of
your phone.
14
13 12
1
11
10
9
3.
Volume key allows you to adjust the ringer
volume in standby mode (with the phone
open) or adjust the voice volume during a
2
3
When receiving an incoming call:
call.
•
Pressing the volume key down mutes the ring
tone.
•
Pressing and holding the volume key rejects the
call.
4. Menu key displays a list of options
available for the current screen. From the
Home screen it displays Add, Wallpaper,
Search, Notifications, Edit, and Settings
options.
8
7
4
5. Home key displays the Home screen when
pressed. Touch and hold to display the
Task manager.
5
6
The following list correlates to the illustrations.
1. Proximity Sensor detects how close an
object is to the surface of the screen. This
is typically used to detect when your face
is pressed up against the screen, such as
during a phone call.
6.
during phone calls and
Microphone is used
allows other callers to hear you clearly
when you are speaking to them. It is also
used to make voice note recordings.
Understanding Your Phone
21
7. Quick search is used to search the device
for applications, contact information, or
searches the internet for information.
8. Back key redisplays the previous screen or
clears entries.
13. Receiver allows you to hear the other caller
and the different ring tones or sounds
offered by your phone.
14. Headset jack allows you to connect a
hands-free headset so you can listen to
music.
9. Display shows all the information needed
to operate your phone, such as the
connection status, received signal
strength, phone battery level, and time.
10. Power/Reset/Lock key turns the device off
(press and hold). Resets the device if it
ever freezes (press and hold for
Back View of Your Phone
The following illustration shows the external
elements of your phone:
15-17 seconds). Access the Phone options
menu (press and hold) to turn on/off Silent
mode, Flight mode, or power off the
device.
11. Front Facing Camera allows you to take
pictures while facing the screen and
allows you to video conference.
1
2
3
1. External speaker allows you to hear
Note: Video recorded in Portrait mode is reversed
ringers, music, and other sounds offered
by your phone.
during playback.
2. Flash is used to take photos in lo-light
conditions.
12. USB Power/Accessory connector allows you
to connect a power cable or optional
3. Camera lens is used to take photos.
accessories such as a USB/data cable.
22
Display settings
Phone Display
In this menu, you can change various settings for
the for the wallpaper, cube, brightness or
backlight.
Your phone’s display provides information about
the phone’s status, and is the interface to the
features of your phone. The display indicates
your connection status, signal strength, battery
status and time. Icons display at the top of the
phone when an incoming call or message is
received and also alerts you at a specified time
when an alarm was set.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Settings) ➔
(
(
Status Bar
The screen also displays notifications, and
Application (or shortcut) bar with four icons:
Phone, Contacts, Messaging, and Applications.
The Status Bar shows information about the
connection status, signal strength, phone battery
level, and time, and displays notifications about
incoming messages, calls and other actions.
Signal strength
Battery status
Connection Status
This list identifies the icons you see on your
phone’s display screen:
Status Bar
Indicator Icons
This list identifies the symbols you’ll see on your
Time
Google
Search
phone’s display and Indicator area:
Notification
area
Displays your current signal strength.
The greater the number of bars, the
stronger the signal.
Status
area
Home
Screen
Shortcuts
IndicatesthattheFlightModeisactive.
You cannot send or receive any calls or
access online information.
Indicates there is no signal available.
Primary Shortcuts
Understanding Your Phone
23
Displays when there is no SIM card in
the phone.
Displays your current battery charge
level. Icon shown is fully charged.
Displays when there is a system error
or alert.
Displays your current battery is 100
percent charged. This icon is followed
by an audible beep.
100%
Displays when a call is in progress.
Displays your battery is currently
charging.
Displays when a call is on hold.
Displays your current battery charge
level is very low.
Displays when you have missed an
incoming call.
Shows your current battery only has
threepercentpowerremainingandwill
immediately shutdown. Represented
as a blinking icon.
Displays when the Auto reject mode
feature is enabled and set to All
numbers.
A
Displays when connected to the EDGE
network.
Displayswhenyouhavereceivedacall
from an unknown caller and the T-
Mobile Name ID service is asking to
name the contact.
Displays when your phone is
communicating with the EDGE
network.
Displayswhenthespeakerphoneison.
Displays when connected to the 3G
network.
Displays when the microphone is
muted.
Displays when your phone is
communicating with the 3G network.
DisplayswhenconnectedtotheHSPA+
network.
Displays whenCall forwarding is set to
Displays when your phone is
communicating with the HSPA+
network.
24
Displays when the phone is connected
to a computer using a supported USB
cable connection.
Displays when the phone is in Silent
mode.
Allsoundsexceptmediaandalarmsare
silenced,andVibratemodeissettoOnly
Displays when there is a new text
message.
when not in silent mode
.
Displays when an outgoing text
message has failed to be delivered.
Displays when the Sound profile is set
to Silent mode and Vibrate is set to
Always or Only in silent mode.
Displayswhenthereisanewvoicemail
message.
Displays when there is a new visual
voicemail message.
Displays when data synchronization
and application sync is active and
synchronization is in progress
Displays in the notifications window
when there is a new Email message.
for Gmail, Calendar, and Contacts.
DisplayswhenBluetoothtechnologyis
active and enabled.
Displays in the notifications window
when there is a new Gmail message.
Displays when the Bluetooth
technology is active and
communicating with an external
device.
Displays when the time and date for a
Calendar Event has arrived. For more
Displays when the an outbound file
transfer is in progress.
Displays when an alarm is set.
Displays when Wi-Fi is connected,
active, and communicating with a
Wireless Access Point (WAP).
DisplayswhenWi-Fiisactiveandthere
is an available open wireless network.
Understanding Your Phone
25
DisplayswhentheWi-Ficallingfeature
is active.
Displays when the external SD card
(internal microSD) has been
disconnected (unmounted) from the
phone and is now ready for either
removal or formatting.
DisplayswhentheWi-Ficallingfeature
is in use and a call is currently active.
Displays when the Portable Wi-Fi
Hotspot feature is active and
Displays when the contents of the
microSD card are being scanned.
Displays when the External SD card is
being prepared for mounting to the
device. This is required for
communication with the External SD
card.
Displays when the USB Tethering
feature is active and communicating.
Displays when the phone’s microSD
card has been improperly removed.
Displays when your phone is
connected to a PC using Kies air.
Displayswhenthe phonehasdetected
an active USB connection and is in a
USB Debugging mode.
Displays when your phone is
connected to a Digital Living Network
Alliance (DLNA) certified device using
the AllShare application.
Displays when Power saving mode is
enabled.
Displays in the notifications window
when a song is currently playing.
Displays when the Power saving alert
notificationhasbeenactivated.Youare
then prompted to view your current
battery level.
Displays when your phone’s GPS is on
and communicating.
For more details on configuring your phone’s
26
Clearing Notifications
Notification Bar
1. Tap the status bar to reveal the
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to
the bottom of the screen to open the
Notifications panel
The Notification area indicates new message
events (data sync status, new messages,
calendar events, call status, etc). You can expand
this area to provide more detailed information
about the current on-screen notification icons.
1. Tap the Status bar to reveal the
2. Tap Clear. The notifications are cleared
from the panel.
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to
the bottom of the screen to open the
Notifications panel (1).
Accessing Additional Panel Functions
In addition to notifications, this panel also
provides quick and ready access to five device
functions. These can be quickly activated or
deactivated.
2. Tap a notification entry to open the
associated application (2).
The following functions can either be activated
(green) or deactivated (white): Wi-Fi
,
BT
(Bluetooth), GPS Silent mode, or Auto rotation
,
.
Note: The Notifications panel can also be opened
on the Home screen by pressing
then tapping Notifications
and
.
Understanding Your Phone
27
•
Wallpaper
(
) lets you to customize the current
Note: Vibration mode is available after pressing
the Volume key down.
screen’s wallpaper image by choosing from either
Gallery, Live Wallpaper or Wallpaper gallery).
Silent mode (no vibration) is only available if
–
You can obtain images from either your Pictures
folder, from any of the available images within the
device’s Wallpaper gallery, or from the animated
Live Wallpapers.
the Vibration setting (Settings
settings Vibration) is set to Only when not
in Silent mode
>
Sound
>
.
•
•
Search
you can use to search for a key term online.
Notifications ) allows you to expand popup
notifications area to provide more detailed
information about the current on-screen notification
icons.
(
) displays the Google Search box that
Function Keys
Your phone comes equipped with four main
function keys that can be used on any screen:
(
Home Menu, Back and Search.
,
Home Key
The Home key (
) takes you back to your
•
•
Edit
(
) allows you to add or remove extended
Home screen (#4 of the 7 available screens).
screens from your device. You can have up to six
extended screens (one Home screen and six
Extended screens).
ꢀ
Press and hold to launch the Recent apps/
Task manager screen. For more
Settings
device’s settings menu.
The Settings menu can also be accessed by
pressing and then tapping
Settings
(
) provides quick access to the
Menu Key
The Menu key (
–
) activates an available menu
➔
function for the current screen or application.
When on the Home screen, the following menu
options are available:
.
Back Key
The Back key (
active screen. If the on-screen keyboard is
currently open, this key closes the keyboard.
) returns you to the previously
•
Add
(
) adds one of the following functions to a
selected screen: Widgets, Shortcuts, Folders, and
Wallpapers.
28
•
Notification area displays those icons associated
with end-user notifications such as: email
messages, calls (missed, call in progress), new
voicemail, upcoming event, USB connection, emails,
and Text/MMS messages.
Search Key
The Search key (
Search box that can be used to search for a key
term online.
) displays the Google
Home Screen
–
These notifications appear at the top-left of the
screen (within the Status bar area) and display
important user information.
The Home screen is the starting point for using
the applications on your phone. There are initially
five available panels, each populated with
default shortcuts or applications. You can
customize each of these panels.
–
This information can be accessed by either
accessing the Notifications panel [
Notifications )].
>
Signal strength
(
Connection Status
Status Bar
Battery status
•
Status area displays those icons associated with
the status of the device such as communication,
coverage, Bluetooth, 4G/3G, Wi-Fi communication,
battery levels, GPS, etc.
Time
Google
Search
•
•
Home Screen is a customizable screen that
provides information about notifications and device
status, and allows access to application Widgets.
Extended Home Screens extend beyond the
current visible screen width to provide more space
for adding icons, widgets, and other customization
features.
Notification
area
Status
area
Home
Screen
Shortcuts
–
There are six available extended screens (panels)
each of which may be populated with its own
shortcuts or widgets. These screens share the
use of the three Primary Shortcuts.
Primary Shortcuts
Understanding Your Phone
29
–
The current screen is indicated at the bottom by a
larger circle. Up to seven (7) total screens are
available.
•
Primary Shortcuts: are four shortcuts present
throughout all of the available screens and can be
used to both navigate within the device or launch
any of the following functions:
Note: Both the status bar and primary shortcuts
–
Phone
functions (Keypad, Logs, Favorites, and Groups).
Contacts ) launches the Contacts-related
(
) launches the phone-related screen
are visible across all screens.
–
(
•
Google search is an on-screen Internet search
engine powered by Google™. Touch to access the
Voice Search feature where you can verbally enter a
search term and initiate an online search.
screens (Keypad, Logs, Contacts, Favorites, and
Groups).
–
–
Messaging
(
) launches the Messaging
–
Tap Voice Search
(
) to launch the Voice
menu (create new messages or open an existing
message string).
Search function from within this Google widget.
•
•
Widgets are self-contained on-screen applications
(not shortcuts). These can be placed onto any of the
available screens (Home or extended).
Applications/Home toggles functionality
between the Home and Application screens.
•
•
Tap
(Applications) to access the
Shortcuts are icons that launch available device
applications such as Camera, YouTube, Voicemail,
Contacts, Phone, Email, Market, etc. These function
the same as shortcuts on your computer.
Application screens loaded with every available
local application.
While in the Applications screens, tap
–
Although some may already be found on the
Extended Home screens, the majority can also be
found within the Applications screens.
(
Home) to easily return to the Home screen.
As you transition from screen to screen, the
screen counter (located at the bottom) displays
the current panel number in a circle.
–
The Application screens can be accessed by
tapping
(Applications) from the Primary
shortcuts area.
–
Shortcuts can be removed from a screen and
added back any number of times.
30
Navigating Through the Screens
The following terms describe the most common
hardware and on-screen actions.
Press and hold
Tap
Touch and hold
Widget
Counter displays
the currently
active screen
•
•
Press and hold: Pressing relates to use of the
hardware keys and buttons to select or activate an
item. For example: press the Navigation key to scroll
through a menu. Some buttons and keys require you
to press and hold them to activate a feature, for
example, you press the Lock key to lock and unlock
the phone.
Screen Navigation
Using the touch screen display and the keys, you
can navigate the features of your phone and
enter characters. The following conventions are
used in this manual to describe the navigation
action in the procedures.
Tap: Use a brief touch to select items on the display
or to enter text on the virtual QWERTY keyboard. For
example: touch an Application icon to open the
application. A light touch works best.
Understanding Your Phone
31
•
•
•
Touch and hold: Touch and hold an icon or key to
open the available options, or to access a pop-up
menu. For example: press and hold from the Home
screen to access a menu of customization options.
Flick: Move your finger in lighter, quicker strokes
than swiping. This finger gesture is always used in a
vertical motion, such as when flicking through
contacts or a message list.
Flick
Swipe or slide and Drag
Swipe or slide: Quickly drag your finger vertically
or horizontally across the screen. This allows you to
move the area of focus or to scroll through a list. For
example: slide your finger left or right on the Home
screen to scroll among the seven panels.
Drag: Press and hold your finger with some
pressure before you start to move it. Do not release
your finger until you have reached the target
position.
•
•
Rotate
Rotate: Automatically change the screen orientation
from portrait to landscape by turning the device
sideways. For example: rotate to landscape
orientation when entering text, to provide a larger
keyboard, or when viewing web content to minimize
scrolling.
•
Pinch: “Pinch” the screen using your thumb and
forefinger to zoom out when viewing a picture or a
Web page. (Move fingers inward to zoom out.)
32
•
Spread: “Spread” the screen using your thumb and
forefinger to zoom in when viewing a picture or a
Web page. (Move fingers outward to zoom in.)
Note: Motion must be enabled for this feature to
Pinch (Zoom Out)
Menu Navigation
You can tailor the phone’s range of functions to
fit your needs using both menus and
applications. Menus, sub-menus, and features
are accessed by scrolling through the available
on-screen menus. Your phone defaults with
seven home screens.
Navigating Through the Application
Menus
There are four default Application Menus
available. As you add more applications from the
Android Marketplace, more screens are created
to house these new apps.
Spread (Zoom In)
1. Press
Applications). The first Application Menu
displays.
To close the Applications screen, tap
press
and then tap
Note: These screens can be re-arranged in any
desired order. For more information, refer to
(
•
or
.
•
Motion Navigation and Activation: The phone
comes equipped with the ability to assign specific
functions to certain phone actions that are detected
by the accelerometer.
2. Sweep the screen to access the other
menus.
3. Tap any of the on-screen icons to launch
the associated application.
Understanding Your Phone
33
Using Sub-Menus
Sub-menus are available from within most
screen and applications.
1. Press
. A sub-menu displays at the
bottom of the phone screen.
2. Tap an option.
Context Menu
Sub-Menu items
Accessing Recently-Used
Applications
1. Press and hold
to open the recently-
used applications window.
Note: This recent applications screen also
provides access to the Task manager
.
Using Context Menus
2. A pop-up displays the six most recently
used applications.
Context menus (also called pop-up menus)
contain options that apply to a specific item on
the screen. They function similarly to menu
options that appear when you right click your
mouse on your desktop computer.
3. Tap an icon to open the recent application.
ꢀ
Touch and hold an item on-screen to open
its context menu.
34
Applications
Accounts and sync
The Application menu provides quick access to
the most frequently used applications.
Applications display on each of the four panels
on the Applications screens.
Allows you to add applications and
determine which type of account
information you want to synchronize
with your Contact list. For more
Note: Some applications might be updated after
connection. This would require a user to
follow the on-screen instructions to update
the related application icon and features.
AllShare
Allowsyoutoshareyouron-devicemedia
contentwith otherexternal devices using
DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance)
and built-in AllShare™ technology.
Samsung’s AllShare makes staying
connected easy.
The following table contains a description of
each application available via both the Primary
shortcuts area and via the Applications screens.
If the application is already described in another
section of this user manual, then a cross
reference to that particular section is provided.
For information on navigating through the
Applications icons, see “Navigating Through the
Application Menus” on page 33
Bejeweled 2
Bejeweled 2 is a free web-based game,
sequeltoBejeweled.Startbyclickingtwo
adjacentpiecestocreatealineofthreeor
more identical gems. For more
411 & More
Providesmorethanjustsingletapaccess
to directory assistance and other portals.
Available categories include: 411
Directory Assistance, Current Weather,
and more.
Understanding Your Phone
35
Blio®
Calendar
Blio is an eReading application that
presents eBooks just like the printed
version, in full color, and with all of the
features you’d want from an eReader.
Launches a calendar application that
syncs to your Facebook™, Google™, or
Microsoft Exchange work calendars.
Camera
Bonus Apps
Launches the built-in 3.0 megapixel
camera application from where you can
take a picture with either the front or rear
facing cameras.
Once added to your Home screen, this
Widget helps you discover free T-Mobile
services and apps that are compatible
with your phone.
Note: An SD card must be inserted
before the camera will take and
store photos.
Books
Use Google Books to read over 3 million
ebooks on the go.
In addition to taking photos, the built-in
cameraalso doublesasacamcorder that
also allows you to record, view, and send
high definition videos.
Calculator
Launches the on-screen calculator
application. The calculator provides the
basic arithmetic functions; addition,
subtraction, multiplication, and division.
You can also use this as a scientific
calculator.
36
Contacts
Files
The default storage location for saving
phone numbers to your Contacts List is
your phone’s built-in memory.
Lets you view supported image files and
text files on your microSD card. Organize
and store data, images, and more in your
own personal file folders. Files are stored
to the memory card in separate (user
defined) folders.
Clock
Allows you to set an alarm, configure and
viewtheWorldclock, useastopwatch, or
set a timer. The applications display in a
tabularformatandquicklyaccessedwith
the touch of a finger.
Gallery
Displays a Gallery of camera images and
video stored in the microSD card. For
Gmail
Downloads
Provides access to your Gmail account.
GoogleMail(Gmail)isaweb-basedemail
service. Gmail is configured when you
first set up your phone. For more
Provides quick access to tabs containing
a list of your current downloaded files
(Internet and Other).
Email
Google Search
Provides access to both your Outlook
(ExchangeServer-based)workemailand
Internet email accounts (such as Gmail
and Yahoo! Mail). For more information,
Provides an on-screen Internet search
engine powered by Google™.
Understanding Your Phone
37
Highlight
Latitude
This downloadable application/widget
allows you to stay up to date on relevant
news, Android Market apps and games
(specific to your phone), T-Mobile
ringtones, CallerTunes and more. For
Lets you see your friends’ locations and
share yours with them. The application
alsoletsyouseeyourfriends’locationson
a map or in a list. It also lets you send
instant messages and emails, make
phone calls, and get directions to your
friends’ locations.
Kies air
Allows you to sync your Windows PC
wirelessly with your phone (as long as
both are on the same Wi-Fi network). You
can now have real-time access of your
phone through your PC to view call logs,
videos,
photos, bookmarks, IMs, and even send
SMS messages directly from your home
computer.
Lookout Anti-Virus
Lookout™ Anti-Virus application
provides mobile device-specific security
features that are coupled with a minimal
performance hit. For more information,
Maps
Launches a Web-based dynamic map
that helps you find local businesses,
locate friends, view maps and get driving
directions. For more information, refer to
38
Market
Mini Diary
Allows you to find and download free and
for-purchase applications on Android
Allows you to create a mini diary where
you can add a photo, and text to describe
an event or other memorable life event.
Media Hub
More for Me
Provides you with a one stop shop for the
hottest movie and TV content. You can
now rent or purchase your favorite
content and then watch it from the
convenience of anywhere. For more
Provides customized offers, discounts
and deals right to your phone. For more
Music
Launches the built-in Music Player that
allows you to play music files that you
have stored on your microSD card. You
can also create playlists. For more
Memo
Creates new text memos. For more
Messaging
My Account
Provides access to text and multimedia
messaging (SMS and MMS). For more
Provides you with account specific
information such as: current status,
Activity, Set Alerts, Bill Summary, Plan
Services, and FAQ’s Info. For more
Understanding Your Phone
39
My Device
Places
Allows you to configure device settings,
view Personalize your CallerTunes,
Ringtones, or Wallpapers, View Quick
Tools, Support, and battery storage
information. For more information, refer
Displays company logos on a layer of
Google Maps. When viewing an area you
can quickly locate a business or person,
find out more information about the
business,seecoupons,publicresponses,
and more. For more information, refer to
Navigation
Polaris Office
Launches a Web-based navigation
application.
Polaris Office® Mobile for Android is a
Microsoft Office compatible office suite.
This application provides a central place
for managing your documents online or
offline.
Caution! Traffic data is not real-time
and directions may be wrong,
dangerous, prohibited, or
involve ferries.
Settings
Accesses the device’s built-in Settings
News & Weather
Launches a Web-based news and
weather feed based on your current
Slacker
Slacker® offers free, internet radio for
mobile phones.
40
Social Hub
Talk
Allows you to easily and intuitively satisfy
all of your communication needs from
within a single-user interface. E-mails,
instant messaging, social network
contents, and calendar contents from all
Launches a Web-based Google Talk
application that lets you chat with family
and friends over the Internet for free. For
Task
Allows you to keep track of both your
currentandupcomingtasks.Youcanalso
sync these tasks with different accounts.
T-Mobile Mall
This downloadable application provides
access to several phone features and
Task Manager
Use Task Manager to see which
applications are running on your phone,
andtoendrunningapplicationstoextend
battery life.
T-Mobile Name ID
Allowsyoutomodifytheon-screenCaller
ID information.
T-Mobile TV HD
Allows you to watch live mobile HD TV on
your phone.
TeleNav GPS
Thisapplicationisasubscriptionservice.
Thisdrivingaidprovidesbothaudibleand
visual navigation instructions for GPS
Understanding Your Phone
41
Tetris
Voice Recorder
Tetris® is a puzzle video game in which
falling tetrominoes must be manipulated
to form complete lines, which are then
cleared from the grid. For more
Allowsyoutorecordanaudiofileuptoone
minutelongandthenimmediatelysendit
Voice Search
Video Chat
Launches your phone’s built-in voice
recognition software and initiates a
Google search based on the recognized
Allowsyoutorecordandsharelivevideos
on your device with your friends, family,
and your favorite social networks. For
Web
Videos
Openthebrowsertostartsurfingtheweb.
Thebrowserisfullyoptimizedandcomes
with advanced functionality to enhance
the Internet browsing feature on your
phone.
Launches your device’s built-in video
applicationthatplaysvideofilesstoredon
your microSD card.
Visual Voicemail
Visual Voicemail enables users to view a
list of people who left a voicemail
message, and listen to the any message
they want without being limited to
chronological order.
Wi-Fi Calling
Provides the ability to use your available
Wi-Fi data connection to make outbound
calls that count against your phone
minutes. Similar to VOIP (Voice Over IP).
42
Customizing the Screens
Yelp
You can customize the Home screens (panels) to
display the Widgets, Shortcuts, Folders, or
Wallpapers. For example, one screen could
contain the Music Player shortcut and other
forms of media, while another screen might
contain communication apps such as Gmail.
Launches the Yelp application that
provides access to an online urban city
guidethathelpspeoplefindcoolplacesto
eat, shop, drink, relaxandplay. Itsthefun
and easy way to find, review and talk
You can customize your Home screen by doing
the following:
YouTube
•
•
•
•
•
Adding, Deleting, and Rearranging screens
Adding and Removing Shortcuts
Adding and Removing Widgets
Creating Folders
Launches the YouTube webpage via the
browser.
Zinio Reader
Changing the Background (Wallpapers)
Launches a digital magazine reader.
Zinio®hastransformedyourfavoriteprint
magazines into digital format. For more
Adding and Deleting Screens
Your phone comes with seven screens. You can
delete these screens and then add them back
later.
Note: These screens can be deleted and
re-arranged.
Important! Your phone can only contain at most
seven screens and at least one screen.
Understanding Your Phone
43
To delete a screen:
1. Press
Rearranging the Screens
1. Press and then tap
Edit).
➔
➔
and
(
then tap
2. Touch and hold a screen and then drag it
into its new location. Upper-left is screen
position #1 and bottom-right is screen last
screen.
(Edit).
2. Touch and
hold, then
drag the
Adding and Removing Primary
Shortcuts
undesired
screen
down to the
Remove tab
The device comes with four Primary shortcuts:
Phone, Contacts, Messaging, and Applications/
Home. As long as the menu is displayed in a
Customizable grid, you can replace the Phone,
Contacts, and Messaging shortcuts with other
applications so you access the shortcuts that are
most frequently used.
(
).
3. Press
to return to the main Home screen.
To add a screen:
1. Press
Edit).
2. Tap the Add icon (
1. Press
and then tap
➔
and then tap
(Applications).
(
2. Press
and then tap View Type
➔
). The newly added
Customizable grid
.
screen appears as the last page.
3. Press to return to the main Home
screen.
3. Press
and then tap Edit
➔
OK. The
application pages then appear at the top of
the screen, the primary shortcuts appear
at the bottom, and you have the option to
also generate a new folder or page to
house these application shortcuts.
4. Scroll through the application pages at the
top and locate the desired application.
44
5. Touch and hold the on-screen icon, then
drag it over one of the four primary
shortcuts to replace it.
To add a shortcut from the Applications screen:
1. Press
to go to the
Home
screen.
•
The new primary shortcut displays at the bottom
of the screen. The previous primary shortcuts
switches places with your selected icon.
2. Select a
location
6. Press
and then tap Save
.
(screen) for
your new
shortcut by
scrolling
across your
available
screens
7. Tap
to return to the Home screen.
Managing Shortcuts
Note: To move a shortcut from one screen to
another, you must carefully touch and hold
the shortcut and slowly drag it to the edge
of the screen. As the shortcut turns light
blue, you can begin to move it to the
adjacent screen.
until you reach the desired one.
3. Tap Applications
(
) to reveal all your
If this does not work, delete it from its
current screen. Activate the new screen and
then add the selected shortcut.
current available applications. By default,
applications are displayed as an
Alphabetical grid.
4. Scroll across the screens and locate your
desired application.
Understanding Your Phone
45
5. Touch and hold the on-screen icon. The
new shortcut then appears to hover over
the current screen.
2. Touch and hold the desired shortcut. This
unlocks it from its location on the current
screen.
6. While still holding the on-screen icon,
position it on the current screen. Once
complete, release the screen to lock the
shortcut into its new position.
3. Drag the shortcut over the Remove tab
(
) and release.
Adding and Removing Widgets
Widgets are self-contained applications that can
be placed on any screen. Unlike shortcuts,
widgets appear as applications.
To add a shortcut via the Add to Home screen:
1. Press
to go to the
To add a Widget:
Home
1. Press
screen.
to go to the
2. Navigate to
Home
a screen
screen.
with an
2. Navigate to
empty area.
a screen
3. Touch and
with an
hold an
empty area.
empty area
3. Touch and
of the
hold an
screen.
empty area
4. From the Add to Home screen window tap
of the
Shortcuts
.
screen.
5. Scroll up or down the list and tap a
4. From the Add to Home screen window tap
Widgets. The available widgets appear
within a scrollable area across the bottom
of the screen.
selection.
To delete a shortcut:
1. Press
to go to the Home screen.
46
5. Scroll left or right across the bottom of the
screen and then tap an available Widget to
place it on your current screen.
To remove a Widget:
1. Touch and hold a Widget until it unlocks
from the current screen.
2. Drag the widget over the Remove tab
(
) and release it.
•
As you place the Widget into the Trash, both
items turn red.
•
This action doesn’t delete the Widget, it just
removes it from the current screen.
To place a widget onto a different screen:
1. Touch and hold the widget until it becomes
transparent.
2. Slowly drag it past the edge of the screen
until the adjacent page appears
highlighted and it then snaps onto the new
page.
3. Drag the widget to its desired position on
the new screen.
4. Repeat these steps to continue moving it to
other screens.
Understanding Your Phone
47
Creating and Managing a Folder
Folders hold items that you want to organize and
store together on the workspace.
Managing Wallpapers
Wallpapers consist of either Gallery images (user
taken), Live wallpapers (animated backgrounds),
or Wallpaper gallery (default phone wallpapers).
To create a new on-screen folder:
1. Press
to go to the Home screen.
Note: Selecting animated Live wallpapers will
2. Touch and hold an empty area of the
screen.
require additional battery power.
3. From the Add to Home screen window tap
To change the current wallpaper:
Folders
.
1. Press
to go to the Home screen.
4. Tap an available folder type and place it on
2. Touch and hold an empty area of the
screen.
the current screen.
3. From the Add to Home screen window tap
Renaming a folder
Wallpapers
.
1. Tap the desired folder you want to rename.
This opens its contents on an on-screen
popup window.
4. Select a Wallpaper:
•
•
•
Tap Gallery to select from a user image stored in
the camera image gallery, crop the image, and
tap Save
2. With the folder open, touch and hold the
grey Folder title bar (top of the Folder
window) until the Rename folder pop-up
displays.
.
Tap Live wallpapers to select from a list of
animated backgrounds, once done tap Set
wallpaper
.
3. Enter a new title for this folder and tap Yes
.
Tap Wallpaper gallery, scroll through the
Deleting a folder
images, tap a wallpaper image, then tap Set
1. Touch and hold a desired folder. This
unlocks it from its location on the current
screen.
wallpaper
.
2. Drag the folder over the Remove tab (
)
and release it.
48
Section 3: Memory Card
Your device lets you use a microSD (SD) or
microSDHC card (also referred to as a memory
card) to expand available memory space. This
secure digital card enables you to exchange
images, music, and data between
SD card Overview
After mounting an SD card in the device you can
use your computer to access and manage the SD
card.
SD-compatible devices. This section addresses
the features and options of your device’s SD
functionality. The device has a USB SD card
mode.
Important! If access to the external SD card is not
available, download and install the
USB drivers.
•
•
microSD card storage: up to 2GB in size
SDHC card storage: up to 32GB in size
microSD Icon Indicators
The following icons show your microSD card
connection status at a glance:
Using the SD Card
There are several methods for using the SD card:
1. Connecting to your PC to store files (such
as music, videos, or other types of files
and media).
• the contents of the microSD card
are being scanned.
• the card is being prepared for use
and for mounting.
2. To activate the camera, video, music
player, and other dependant media or
applications.
• the card has been improperly
removed.
Important! Your device can support SDHC cards
up to 32GB capacity.
Memory Card
49
3. Verify the phone is not in a USB Debugging
Mode. This mode is used by developers
and prevents access to the phone’s
storage capabilities. For more information,
4. Connect the USB cable to the phone and
connect the cable to the computer.
Important! DO NOT remove a microSD card while
the device is accessing or transferring
files. Doing so will result in loss or
damage of data. Make sure your
battery is fully charged before using
the microSD card. Your data may
become damaged or lost if the battery
runs out while you are using the
microSD card.
Unmounting the SD card
Unmounting the SD card prevents corruption and
damage to the SD card while removing it from
the slot.
Mounting the SD Card
To store photos, music, videos, and other
applications. You must mount (install) the SD
card prior to use. Mounting the SD card
establishes a USB connection with your
computer.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Storage.
2. Tap Unmount SD card ➔ OK.
3. When the “SD card will be unmounted
”
message displays and the Mount SD card
now appears in the menu list, remove the
Important! You must enable USB storage to mount
the SD card.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Storage.
2. Tap Mount SD card
➔
and then tap
(
SD card Memory Status
.
To view the memory allocation for your external SD
card:
Connecting to the SD card
1. Insert the SD card into the external, SD
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Storage. The available
memory displays under the Total space
and Available space headings.
2. Verify the card is properly mounted.
50
4. Tap Reset phone
➔
Erase everything
.
Erasing Files from the SD card
You can erase files from the SD card using the
phone.
2. Press
Settings) ➔ Storage ➔ Unmount SD card
3. Tap Format SD card Format SD card
➔
and then tap
(
.
➔
➔
Erase everything to format the SD card. The
SD card formats and erases all the data
stored on it.
Factory Data Reset
From this menu you can reset your phone and
sound settings to the factory default settings.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Privacy
.
2. Tap Factory data reset. This action erases
all data from your device except current
system software and bundled applications,
or SD card files such as music or photos.
Note: This feature provides an option to format the
internal USB storage, not the microSD card.
3. Tap Format USB storage to erase all data
stored on the device’s internal storage
area.
Memory Card
51
Section 4: Call Functions and Contacts List
This section describes features and functionality
Note: When you activate the Auto redial (Call >
associated with making or answering calls, and
the Contacts list, which is used to store contact
information.
Additional options) option in the Call settings
menu, the phone automatically redials up to
10 times when the person does not answer
the call or is already on the phone, provided
your call is not sent to voice mail.
Displaying Your Phone Number
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ About phone
➔
Status. Your
Quick Dialing a Number from the
Contacts List
phone number displays in the My phone
number field.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Note: The phone’s Settings menu can also be
activated by pressing and then
tapping Applications) ➔
Settings).
(
Contacts).
2. Locate a contact from the list.
3. In a single motion, touch and slide your
finger over the number by going to the
right. This action places a call to the
recipient.
(
(
Making a Call
You can store phone numbers that are regularly
used to the SIM card or to the phone’s memory.
These entries are referred to as the Contacts list
Ending a Call
.
ꢀ
Briefly tap
key to end the call.
1. Press
and then tap
.
Note: To redial a recent number, tap
end of the call or locate the number from
the Logs list, tap the entry and tap Call
at the
2. Enter the phone number and then tap
.
.
ꢀ
If you make a mistake while dialing, tap
to clear the last digit. Touch and
If you exit the current call screen and return to
the Home screen, You are visually notified that
you are still on an active call by the green phone
icon within the Status bar (highlighted in green).
hold
to clear the entire sequence.
52
Making Emergency Calls
In Call Notification
If you do not have a SIM card installed the first
time you turn on the phone, the Insert SIM card to
make calls message displays and an animated
tutorial shows you how to install the SIM card.
Without a SIM card, you can only make an
emergency call with the phone; normal cell
phone service is not available.
Making an Emergency Call Without a SIM
card installed
1. Tap Emergency call from the on-screen
Ending a Call from the Status Bar
1. Tap the Status bar to reveal the
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to
the bottom of the screen to open the
Notifications panel (1).
display to make an emergency call.
2. Complete your call. During this type of call,
you will have access to the Speaker mode,
Keypad, and End Call features.
2. Tap End to end the currently active call (2).
Note: Selecting Location consent may drain
battery power. For more information, refer
3. Tap
to exit this calling mode.
Making an Emergency Call With a SIM card
installed
1. Swipe the Lock screen and access the
Home screen.
2. Press
3. Enter the emergency number (ex: 911) and
then tap
and then tap
.
.
Call Functions and Contacts List
53
4. Complete your call. During this type of call,
you will have access to the Speaker mode,
Keypad, and End Call features.
To view additional dialing options:
Tap
ꢀ
:
• Add to Contacts to add the current number to
either a new or existing Contacts entry.
Note: Selecting Location consent may drain
battery power. For more information, refer
• Speed dial setting to access the Speed Dialing
menu where you can assign a speed dial
location to a current Contacts entry.
• Send message to send the current caller a text
message while still maintaining the current call
active.
5. Tap
to exit this calling mode.
Dialing Options
When you enter
numbers on the
Keypad, you will
see three
• Add 3 sec pause to insert a two-second pause
to enter a 3-second delay within a number string
(the phone continues dialing after 2 seconds
without any additional keys being pressed).
• Add wait to insert a hard pause within the
number string (the phone waits for your input). A
wait requires that any consecutive numbers be
on-screen
options.
From the keypad
screen, use one
of the following
options:
manually sent by tapping Send
.
•
Call
(
) to
call the entered
number.
•
•
•
Delete
(
)
to delete digits from the current number.
Voice Mail
service.
(
) to access your Voice Mail
) to send the current number
Text Message
(
a new text message.
54
Answering a Call
When somebody calls you, the phone rings and
displays the incoming call image.
Touch and
drag to
The caller's phone number, picture, or name if
stored in Contacts List, displays.
Touch and
slide it
reject with a
message
ꢀ
At the incoming call screen:
to answer
the call
•
•
•
Touch and slide
the call.
anywhere to answer
Touch and
slide to reject
the call
Touch and slide
call.
anywhere to reject the
Touch and drag the Reject call with message
tab upward and tap a predefined rejection
message or tap Create new message to create
a new custom outgoing response.
Managing Reject Calls
This feature allows you to categorize both known
and unknown callers as rejected contacts. These
Contacts are then added to you Rejection list
which can be managed for individual entries
from within the Contacts list or as a whole from
the Call rejection scree.
Pressing the Volume down button mutes the
ringer.
If the incoming call is from a number stored in
your Contacts, the entry’s name is displayed. You
may also see the caller’s phone number, if
available.
1. From the Home screen, press
and
Call
then tap
rejection
(
Settings) ➔ Call
➔
.
2. Tap Auto reject mode to configure your
automatic rejection settings. Rejected calls
are routed automatically to your voicemail.
Choose from:
• Off: disables the automatic rejection feature. You
must then manually reject incoming phone calls.
Call Functions and Contacts List
55
• All numbers: enables the features for all known
and unknown number, including those contacts
that are not assigned to the rejection list.
• Auto reject numbers: automatically rejects all
entries assigned to the Reject list.
3. Tap Save to complete the assignment.
International Calls
1. From the Home screen, tap
, then
touch and hold
displays.
. The + symbol
ꢀ
Adding numbers to the rejection list
2. Use the on-screen keypad to enter the
country code, area code, and phone
number.
Entries can be added to the list via either the
Contacts menu or via the Auto reject list menu.
The Contacts menu option assigns all numbers
for an individual as rejected. The Auto reject list
allows to assign individual numbers.
•
If you make a mistake, tap
a single digit.
once to delete
•
Touch and hold
to delete all digits.
To assign multiple numbers as rejected via
Contacts:
1. From the Home screen, tap
3. Tap
.
Pause Dialing
You can dial or save phone numbers with pauses
for use with automated systems, such as
voicemail or financial phone numbers.
(
Contacts).
2. Locate an entry and tap it to open the
Contact Overview Screen (page 87).
•
3-Second Pause automatically sends the next set
3. Press
and then tap Add to black list.
of numbers after a three-second pause. This is
All phone numbers associated with this
entry are then added to the reject list.
indicated in the number string as a comma (
Wait sends the next set of numbers only after
tapping . This is indicated in the number
,).
•
To assign single numbers as rejected via Auto
reject list:
1. From the Home screen, press
Send
string as a semicolon (
1. From the Home screen, tap
;
).
and
Call
and use
then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Call
Black list
Add) and either enter the phone
➔
the on-screen keypad to enter the phone
number.
rejection
➔
.
2. Tap
(
number or select a Contact from your Logs
or Contacts list.
56
2. Press
and then tap Add 3 sec pause
.
2. Press
and then tap Add wait. This
This feature adds an automatic three-
second pause.
feature causes the phone to require your
acceptance before sending the next set of
entered digits.
3. Use the keypad to enter the additional
numbers that will be dialed automatically
after the second pause.
3. Tap
.
4. Once prompted, tap
remaining digits.
to dial the
Send
Tip: You can create pauses longer than three
Redialing the Last Number
seconds by entering multiple 3-sec pauses.
The phone stores the numbers of the calls you’ve
dialed, received, or missed if the caller is
identified.
4. Tap
.
Wait Dialing
To recall any of these numbers:
Inserting a Wait
into your dialing
sequence means
that the phone
waits until it
hears a dial tone
before
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Tap the Logs tab to display the list of recent
calls.
3. Tap the name/number and tap
.
proceeding with
the next
sequence of
numbers.
1. From the
Home
screen, tap
and use the on-screen keypad to
enter the phone number.
Call Functions and Contacts List
57
4. Tap a contact and select a number to
assign to the speed dial location. The
selected contact number/image is
Speed Dialing
Once you have stored phone numbers from your
Contacts List, you can set up to 8 speed dial
entries and then dial them easily whenever you
want, simply by touching the associated numeric
key.
displayed in the speed dial number box.
Changing a Speed Dial Entry Order
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
Setting Up Speed Dial Entries
2. Press
and then tap Speed dial setting.
Important! Speed dial location #1 is reserved for
Voicemail. No other number can be
assigned to this slot.
Important! The number 1 is reserved for Voicemail
and another number cannot be
assigned to this slot.
1. From the
3. Press
and then tap Change order
.
Home
screen, tap
4. In a single motion, touch and drag an entry
over another location on the virtual
keypad.
.
2. Press
5. Tap Save to store the new assignment.
and then tap
Speed dial
setting. The
Speed dial
screen
6. Press
screen.
to return to the previous
Removing a Speed Dial Entry
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Press
and then tap Speed dial setting.
displays a
virtual
keypad with
the numbers 1 through 9.
3. Tap an unassigned number. The Contacts
screen displays.
3. Touch and hold a existing on-screen speed
dial location and select Remove from the
context menu.
– or –
Press
and then tap Remove. Tap an
entry and select Remove
.
58
4. Press
screen.
to return to the previous
Important! Wi-Fi must first be active and
communicating prior to launching Wi-
Fi Calling.
Making a Call Using Speed Dial
You can assign a short cut number to a phone
number in the Contacts List for speed dialing.
Activating Wi-Fi:
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Wi-Fi
2. Touch and hold a speed dial location
(numbers 2-9, or 1 if you are dialing voice
mail) until the number begins to dial.
3. If you are not certain of the speed dial
settings.
2. Tap Wi-Fi to turn it on. A checkmark
displays to indicate activation.
location, tap
setting and touch a speed dial number to
view the assigned phone number.
➔
➔
Speed dial
3. Tap an available WAP (Wireless Access
Point) from within the Wi-Fi networks area
of the page. Follow the on-screen
instructions to complete connection.
Wi-Fi Calling
Wi-Fi Calling is a free feature for T-Mobile
customers with a Wi-Fi capable phone. Wi-Fi
Calling is an excellent solution for coverage
issues in and around the home or wherever
cellular coverage is limited. Minutes used while
connected to the Wi-Fi network count against
available rate plan minutes.
Note: To avoid international data roaming fees
when using Wi-Fi calling when outside the
United States, the Data Roaming feature on
your device must be turned off.
Note: With certain rate plans, minutes used while
connected to the Wi-Fi network count
against available rate plan minutes.
The benefits of Wi-Fi Calling include the following:
•
Wi-Fi Calling provides a coverage option to improve
upon your current in-home coverage experience
Wi-Fi Calling works anywhere you can connect to an
available Wi-Fi network.
•
Call Functions and Contacts List
59
3. If prompted to
register onto
the T-Mobile
network prior
to use, tap
Launching Wi-Fi Calling
Note: Verify you are currently connected to a
Wireless Access Point.
1. Ensure that the Wi-Fi connected icon
displays on the status bar. The network
names and security settings (Open
network or Secured with WEP) of detected
Wi-Fi networks display in the Wi-Fi
networks section.
Register to
complete the
process.
4. Tap the slider
to activate Wi-
Fi Calling. The
slider shows
On. Your
Wi-Fi Calling
activation
slider
Note: When you select an open network you are
automatically connected.
device
connects to
the T-Mobile Network.
Wi-Fi Connected
Displays when Wi-Fi is connected,
active, and communicating with a
Wireless Access Point (WAP).
Note: If prompted with a connection error, move
the slider back to Off then back to On to re-
establish the connection.
Wi-Fi Communication Issue
DisplayswhenWi-Fiisactiveandthere
is an avialable Wireless Access Point
(WAP).
2. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Wi-Fi Calling).
60
In Call Options
Your phone provides a number of features that
are available for use during a call.
When Action
Then
Displays on the Youareconnectedtothe
screen status T-Mobile network and
bar.
can make Wi-Fi calls.
Displays on the Thefeatureisactiveand
screen status you are using with
Dials the
number
bar.
within your current
active call.
Place a call
on hold
Call
duration
Doesnotdisplay Youarechargednormal
Adds a
new call
status bar.
Ends the
call
5. Use the phone Dialer, call log, or contacts
list to make a call. For more information,
Activates or
Deactivates
Activates or
Deactivates
Bluetooth
Headset
Mutes or Unmutes
the call
speakerphone
6. Confirm you established a Wi-Fi calling
connection to the T-Mobile network by
Adjusting the Call Volume
During a call, use the Volume keys on the left
side of the phone, to adjust the earpiece volume.
making sure
the screen before you place your new call
and appears during the call.
appears at the top of
ꢀ
Press the Up volume key to increase the
volume level and the Down volume key to
decrease the level.
– or –
During a call, press the Up Volume key on
the side of the device.
Call Functions and Contacts List
61
From the Home screen, you can also adjust the
ring volume using these keys.
Turning the Speakerphone on and off
While on a call, you can use your Speakerphone
Placing a Call on Hold
by following these steps:
Speaker
1. Tap
(Speaker off) to turn the
You can place the current call on hold whenever
you want. If your network supports this service,
you can also make another call while a call is in
progress.
speakerphone on.
Speaker
2. Tap
(
Speaker on) to turn the
speakerphone off.
To place a call on hold:
Tip: When the speaker is turned On, the color of
the speaker is green. When the speaker is
turned Off, the color of the speaker is gray.
1. Tap Hold to place the current call on hold.
2. Tap Unhold to activate the call that is on
hold.
To make a new call while a call is in progress:
1. Enter the new phone number that you wish
to dial or look it up in Call history.
Muting a Call
Mute
1. Tap
(Mute off) to turn mute on so
the other caller cannot hear you speaking.
2. Tap Add call to dial the second call.
Mute
2. Tap
(Mute on) to turn mute off and
3. Dial the new phone number and tap
.
resume your conversation.
To switch between the two calls:
Switching to Bluetooth Headset
1. While on a call, switch to the Bluetooth
headset instead of speaker by tapping
ꢀ
Once the caller answers, tap Swap.
The In call number turns gray and displays
On hold. The active call displays a green
background behind the number.
Headset
.
2. At the prompt, tap Yes to enable Bluetooth
if it is not already activated.
62
Setting up a Multi-Party Call
1. From the Home screen, tap
More In-call Options
During a call you can save the current caller’s
information to the Contacts list, or create a
Memo.
.
2. Dial the number for the first participant and
tap
3. Tap Add call, enter the second phone
.
Viewing the Contacts List
During a call you can look up a number in the
Contacts list.
number and tap
placed on hold.
. The first caller is
1. Press
and then tap Contacts.
4. Wait for the second caller to answer the
incoming call and tap Merge. The two calls
are now joined into a multi-party call and
display in the order in which they were
called.
2. Browse the Contacts list for the
information you need.
3. Press
to return to the active call.
Creating a Memo During a Call
During a call it may be necessary to record
information (a Note).
Important! A maximum of two callers can be
joined to a single multi-party line.
Additional callers participate in a new
Multiparty session and are held in
conjunction with the previous
1. Press
2. Use the keyboard to enter the note then
tap Save
If desired, press
background color before saving.
and then tap Memo.
.
•
and select a new memo
multiparty call. You can swap or place
each multi-party call on hold.
Multi-Party calls
Making a Multi-Party Call
A multi-party call is a network service that
allows up to six people to participate in a multi-
party or conference call.
For further details about subscribing to this
service, contact T-Mobile customer service.
Call Functions and Contacts List
63
Having a Private Conversation With One
Participant
Split
Caller
End
Call
When you have
two participants
in a multi-party
session, it might
be necessary to
place one of
Manage Conference
Call
thoseparticipants
on hold so that a
private
conversation can
be held with a
single caller.
While you are in a
multi-party call:
1. Press
3. Tap the participant to which you want to
speak privately. You can now talk privately
to that person while the other participants
can continue to converse with each other.
If there is only one other participant, that
person is placed on hold.
4. To return to the multi-party call, tap the
Merge icon. All of the multi-party call
participants can now hear each other.
Dropping One Participant
and then
tap Manage conference call
– or –
.
1. Press
and then tap Manage
conference call
.
Tap the Conference Call image shown on
2. Tap End to the right of the number to
drop.
2. Tap
adjacent to the participants you
would like to split from the current multi-
line call. The list displays the callers in the
order they were dialed.
The participant is disconnected and you
can continue the call with the other
participant.
3. Tap
to end your conversation with
the remaining caller.
64
Call Waiting
Important! The currently active call is displayed
You can answer an incoming call while you have
a call in progress, if this service is supported by
the network and you have previously set the Call
waiting option to Activate.
with a green background.
4. Tap Swap again to switch back.
Logs Tab
You are notified of an incoming call by a call
waiting tone. For more information, refer to
The Logs tab is a list of the phone numbers (or
Contacts entries) for calls you placed, accepted,
or missed. The Logs tab makes redialing a
number fast and easy. It is continually updated
as your device automatically adds new numbers
to the beginning of the list and removes the
oldest entries from the bottom of the list.
To answer a new call while you have a call in
progress:
1. In a single motion, touch and slide
in any direction to answer the new
incoming call.
The Notification area of the Home screen (upper-
left) displays phone notifications, status, or alerts
such as:
2. Tap an option from the on-screen menu:
• Putting XX on hold to place the previous caller
on hold while you answer the new incoming call.
• Ending call with XXX to end the previous call
and answer the new call.
Displays when a call is in progress.
Displays when a call was missed.
Note: The new caller appears at the top of the list.
The previous caller is placed on hold and
appears at the bottom of the list.
Accessing the Logs Tab
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
(
Logs tab).
3. Tap Swap to switch between the two calls.
This places the new caller on hold and
activates the previous call.
Logs
2. Tap an entry to view available options.
Call Functions and Contacts List
65
3. Tap the Missed call entry to open the Logs
Note: The Logs tab only records calls that occur
while the phone is turned on. If a call is
received while it is turned off, it will not be
included in your calling history.
screen (2).
Each entry contains the phone number (if it is
available) and Contacts entry name (if the
number is in your Contacts).
Indicates all outgoing calls made from
your device.
Indicates any received calls that were
answered.
Indicates a missed call.
Tip: Press
panel.
and tap Notifications to open the
Indicates a rejected call.
This list provides easy access to redial an entry,
or you can also choose to access two types of
history entry lists depending on how they are
touched.
AccessingLogsfromTheNotifications
Area
1. Locate
from the Notifications area of
the Status bar.
2. Tap the Status bar to reveal the
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to
the bottom of the screen to open the
Notifications panel (1).
66
• Time provides the time and date of the call and
its duration.
Call Logs - Caller Overview
• Create contact to save the number if it is not
already in your Contacts.
Call options (tap)
Call Log screen
• Update existing to add the number to an
existing Contacts entry.
•
Touch and hold an entry to display the entry-specific
context menu:
• Call [Number] to redial the current phone
number.
• Send message allows you to create a new text
message to the selected entry.
• Edit number before call to make alterations to
the current phone number prior to redial.
• Add to Contacts to save the number if it is not
already in your Contacts.
• Send log info to send the Log entry information
via text message.
Entry-specific
context menu
(touch and hold)
• View contact to view the information for the
currently stored Contacts entry.
• Add to black list to add the current phone
number to an automatic rejection list. Similar to a
block list, the selected caller will be blocked from
making an incoming calls to your phone.
• Delete to delete the entry from the Logs list.
•
Tap a contact entry name or number to reveal the
Call options screen:
• Call allows you to redial the entry by name or
number.
• Send message allows you to create a new text
message to the selected entry.
Call Functions and Contacts List
67
Altering Numbers from the Logs List
Viewing Missed Calls from Lock
Screen
If you need to make a call from the Logs screen
and you need to alter the number prior to dialing,
you can add the appropriate prefix by prepending
the number.
When you are
unable to answer a
call for any reason
and your screen is
locked, the number
of missed calls are
displayed on the
Lock screen
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
.
Logs
2. Touch and hold an entry to access the
entry-specific context menu.
3. Tap Edit number before call
.
immediately after a
call is missed.
4. Edit the number using the on-screen
keypad or delete digits by pressing
to erase the numbers.
To view a missed call
immediately:
1. Press
5. Tap
changed.
once the number has been
to
reactive the screen.
Erasing the Logs List
2. Touch and drag the button (with the
number of missed calls on it) to the
right.The Logs tab is then displayed.
You can delete either an individual call log entry
or all current entries from the Logs list.
To clear a single entry from the list:
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
.
Logs
2. Touch and hold an entry and select Delete
.
To clear all entries from the list:
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
.
Logs
2. Press
➔
Delete.
Delete
3. Tap Select all
➔
➔
OK.
68
Section 5: Entering Text
Thissectiondescribeshowtoselectthedesiredtext
input method when entering characters into your
phone. This section also describes the predictive
text entry system that reduces the amount of key
strokes associated with entering text.
Selecting the Text Input
Method
The Text Input Method can be assigned from
within one of two locations:
Settings Menu:
Your phone comes equipped with an orientation
detector that can tell if the phone is being held in an
upright (Portrait) or sideways (Landscape)
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
Select input method
Text Input field:
➔
and then tap
(
➔
orientation. This is useful when entering text.
.
Your phone also provides several on-screen keypad
text entry options to make the task of text entry that
much easier.
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
touch and hold the text input field to open
the context-menu.
Text Input Methods
There are two text input methods available:
Samsung keypad (default): an on-screen
QWERTY keypad that can be used in both
portrait and landscape orientation.
2. Select the input method (Samsung keypad
or Swype).
•
•
Swype: a new way to enter text on touch
screens. Instead of tapping each key, use your
finger to trace over each letter of a word.
Default Text
Input Method
The on-screen QWERTY keypad works the same
in both portrait and landscape mode.
Entering Text
69
Enabling Accessibility settings
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ (Accessibility).
Enabling and Configuring SWYPE
If you configure another text input method
(Samsung keypad) you must re-enable SWYPE
before using the SWYPE keyboard.
➔
(
2. Tap Accessibility to activate or deactivate
accessibility services. When activated, a
check mark appears in the box.
3. If prompted, tap OK to download
accessibility applications from the Android
Market.
When SWYPE is enabled there can also be
normal keyboard functionality.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
.
2. Tap Select input method
➔
Swype.
SWYPE Settings
4. Follow the on-screen instructions.
To configure Swype settings:
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Swype
➔
Language and keyboard
➔
.
Entering Text Using Swype
2. Locate the Preferences section to alter
Swype™ is a text input method that allows you
to enter a word by sliding your finger or stylus
from letter to letter, lifting your finger between
words. SWYPE uses error correcting algorithms
and a language model to predict the next word.
SWYPE also includes a touch predictive text
system.
these settings:
• Language: allows you to select the current text
input language. Default language is US English.
• Audio feedback: turns on sounds generated by
the Swype application.
• Show tips: turns on helpful on-screen tips from
Swype.
The on-screen keyboard options are different
between the Android keyboard and Swype on-
screen input methods.
3. Locate the Swype Advanced Settings
section to alter these settings:
• Word suggestion: suggests words as you are
typing.
• Auto-spacing: automatically inserts a space
between words. When you finish a word, just lift
your finger or stylus and start the next word.
70
• Auto-capitalization: automatically capitalizes
the first letter of a sentence.
Swype Text Entry Tips
You can
• Show complete trace: once enabled, sets
wether or not to display the complete Swype
path.
access the
SwypeTips
application
and watch a
video or
tutorial on
using Swype.
You can also
use the
• Speed vs. accuracy: sets how quickly Swype
responds to on-screen input. Move the slider
between Fast Response (speed) or Error
Tolerant (accuracy) and tap OK
.
4. Locate the Help section to alter these
settings:
following
Swype text
entry tips.
• Swype help: allows you to view the on-line user
manual for Swype.
•
Create a
• Tutorial: a short tutorial that helps you to get
started using Swype.
squiggle (like
an S shape) to
5. Locate the About section to review the
Swype application information:
• Version: lists the Swype version number.
create a double letter (such as pp in apple).
Touch and hold a key to view the punctuation menu
then make a selection.
•
•
•
Move your finger or stylus over the apostrophe to
enter contractions.
Double-touch on the word you want to change to
correct a misspelled word, then touch the delete key
to erase one character. Touch and hold the delete
key to erase an entire word.
Entering Text
71
• Text Input mode: There are two available
modes: 123ABC and SYM.
Selecting a Text Input Mode in Swype
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
tap the text input field to reveal the
on-screen keyboard.
–
123ABC mode contains alphanumeric
characters and a few common punctuation
marks. Text mode button indicates SYM
SYM mode contains only symbols and numbers.
Text mode button indicates 123ABC
.
2. With Swype as your text entry method,
select one of the following text mode
–
options:
• 123 ABC
.
123
ABC
to use Swype with
• SWYPE tips: Tapping this button displays the
alphanumeric characters from the on-screen
Swype tips and tutorial screen.
keyboard.
123
SYM
• SYM (Symbol)
to enter numbers and
Recipients
symbols from the on-screen keyboard.
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,
Text input
field
the
key changes to
and all letters
that follow are in lower case.
Current
Mode
Predictive
text
Swype Keyboard Overview
• Recipients: a field where you can enter the
recipients of the current message. You can
CAPS/ALT
key
choose from Contacts
,
Recent, Group or
Delete
Favorites
.
• Text Input field: a field where text, number, or
other characters can be entered.
SWYPE Tips
Text Input mode
Voice actions
• CAPS/ALT key: When in 123ABC mode, this key
changes the capitalization of the subsequent
entered characters. When in SYM mode, this key
can show additional symbol characters.
72
Using 123ABC Mode in SWYPE
All lowercase
In 123ABC mode, you can enter only letters and a
few common punctuation marks from the
onscreen keyboard. The text mode key shows
Displays when the next character is
entered in lowercase. Pressing this
while in 123SYM mode, reveals
additional numeric-symbols keys.
123
SYM
.
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
Initial Uppercase
tap the text input field to reveal the on-
Displays when the first character of
eachwordisenteredasuppercasebut
all subsequent characters are
lowercase.
screen keyboard.
123
ABC
2. Tap
to configure the keyboard for
123ABC mode (showing letters and
numbers on the onscreen keys). Once in
this mode, the text input type shows
All Uppercase
Displays when all characters will be
entered as uppercase characters.
123
SYM
.
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,
By default, the first letter of an entry is
the
key changes to
and all letters
capitalized and the following letters are lower
case. After a word is entered and you lift your
finger, the cursor automatically adds a space
after the word.
that follow are in lower case.
3. Swipe your finger continuously over the
letters to form a word.
–
If you make a mistake, tap
single character. Touch and hold
an entire word.
to erase a
to erase
Note: If multiple word choices exist for your
Swype entry, an on-screen popup appears
to provide additional word choices.
4. Tap
to send the message.
Send
Entering Text
73
Entering Numbers and Symbols in
SWYPE
By using the on-screen keyboard in portrait
mode, some symbols are not available (such as
Emoticons or Smileys). In SYM mode using
Swype, you can only enter symbols and numbers
Using the Samsung Keypad
This QWERTY keypad is the default text input
method and can be used to enter text in either a
Portrait or landscape orientation. The only
difference between the two orientations are the
sizes of the keys.
from the on-screen keyboard. Once in SYM
From a screen where you enter text, rotate your
phone counterclockwise to a landscape
orientation. The on-screen QWERTY keypad
displays.
123
mode, the text mode key shows
.
ABC
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
tap the text input field to reveal the on-
screen keyboard.
123
2. Tap
to configure the keyboard for
SYM
SYM mode. Once in this mode, the text
input type shows
123
.
ABC
3. Tap the on-screen key for the number or
symbol you want to enter.
4. Touch and hold an on-screen key to enter
the secondary symbol (above the main one
on the same key).
The Samsung Keypad
5. Tap
symbols.
For example:
to choose from additional
This phone has a built-in, QWERTY keypad
(portrait mode) or keyboard (landscape mode).
Using the QWERTY keypad/ keyboard, you can
type letter, numbers, punctuation, and other
characters.
•
To enter
&: tap 123SYM and select the
&
key.
•
To enter
over the
or
~: tap 123SYM and draw a small circle
To use the Samsung keypad you must first
configure the settings to default to the Samsung
keypad.
&
~
key.
To enter
hold the
: tap 123SYM and then touch and
&
key.
74
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Changing the Text Input Mode in
Keypad
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
tap the text input field to reveal the on-
screen keyboard.
(Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
➔
Select input method
– or –
➔
Samsung keypad.
From a screen where you can enter text,
tap and hold the text input field and tap
Input method
2. With Samsung keypad as your text entry
method, select one of the following text
mode options:
➔
Samsung keypad.
2. The virtual keyboard is then assigned to
the Samsung keypad configuration for all
subsequent text input.
ABC
• Abc
the on-screen keyboard. In this mode, the text
?123
: to use alphabetic characters from
mode button displays
• Symbol/Numeric
.
Recipients
Text input field
Shift key
: to enter numbers by
?123
pressing the numbers selecting them on the
on-screen keyboard. In this mode, the text mode
ABC
button displays
There are up to 3 available pages of numeric
1/3
.
symbols available by tapping
.
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,
tap to toggle capitalization.
Input Mode
Indicator
Current Mode
Delete
Settings
Entering Text
75
3. Enter your text using the on-screen
All lowercase
keyboard.
Displays when the next character is
entered in lowercase.
–
If you make a mistake, tap
single character. Touch and hold
an entire word.
to erase a
to erase
Initial Uppercase
Displays when the first character of
eachwordisenteredasuppercasebut
all subsequent characters are
lowercase.
4. Tap
to send the message.
Send
Using Symbol/Numeric Mode
Use the Symbol/Numeric Mode to add numbers,
symbols, or emoticons. While in this mode, the
text mode key displays
All Uppercase
.
ABC
Displays when all characters will be
entered as uppercase characters.
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
tap the text input field to reveal the on-
screen keyboard. Rotate the phone
counterclockwise to a landscape
orientation, if desired.
By default, the first letter of a new entry is
capitalized and the following letters are
lowercased. After a character is entered, the
cursor automatically advances to the next space.
?123
2. Tap
Symbol mode. Once in this mode, the text
input type shows
to configure the keyboard for
Using ABC Mode in Samsung Keypad
1. From a screen where you can enter text,
tap the text input field to reveal the on-
screen keyboard.
.
ABC
3. Tap a number, symbol, or emoticon
character.
4. Tap
to return to ABC mode.
ABC
ABC
2. Tap
ABC mode. Once in this mode, the text
input type shows
to configure the keyboard for
.
?123
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,
the key changes to and all letters
that follow are in lower case.
76
To enter symbols:
?123
2. Set any of the following options:
• Portrait keypad types allows you to choose a
keypad configuration (Qwerty Keypad [default] or
3x4 Keypad).
1. Tap
to configure the keyboard for
Symbol mode.
2. Tap the appropriate symbol key.
– or –
• Input languages sets the input language. Tap a
language from the available list. The keyboard is
updated to the selected language.
1/3
Tap
button to cycle through
additional pages.
• XT9 enables predictive text entry mode. This
must be enabled to gain access to the advanced
settings.
•
The first number on this key indicates which
page (1, 2, or 3) of additional characters is
active.
• XT9 advanced settings configuration of more
advanced XT9 features. For more information,
Using XT9 Predictive Text
XT9 is a predictive text system that has next-
letter prediction and regional error correction.
• Keypad sweeping allows changing between the
input modes without having to use the Input
Mode key. You can "sweep" the displayed
keypad aside, in a similar manner to scrolling
through the Home screens.
Note: XT9 is only available when ABC mode is
selected. XT9 advanced settings are
available only if the XT9 field has been
selected.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
➔
• Auto-capitalization automatically capitalizes
the first letter of the first word in each sentence
(standard English style).
Language and keyboard
keypad.
➔
Samsung
– or –
• Voice input activates the Voice input feature.
This is an experimental feature that uses
Google’s networked speech recognition
application.
From within an active text entry screen,
tap from the bottom of the screen to
reveal the Samsung keypad settings
screen.
• Auto full stop automatically inserts a full stop by
tapping the space bar twice.
Entering Text
77
• Tutorial launches a brief onscreen tutorial
covering the main concepts related to the
Samsung keypad.
• Spell correction enables the automatic
correction of typographical errors by selecting
from a list of possible words that reflect both the
characters of the keys you touched, and those of
nearby characters. (A green check mark
indicates the feature is enabled.)
Using XT9 Predictive Text
XT9 is a predictive text system that has next-
letter prediction and regional error correction,
which compensates for users pressing the
wrong keys on QWERTY keyboards.
• Next word prediction predicts the next word
you are like to enter. (A green check mark
indicates the feature is enabled.)
1. Press
➔
and then tap
➔
Language and keyboard
keypad.
➔
Samsung
• Auto-append automatically adds predictions to
the word you are typing. (A green check mark
indicates the feature is enabled.)
2. Tap the XT9 field. A checkmark indicates
activation.
• Auto-substitution allows the device to
automatically replace misspelled or miskeyed
words. This option reduce “typos.” (A green
check mark indicates the feature is enabled.)
• Regional correction automatically tries to
correct errors caused when you tap keys
adjacent to the correct keys. (A green check
mark indicates the feature is enabled.
3. Tap the XT9 advanced settings and
configure any of the following advanced
options:
• Word completion tells your device to attempt to
predict how to complete the word you have
started. (A green check mark indicates the
feature is enabled.)
• Word completion point sets how many letters
should be entered before a word prediction is
made. Choose from 2 letters, 3 letters, 4 letters,
or 5 letters.
• Recapture sets the device to redisplay the word
suggestion list after selecting the wrong word
from the list.
78
• XT9 my words allows you to add new words to
the built-in XT9 dictionary.
–
–
Tap Add word.
Use the Register to XT9 my words field to
enter the new word.
–
Tap Done to store the new word.
• XT9 auto-substitution allows you to create a
word rule by adding words for automatic
substitution during text entry (for example youve
becomes you’ve).
–
Tap the XT9 auto-substitution field. Flick up or
down to review the current list of word
substitutions.
–
–
Press
and tap Add.
Enter the original word that will be replaced in
the Shortcut field (for example, youve).
Enter the substitute word that will be used in the
Substitution field (for example, you?fve).
Tap Done to save the substitution rule.
–
–
4. Press
screen.
to return to the previous
Entering Text
79
Section 6: Contacts
This section explains how to use and manage
your Contacts List. You can save phone numbers
to your phone’s memory.
4. From the Manage accounts area, tap
next to the account you want to
synchronize.
Accounts
– or –
From the Accounts menu you decide if you want
applications to synchronize, send, and receive
data at any given time, or if you want the
applications to synchronize automatically. After
determining how you want the accounts to
synchronize, indicate which account to
synchronize with your Contacts list.
Tap Add account to create a new account.
5. Tap an account type to add.
6. Follow the on-screen instructions. The
selected account type synchronizes with
your Contacts list.
Contacts List
Creating a Contact
1. Sign in to your Google account.
2. Press
➔
and then tap
The default
(Settings) ➔ Accounts and sync
.
storage location
for saving phone
numbers to your
Contacts List is
your phone’s
– or –
From the Home screen, tap
(Applications) ➔
(Settings) ➔
Accounts and sync
.
built-in memory.
3. From the General sync settings section, tap
one of the following options:
If existing Google
and Corporate
email accounts
• Background data: allows your phone to use
data in the background.
have been
• Auto-sync: automatically synchronizes your
data with the phone.
synchronized to
your phone, these
will be made
available to your device during the creation of
80
new entries. These new Contacts entries can be
assigned or saved to synced accounts such as
Phone, SIM, Google, or Corporate.
•
•
•
•
T-Mobile Contacts Backup contacts are stored
remotely on the T-Mobile servers and can later be
retrieved even if your phone has been damaged or
reset.
Your phone automatically sorts the Contacts
entries alphabetically. You can create either a
Google contacts are shared with your existing
Google account and can also be imported to your
phone after you have created a Google Mail
account.
Phone
,
SIM, T-Mobile Contacts Backup, Google, or
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync contact.
Note: Before you can save a contact to the Phone,
Contact settings must be set to Save new
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync (also known as
Work or Outlook) contacts are those contacts that
are intended to be shared with either an Exchange
contacts to Phone
.
®
®
Server or from within Microsoft Outlook
.
Important! The Google and Microsoft Exchange
ActiveSync account types are only
visible after creating an email account
of those types on your phone.
Remember this choice assigns the desired default
account storage location for new Contact entries.
Note: When storing an entry into your SIM card,
note that only the Name, and Number are
saved. To save additional information for a
particular contact, such as notes, email,
dates, etc., it is important to save that
•
Phone contacts are stored locally on the device.
Note: If the phone is ever reset to its factory
default parameters, contacts stored on the
phone can be lost.
Contact into your phone’s onboard memory.
1. From the Home screen, tap
•
SIM contacts are stored within the SIM Card.
(
Contacts).
2. Tap
contact.
Note: SIM contacts only store the Name and
(Create contact) to create a
Phone number for an entry.
Contacts
81
•
Tap
on the QWERTY keyboard to remove
Note: You can also add a new contact by entering
a previously entered phone number.
a number from the keypad and pressing
•
•
Tap
to enter an additional phone number
to remove a previously entered phone
and then tap Add to Contacts
➔
Create
Tap
contact. Continue with step 3.
number.
3. Tap a destination type (Phone
,
SIM,
T-
8. Enter additional information such as:
Internet call, Email IM Groups, Ringtone
Postal address Organization or More fields
to input additional category information.
Mobile Contacts backup, Google, or
,
,
,
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync) (depending
on where you want to save the new
contact information).
,
•
The More field contains the following options:
Notes, Nickname, Website, Birthday, and
Anniversary.
4. Tap the Given name and Family name fields,
and enter a name for this contact using the
displayed keypad.
•
Use your finger to slide the page up or down to
see additional fields and categories.
5. Tap the image icon and select a photo for
this contact. Selections are: Album, or Take
9. Tap Save to complete and store the new
photo
.
entry.
6. Tap the label button (to the left of the
To save a Number from your Keypad:
1. From the Home screen, tap
Phone number field) to select a category
(Phone).
such as Mobile (default), Home
Fax Home Fax Pager Other Custom, or
Callback
,
Work, Work
2. Enter a phone number using the on-screen
,
,
,
,
keypad.
.
3. Tap Add to Contacts
➔
Create contact or
Update existing (select the Contact entry
from the on-screen list).
– or –
Note: These label entries can change and are
dependant on the selected destination type
(ex: Callback might not appear with a
Google account destination type).
Press
Create contact or Update existing (select
the Contact entry from the on-screen list).
and then tap Add to Contacts
➔
7. Tap a phone number field and enter a
phone number.
82
•
If you're updating an existing contact, tap the
entry from the list and proceed to step 5.
Finding a Contact
You can store phone numbers and their
4. Tap a destination type (Phone
,
SIM, T-
corresponding names onto either your SIM card,
your phone’s built-in memory, or an external
location (such as Google, Exchange, or T-Mobile
Backup). They are all physically separate but are
used as a single entity, called Contacts.
Mobile Contacts backup, Google, or
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync) (depending
on where you want to save the new
contact information).
Depending on the storage size of the particular
SIM card, the maximum number of phone
numbers the card can store may differ.
1. From the Home screen, tap
5. Tap the Given name and Family name fields,
and enter a name for this contact.
6. Tap the label button (to the left of the
Phone number field) to select a category
(Contacts).
such as Mobile (default), Home
Fax Home Fax Pager Other Custom, or
Callback
,
Work, Work
2. Swipe up or down until you see the contact
,
,
,
,
displayed.
– or –
.
Note: These label entries can change and are
dependant on the selected destination type
(ex: Callback might not appear with a
Google account destination type).
Tap the Search contacts field and begin
entering the entry’s name. Matching
entries are then displayed. This process
filters through all of your current account
Contact entries to only show you the
matching entries.
7. Tap Save to complete and store the new
entry.
– or –
Note: For further details about how to enter
In a single motion, touch and hold the
letter tab area (on the right) until on-screen
letters appear, then scroll through the list.
You are then taken to that section of the
Contacts list. Touch the contact entry.
Contacts
83
Editing Contact Information
1. From the Home screen, tap
Search
Contacts
field
.
2. Tap a contact name from the list.
Tabs
3. Press
and select Edit.
Create
Contact
Note: You can also access an entry’s context
menu by touching and holding an entry then
tapping Edit
.
4. Edit the contact information then tap Save
.
Tabbed
Navigation
Contacts
Context Menu
84
•
•
The More field contains the following options:
Notes, Nickname, Website, Birthday, and
Anniversary.
Adding a Number to an Existing
Contact
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Touch and
hold an
.
Use your finger to slide the page up or down to
see additional fields and categories.
entry and
5. Tap Save to complete and store the new
select Edit
to reveal
the Contact
entry’s
entry.
Deleting Contacts
This option allows you to delete your contacts.
You can delete all your entries from your phone’s
memory, your SIM card, FDN, or All.
details
screen
Important! Once Contacts List entries are deleted,
3. Tap a
phone
they cannot be recovered.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Touch and hold a contact name from the
list and select Delete OK
.
number
field and
enter a
Contact Details Screen
➔
.
Contact List Options
phone number.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
•
Tap
on the QWERTY keyboard to remove
2. Press
. The following options display:
a previously entered phone number.
• Delete: allows you to delete 1 or more of your
contacts.
•
•
Tap
to enter an additional phone number
to remove a previously entered phone
Tap
• My profile allows you to set up a profile for yourself.
:
number.
The information will be the same that you can add for a
new contact.
4. Enter additional information such as:
Internet call, Email IM Groups, Ringtone
Postal address Organization or More fields
to input additional category information.
,
,
,
Press
and tap Edit to alter this profile information.
,
Contacts
85
• Sync contacts: allows you to manually
synchronize all of your current contacts with their
respective accounts.
–
–
Send message: allows you to send a text or
picture message.
Display options: allows you to choose to only
display contacts that have phone numbers, sort
by Given or Family name, display contacts Given
(first) name first or Family (last) name first,
display contacts stored to your SIM card, display
contacts stored on your phone, and/or display
contacts stored to other accounts. For more
• Merge with Google: allows you to merge all of
your current Contact entries with your active
Google/Gmail account. If several of your contacts
are from other sources such as Corporate email,
Internet email, Facebook, etc.., this allows you to
“back them up” or copy them to your Gmail
account. Tap Merge to continue or Cancel to
exit.
• Import/Export: imports or exports contacts to or
from the SIM card or SD card, you can also send
namecards via methods such as Bluetooth,
Email, Gmail, or Messaging.
–
Settings: allows you to configure where you
save new contacts, or view your Own numbers,
or Service numbers.
Contact Menu Options
• More
:
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
–
View Friends: allows you to view only those
Contact entries that have been added from
Social Networking Sites (SNS) such as Facebook.
Accounts: allows you to add and manage
mobile accounts on Facebook, Twitter, or
MySpace. You can also add Corporate or Google
accounts.
2. Touch and hold an entry to reveal the
context menu. The following options
display:
–
• Edit: allows you to edit the currently selected
Contacts entry.
• Delete: allows you to delete the currently
selected Contacts entry.
–
–
Speed dial setting: allows you to set up speed-
dialing.
• Join contact: allows you to link the current
contact to another current contact. Similar to a
“see also” feature. If you can’t remember a
contact’s information, linking entries can help
you find the person you are looking for.
Send email: allows you to send an email using
your Google account.
86
• Send contact information: allows you to send
the current entry info via text message.
• Add to Favorites: allows you to copy the current
Contacts entry to the list within the Favorites tab.
• Remove from Favorites: allows you to remove
the current Contacts entry from the Favorites
tab.
Contact Entry Options
1. From the
Home
screen,
tap
.
2. Tap an entry
to reveal the
Contact
• Add to group: allows you to add the current
Contacts entry to an existing group.
entry’s
Overview
Screen. This
screen
• Add to black list/ Remove from black list
:
allows you to add or remove the current Contacts
entry to a list of automatically rejected incoming
phone numbers.
contains
Name,
contact
• Send namecard via: allows you to send the
current Contact entry’s information to an external
Contact Overview Screen
numbers,
recipient via either Bluetooth
,
Email (Exchange
email, and linked contact information.
3. Press to reveal the context menu
specific to this entry.
4. Tap an available option.
or Internet), Gmail, or Messaging
.
Contacts
87
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
Joining Contact Information
2. Tap a contact name (the name you want to
Most people now maintain multiple email
accounts, social networking logins, and other
similar account information. For example, a
Facebook account login name might differ from a
corporate email account login because they are
maintained separately and for different groups of
people.
link to another entry) to reveal the Contact
entry’s Overview Screen
.
Note: Typically this is the same contact with a
different name or account information.
3. Press
and then tap Join contact.
This device can synchronize with multiple
accounts (such as Facebook, Twitter, Linkedin,
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync, Google, or
T-Mobile). When you synchronize your phone
with those accounts, each account creates a
separate contact entry in the Contacts list.
4. Tap the second contact entry (the entry in
which to link). The second contact is now
linked with the first and the account
information is merged into one screen.
Note: The information is still maintained in both
entries, but displays in one record for easier
viewing when you link the contacts.
If one of your contacts (Amy Smith) has a regular
email account that you maintain in Gmail, but
also has a Facebook account under her maiden
and married name, as well as a Video! chat
account, when you merge those accounts into
your Contacts list you can join all of her entries
and view the information in one record.
Important! It is the second contact image that is
displayed for both, but the first
contact’s name that is used.
Joining contact information makes sending
messages easy. You can select any account
email address or information all from one screen,
versus searching multiple, individual screens to
locate the desired account information.
For example: If Amy (original entry) is
joined with Julie (second entry). Julie
appears to disappear and only Amy
remains. Tap the Amy entry (showing
the Julie image) to view both.
Next time you synchronize your phone with your
accounts, any updates contacts make to email
account names, email addresses, etc.
automatically update in your contacts list.
88
5. Tap the main linked contact to view the
contact information you linked. The
contacts and information displays with an
icon next to the contact name to indicate
what type of account information is
contained in the entry.
Marking a Contact as Default
When you use applications such as the Voice
Dialer or other messaging type applications, the
application needs to know which information is
primary (default) in a contact entry list. For
example, when you say “Call John Smith”, if you
have three phone records for John Smith, the
Voice dialer is looking for the “default” number
or entry.
Unjoining a Contact
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Tap a contact name (the account name
from which you want to unjoin an entry).
This reveals the details for entry.
The Mark as default option marks one entry in a
contact record to use as the default. This comes
in handy when you have multiple entries for the
same person.
Note: Typically this is the same contact with a
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
different name or account information.
2. Tap a Contact entry.
3. Press
and then tap Mark as default.
3. Tap the Joined contacts area.
The Mark as default screen displays radio
buttons next to the contact name, phone
number, or other contact information.
4. Tap the radio button next to the entry
information you want to be the primary
information (such as name, phone number,
– or –
Press
and then tap Separate contact.
4. Tap
next to the entry you want to
unjoin. The contacts are “unjoined” or
separated and no longer display in the
merged record screen. Both contacts now
go back to being separately displayed.
or email) and select Save
.
Note: If there are multiple phone numbers
assigned to an entry, assigning one as the
default will automatically dial that number
when the contact is selected for dialing.
Contacts
89
4. Tap Send and select a delivery method:
• Bluetooth to transmit this contact to another
bluetooth-compatible device.
Sending a Namecard
A Namecard contains contact information, and
can be sent to recipients as a Virtual Business
Card (V-card) attachment using Bluetooth,
Google Mail, or as a message.
• Email to attach the contact card to a new
outgoing email (Exchange or Internet).
• Gmail to attach the contact card to a new
outgoing Internet-based email.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Tap a Contact entry.
3. Press
via and select a delivery method:
Bluetooth Email Gmail, or Messaging.
and then tap Send namecard
• Messaging to attach the contact card to a new
outgoing text message.
,
,
Sending a namecard using Bluetooth
You must create a Contact prior to sending a
namecard to a recipient. For more information,
refer to “Creating a Contact” on page 80.
The Namecard attaches to the selected
message type and is delivered when you
send the message.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
Note: Email appears as an option only after an
Internet or Exchange email account has
been created.
2. Touch and hold the entry to reveal the on-
screen context menu.
3. Tap Send namecard via
➔
Bluetooth.
Sending All Current Namecards
Rather than selecting once Contact entry at a
time, you can send all of your current entries at
once.
Important! You must activate Bluetooth to use this
feature.
4. Tap the Bluetooth device in which to send
this name card. Bluetooth forwards the
namecard to the recipient.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Press and then tap Import/Export Ô
Send namecard via
.
.
3. Tap Select all to place a check mark
alongside all currently displayed Contact
entries.
90
Copying Contact Information
Note: These must be contacts stored on the
phone. External entries (Google, Exchange,
etc...) can not be transferred in this manner.
Copying Contact Information to the
SIM Card
The default storage location for saving phone
numbers to your Contacts list is your phone’s
built-in memory. This procedure allows you to
copy numbers saved to the phone’s memory,
onto the SIM card.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. From the Contacts List, press
and
then tap Import/Export
card
➔
Export to SD
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
3. Tap OK to choose all current phone contact
2. From the Contacts List, press
and
entries.
then tap Import/Export
card
➔
Export to SIM
Synchronizing Contacts
.
Syncing data from your managed accounts
allows you to add and manage a new or existing
contact from your online or remote accounts to
your phone. Prior to syncing, you must first have
an active Google or Microsoft Exchange account
with current Contact entries, and be signed into
your account via the phone.
3. Tap Select all to choose all current phone
contact entries.
– or –
Select a specific entry by touching an
entry. A check mark indicates a selection.
4. Tap Export. The name and phone number
for the selected contact is then copied to
the SIM.
With syncing, any Contacts entries (with phone
numbers, email addresses, pictures, etc.) are
updated and synced with your phone. For more
information about syncing existing managed
Copying Contact Information to the
microSD Card
This procedure allows you to copy entry
information saved on the phone’s memory, onto
the SIM card.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
➔
Accounts and sync
.
2. Locate the email account containing the
contacts you wish to synchronize.
Contacts
91
3. Tap
within the adjacent account field
• Only contacts with phones allows you to
display only those contacts containing phone
numbers.
to reveal the account’s synchronization
settings screen.
4. To synchronize Contacts, tap Sync
Contacts. A green checkmark indicates the
feature is enabled.
• Sort by defines how the current list of Contacts
are sorted: Given name or Family name
.
• Display contacts by defines how the current list
of Contacts are listed: Given name first (ex:
Steve Smith) or Family name first (Smith,
Steve).
Note: The process of updating your Contacts tab
can take several minutes. If after 10-20
minutes, your list has not been updated,
repeat step 2-3.
• Select contacts to display allows you to filter
Contacts based on category entries from within
the locations such as: Phone
Contacts Backup Google, and Microsoft
Exchange ActiveSync
3. Tap Done
,
SIM, T-Mobile
5. Your Contacts tab then reflects any
,
updated Contact information.
.
Note: Syncing of contacts requires you are logged
into your Gmail and Corporate accounts via
the device.
.
Adding more Contacts via
Accounts and Sync
When you synchronize applications such as
Facebook, Twitter, Linkedin, a corporate email
account, or Google, using the Accounts and sync
option synchronizes the data from the selected
account type with your Contacts list.
Display Options
The Display options menu allows you to allows
you to choose whether to display contacts saved
from the Phone, SIM, T-Mobile Contacts Backup,
external source, or all. You can also choose to
display only contacts that have phone numbers.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Add account
➔
Accounts and sync
➔
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Press and then tap More
.
➔
Display
options. Configure any of the following
options:
92
2. Determine which type of account
information you want to synchronize with
your Contact list. Selections are: Facebook,
Twitter, Linkedin, Microsoft Exchange
ActiveSync, Google, Blio (T-Mobile),
Samsung account, Video Chat, or
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Add account
➔
Accounts and sync
Facebook.
➔
➔
2. Accept the terms of the Social Hub, tap the
I accept all terms above field, then select
Agree
3. Read the on-screen descriptions and tap
Next
4. Log into your Facebook account:
Enter your account’s access Email and
Password information and tap Log in
.
T-Mobile Contacts Backup
.
3. Tap an account type to add.
.
4. Follow the prompts. The selected account
type synchronizes with your Contacts list.
5. After synchronizing accounts you may
want to link contact information. For more
•
.
5. Tap those contact settings you wish to
synchronize (all are enabled by default). A
green circle indicates the feature is
enabled.
To add Facebook content to your Contacts list:
•
Choose from: Sync contacts
,
Sync message,
You can now add your Facebook contact
information, such as pictures, email, and phone
numbers directly to your Contacts list. All of their
current contact information is then migrated over
to your phone. If a Contacts entry already exists
with a slightly different name, separate entries
are created and can later be linked (joined)
together into a single entry.
or Sync calendar
.
6. Tap Done to complete the login and sync
process.
7. Tap
to confirm your Facebook
contacts are now synchronized and appear
in your Contacts list.
To resync Social Network Contacts:
Important! This process not only synchronizes
your contact information but also your
status, events, and more.
1. Press
Accounts and sync.
2. Tap within the adjacent SNS account
field to reveal the account’s
➔
and then tap
➔
synchronization settings screen.
Contacts
93
3. Tap Sync Contacts
.
3. Tap the contact(s) to which you want to
send an email. A check mark displays next
to the selection.
My Profile
You can send this Virtual Business Card (V-card)
to other contacts as an attachment. My Profile is
the first Contact listed in the Contacts list.
Note: The select contact must have an email as
part of their details screen.
Note: As with any profile, your profile can be
4. Tap Send
.
associated with a group.
5. Select an email account type.
To create My Profile:
6. Compose the email and tap Send
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
Export/Import
2. Press
and then tap My profile.
To edit My Profile:
1. With My profile displayed, press
then tap Edit
2. Modify any of the information contained in
My Profile, then tap Save
and
Contact List Settings
.
From this menu you can determine the default
storage location for Contacts, display your
phone’s primary number, and view service
numbers listed in your Contact list.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Press and then tap More
.
Additional Contact Options
Sending an Email to a Contact
.
➔
Settings.
Note: Contacts must contain and email account
and address before you can use the Send
email feature.
Important! The Google and Microsoft Exchange
ActiveSync account types are only
visible after creating an email account
of those types on your phone.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Press and then tap More
.
➔
Send
3. Select one of the following options:
email. Contacts that contain an email
address display.
94
• Save new contacts to: defines the default
4. Tap Ringtone and select a ringtone for the
storage location of new Contacts. Choose from:
group. Selections are: Default ringtone,
Always ask
Backup Google, or Microsoft Exchange
ActiveSync
,
Phone
,
SIM
,
T-Mobile Contacts
Select sound from My files, or Phone
ringtone.
,
.
5. Tap Save to store the newly created group.
• Service numbers: displays the available service
numbers.
Note: Some externally maintained group types
(such as Google) can only be managed or
updated remotely online vs via the phone.
These external types will not allow editing
or deleting members locally via the phone.
• Send contact: allows you to define what set of
namecards are sent when you choose to send
namecards to other sources.
–
Read the on-screen description of this feature
and tap Next
Select either Send all namecards or Send
individual namecards
.
Adding an Existing Entry to a Current
Caller Group
–
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
.
Groups
Groups
2. Tap a group entry ➔
(
Add group
This feature allows you to add a new or existing
contact to a call group. This group can be one of
the already present groups (Family, Friends, or
Work) or a user-created group.
member).
3. From the available list of contacts, tap the
contact(s) you want to add. A check mark
displays next to contact entry.
Creating a New Caller Group
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
4. Tap Add. The selected contacts are added
to the group.
(Groups tab).
Groups
RemovinganEntryFromaCallerGroup
2. Press
and then tap Create
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
3. Tap the Group name field and use the on-
screen keypad to enter a new group name.
.
Groups
2. Tap a group entry.
3. Press
and then tap Remove member
.
Contacts 95
4. Tap all of the contacts you want to remove
from this group. A checkmark displays
next to contact entry.
Sending a Message to a Group
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
.
Groups
5. Tap Remove.The contacts are removed
from the group.
2. Tap an
existing
group, and
press
Editing a Caller Group
To edit a Group entry, there must be at least one
and then tap
Send
member as part of the selected group.
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
message
– or –
.
.
Groups
2. Touch and hold a group entry then select
Edit group
Touch and
hold a group
entry and
select Send
message
.
3. Make modifications to the Group name or
Ringtone fields. For more information, refer
to “Creating a New Caller Group” on page
95.
.
4. Tap Save
.
3. Select the recipients of the new message
(indicated by a green checkmark). If an
entry contains multiple phone numbers,
each must be selected individually.
Deleting a Caller Group
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
.
Groups
4. Tap Send
.
2. Press
and then tap Delete.
5. Type your message, and tap Send
.
3. Select either Select all or tap the desired
group.
4. Tap Delete
.
96
The Favorites Tab
The Favorites tab is a list of the phone numbers
that have been designated as favorite contacts.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Tap Favorites tab).
.
(
Favorites
Adding a contact to your favorites list:
3. From within the Favorites tab, press
and select Add to favorites
.
4. Place a check mark alongside those
current Contacts entries you wish to assign
as favorites.
5. Tap Add to complete the process.
Contacts
97
Section 7: Messaging
This section describes how to send or receive
different types of messages. It also explains the
features and functionality associated with
messaging.
and from other mobile phones or email
addresses. To use this feature, you may need to
subscribe to your service provider’s multimedia
message service.
Types of Messages
Important! When creating a message, adding an
image, a sound file, or a video clip to a
text message changes the message
from a text message to a multimedia
message.
Your phone provides the following message
types:
•
•
•
•
Text Messages
Multimedia (Picture, Video, and Audio) Messages
Email and Gmail Messages
Google Talk
Messaging icons are displayed at the top of the
screen and indicate when messages are
1. From the Home screen, tap
Message Icons on the Status Bar
Icons are displayed on the Status Bar at the top
of the display when new messages are received.
(Messaging) ➔
(New message).
2. Tap the Enter recipient field to manually
Creating and Sending
Messages
enter a recipient.
– or –
The Short Message Service (SMS) lets you send
and receive text messages to and from other
mobile phones or email addresses. To use this
feature, you may need to subscribe to your
service provider’s message service.
Tap
following:
to select from one of the
• Contacts: to select a recipient from your
Contacts list (valid entries must have a wireless
phone number or email address).
The Multimedia Messaging Service (MMS) lets
you send and receive multimedia messages
(such as picture, video, and audio messages) to
• Recent: to select a recipient from a list of
recently sent messages.
98
• Groups: to select a recipient from the Group list.
• Favorites: to select a recipient from the
Favorites list.
Message Options
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Messaging).
3. If adding a recipient from either Recent,
Contacts, or Group, tap the contact to
place a checkmark then tap Add. The
contact displays in the recipient field.
2. From within an open message, press
to display additional messaging options:
• Insert smiley: allows you to add insert
smiley icons images (emoticons).
• Call: places an outgoing call to the sender.
• Add text: allows you to add text items from
sources such as: Location, Contacts,
Calendar, Memo, Text, and Text templates.
• Add to Contacts: allows you to add the new
recipient to your current Contacts list as a new
entry.
Note: Delete any unnecessary members in the list
by selecting the trash can icon and deleting
unwanted entries.
4. Tap the Tap to enter message field and use
the on-screen keypad to enter a message.
• Add/Remove slide: converts an SMS message
into an MMS (Multimedia) message and allows
you to attach an existing slideshow.
5. Add more recipients by tapping either the
Enter recipient field or
and selecting
recipients.
–
Once the message has been converted into in an
MMS message, press and tap More to
6. Review your message and tap Send.
choose from these options: Add slide, Remove
slide, Add subject, Duration (5 sec), Layout
(bottom), or Delete message.
Note: If you exit a message before you tap send
the message automatically saves as a draft.
• More: (when in an SMS message - plain text)
provides additional options such as: Add subject
and Delete messages.
Messaging
99
To reply to a text
message:
1. From the
Home
Viewing Newly Received
Messages
Current Recipient
My Text
When you receive a message, your phone
notifies you by displaying
within the
screen, tap
.
Notification area at the top left of your Home
screen.
2. While the
message is
open, tap
To read a message:
1. Open the Notification Bar and select the
– or –
the Type to
compose
field and
then type
From the Home screen, tap
then tap
your reply
message.
3. Compose
your reply.
Your texts
the new message to view its contents. The
selected message displays on the screen.
Reply Bubble
Text Message Thread
2. Tap
to play a multimedia message.
3. In a single motion, touch and scroll up or
down the page to scroll through the
are colored Blue and your caller’s replies are
Yellow.
message (if additional pages were added).
Message Threads
4. Tap Send to review your reply.
Sent and received text and picture messages are
grouped into message threads. Threaded
messages allow you to see all the messages
exchanged (similar to a chat program) and
displays a contact on the screen.
– or –
Press
and then select one of the
available message options (page 99).
To access message thread options:
Message threads are listed in the order in which
they were received, with the latest message
displayed at the top.
ꢀ
From the main Messaging screen, touch
and hold the message to display the
following options:
100
• View contact: displays the Contact’s Overview
page.
Deleting Messages
Deleting a message thread
• Add to Contacts: begins the process of adding
the new number to your Contacts list.
• Delete thread: deletes the currently selected
message thread.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Touch and hold a message from the
Messages list, then select Delete thread
.
3. At the prompt, tap OK to delete or Cancel to
To access additional Bubble options:
exit.
ꢀ
From within the message string screen,
touch and hold the message bubble to
display the following options:
• Delete message: deletes the currently selected
message bubble from the thread.
Deleting a single message
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Open a message to reveal the message
string.
3. Touch and hold a message bubble, then
• Add to Contacts: adds the current caller to your
Contacts list.
select Delete message
.
4. At the prompt, tap OK to delete or Cancel to
• Copy message text: copies the currently
selected message bubble from the thread.
• Lock/Unlock message: locks or unlocks the
currently selected message bubble from being
accidentally deleted.
exit.
Deleting multiple messages
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. Press
and then tap Delete threads.
3. Tap each message thread you want to
• Forward: allows you to forward the currently
selected message bubble to an external
recipient.
delete. A checkmark displays beside each
selected message.
4. Tap Delete
.
• Copy to SIM: copies the currently selected
message bubble as a single text message within
the SIM card.
5. At the prompt, tap OK to delete or Cancel to
end the process.
• View message details: displays details for the
currently selected message bubble.
Messaging
101
Storage settings
Message Search
• Delete old messages: deletes old messages
You can search through your messages by using
the Message Search feature.
when the limit is reached, rather than overwriting
them.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Press and then tap Search
.
• Text message limit: allows you to set a limit on
how many text messages are allowed in one
conversation.
.
3. Use the on-screen keypad to enter a word
or phrase in which to search, then tap
.
• Multimedia message limit: allows you to set a
limit on how many multimedia messages are
allowed in one conversation.
4. All messages that contain the entered
search string display.
Text message (SMS) settings
Messaging Settings
• Delivery reports: when this option is activated,
To configure the settings for text messages,
multimedia messages, Voice mails, and Push
messages.
the network informs you whether or not your
message was delivered.
• Manage SIM card messages: allows you to
manage the messages stored on the SIM card.
• Message Center: allows you to enter the
number of your message center where your
messages reside while the system is attempting
to deliver them.
1. From the Home screen, tap
2. Press and then tap Settings
.
.
The following Messaging settings are available:
Settings
• Message font size: enables the phone to
change the display size for the on-screen front.
Choose from: Normal, Small, or Tiny.
• Input mode: allows you to set the input mode for
your text messages. Choose from: GSM
Alphabet, Unicode, or Automatic.
• Background color: enables the phone to display
the messages using different contrasting colors
schemes. The background color options are:
Black or White.
102
Multimedia message (MMS) settings
Notification settings
• Delivery reports: when this option is activated,
• Notifications: allows you to see message
the network informs you whether or not your
message was delivered.
notifications on your status bar.
• Select ringtone: allows you to set the ringtone
for your message notifications.
• Read reports: when this option is activated, your
phone receives a request for a read reply along
with your message to the recipient.
Text Templates
This screen displays your available text message
reply templates. This is a readily accessible list
of both default and user-defined text snippets
that can be used to quickly reply to incoming
messages.
• Auto-retrieve: allows the message system to
automatically retrieve messages.
• Roaming auto-retrieve: allows the message
system to automatically retrieve while roaming.
• Creation mode: allows you to select the creation
mode: Free, Restricted, or Warning.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
2. From the Messaging list, press
and
then tap Text templates
.
–
Restricted: you can only create and submit
messages with content belonging to the Core
MM Content Domain.
3. Tap a message to immediately insert it into
your current message conversation.
To create your own text template:
1. From the Home screen, tap
–
Warning: the phone will warn you via pop up
messages that you are creating a multimedia
message which does not fit the Core MM
Content Domain.
.
2. From the Messaging list, press
and
then tap Text templates
3. Tap Create template).
4. Enter a new text string and tap Save
.
–
Free: you may add any content to the message.
(
Push message settings
.
• Push message: allows you to receive push
messages from the network.
• Service loading: allows you to set the type of
service loading notification. Choose from:
Always, Prompt, or Never.
Messaging
103
Creating an Internet Email Account
Email
1. From the Home screen, tap
Email (or Internet Email) enables you to review
and create email using several email services.
You can also receive text message alerts when
you receive an important email. Your phone’s
Email application lets you access and manage
multiple email accounts simultaneously in one
convenient location.
(Applications) ➔
(Email).
2. If you already have other email account
setup:
•
•
Tap the account name field (upper-right) to open
the complete email account list page.
Press
and then tap Add account.
There are currently three main types of email
accounts on your phone: Gmail, Internet-based
email (Gmail, Yahoo, etc..), and Microsoft
Exchange (Corporate email or Outlook®).
Account name
To send and receive email messages through an
ISP (Internet Service Provider) account, or if you
wish to use your device to access your corporate
email through a VPN (Virtual Private Network),
you will first need to set up an IMAP or POP
account.
– or –
•
IMAP (Internet Message Access Protocol) - This
protocol is frequently used in large networks and
commercial settings. IMAP4 is the current standard.
POP3 (Post Office Protocol) - This protocol is
supported by most ISPs (Internet service providers)
and common among consumer applications. POP3
is the current standard.
Enter your Email address and Password
information. Tap Show password to view
the password string as you enter it.
•
• Email address: your Outlook work email
address.
• Password: typically your network access
password (case-sensitive).
•
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync - This protocol is
frequently used with a large corporate email server
system and provides access to email, contact, and
calendar synchronization.
104
3. Tap Send email from this account by default
to make this not only your default email
account, but also link it to your Social Hub
Important! Only some “Plus” accounts include
POP access allowing this program to
connect. If you are not able to sign in
with your correct email address and
password, you may not have a paid
“Plus” account. Launch the Web
4. Tap Next. If prompted to sign up to Social
Hub, tap OK
.
browser to access your account.
•
Tap Manual setup to configure your connection
settings manually (POP3 or IMAP). Follow the
on-screen prompts and enter the information
specific to your email provider.
Opening an Email
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
(
Email).
•
The unique account name is used to differentiate
this account from other email accounts
accessed by your device.
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to
open the complete email account list page.
3. Select an email account and tap an email
message.
5. At the Set up email screen, name the
account and enter a screen name to
identify yourself on this account. If you
have already setup this account, skip to
step 7.
Refreshing Email messages
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
(Email).
6. Messages for this account display on the
Inbox tab. You can also view Personal
information for this account, Receipts (if
you setup the account to return receipts),
Travel information, and more (if available).
7. Tap Done to store the new account.
2. Select an email account.
•
If you are already in an email account, tap the
account name field (upper-right) to open the
complete email account list page.
•
Select an available email account.
3. Press
and then tap Refresh.
Messaging
105
–
Tap
to delete the attached file.
Composing Email
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
•
•
To insert a Gallery, Contacts, Location, Calendar,
and Memo item, tap Insert and make a
selection.
(Email).
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to
open the complete email account list page.
Tap the file you wish to attach.
3. Tap Inbox
➔
(Compose).
Note: If you attach an image to your email, you
have the option to resize it prior to delivery.
Choose from: Original, Large (70%),
4. Enter the recipient’s email address in the
To field.
•
If you are sending the email message to several
recipients, separate the email addresses with a
comma. You can add as many message
recipients as you want.
Medium (30%), or Small (10%). Once
chosen, tap OK
.
8. Once complete, tap Send
.
5. Press
and then tap Add Cc/Bcc to add
Configuring Email Settings
1. From the Home screen, tap
additional carbon copy recipients.
➔
•
•
Use the Cc field to carbon copy additional
recipients.
(
Email).
2. Select an account.
Use the Bcc field to blind copy additional
recipients.
3. From the email list screen, press
and
then tap More
➔
Account settings.
6. Tap the Subject field and enter the email
subject.
4. Alter any of the following settings:
• Account name: displays your uniquely created
account display name.
7. Tap the email text field and compose your
email message.
• Your name: displays the name used in the From
field of your outgoing email messages.
•
To add a n attachment (such as image, video,
audio, etc..), tap Attach (from the bottom of the
screen) and make a category selection.
• Add signature: Lets you attach a customized
signature to the bottom of all outgoing emails.
• Signature: Lets you create an email signature
for your outgoing Gmail email messages.
–
Tap the file you wish to attach. If selecting an
image, you can choose to select a variation of
the image size.
106
• Email check frequency: adjusts the time
interval used by your device to check your email
account for new email messages.
Microsoft Exchange Email
(Outlook)
Your phone also provides access to your
company’s Outlook Exchange server. If your
company uses either Microsoft Exchange Server
2003 or 2007, you can use this email application
to wirelessly synchronize your email, Contacts,
and Calendar information directly with your
company’s Exchange server.
• Default account: Assign this account as the
default email account used for outgoing
messages.
• Always Cc/Bcc myself allows you to include
your own email address in either the CC, Bcc, or
None fields. Lets you always receive a copy of
outgoing emails.
SettingUpaMicrosoftExchangeEmail
account
• Email notifications: Activates the email
notification icon to appear within the Notifications
area of the status bar when a new Internet mail
(Gmail, etc..) is received.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Email).
➔
(
2. If you already have other email account
setup:
• Select ringtone: Plays a selected ringtone when
a new email message is received.
•
•
Tap the account name field (upper-left) to open
the complete email account list page.
• Vibrate: Activates a vibration when a new email
message is received.
Press
and then tap Add account.
• Incoming settings: Lets you specify incoming
email settings, such as User name, Password,
IMAP server, Security type, Port, and IMAP path
prefix.
Account name
• Outgoing settings: Lets you specify incoming
email settings, such as SMTP server, Security
type, Port, Require sign-in, User name, and
Password.
• Forward with files: Lets you include
attachments when forwarding an email.
– or –
Messaging
107
Enter your Email address and Password
information. Tap Show password to view
the password string as you enter it.
•
•
If your network requires SSL encryption, tap the
Use secure connection (SSL) field to place a
check mark in the box and activate this
additional level. Most often, this option should be
enabled.
• Email address: your Outlook work email
address.
If your network requires you accept SSL
certificates, tap the Accept all SSL certificates
field to place a check mark in the box and
activate this additional level. Most often, this
option is not required. Confirm this information
with your IT Administrator.
• Password: typically your network access
password
(case-sensitive).
3. Tap Send email from this account by
default, to make this not only your default
email account, but also link it to your
Social Hub (page 155).
Important! If your exchange server requires this
feature, leaving this field unchecked
can prevent connection.
4. Tap Done
➔
Next. Consult your Network or
IT Administrator for further details and
support.
7. Manually updated or re-enter your
Exchange server information within the
appropriate field. This field can often be
populated with incorrect or out of date
information.
5. Tap Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync (from
the add new email account screen).
6. When prompted to provide additional
detailed information, enter an updated
Domain, and confirm your User name and
Password information.
• Exchange Server: your exchange server remote
email address. Typically starts with
Important! It will be necessary for you to enter
your domain information before the “\”
in front of your user name.
mail.XXX.com. Obtain this information from
your company network administrator. Do not
accept the default entry as this is a guess based
on returned information.
108
Composing Exchange Email
Important! The Exchange server field may not
reflect the desired server information.
It is recommended that you confirm
this information and re-enter if
necessary.s
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
(Email).
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to
open the complete email account list page.
3. Select an exchange email account.
8. With the new server information entered,
4. Tap Inbox and tap
(Compose).
tap Next
9. Read the on-screen activation disclaimer
and, if prompted, tap OK
10. Adjust the various on-screen configuration
fields and tap Next
11. Identify your new work email account with
.
5. Enter the recipient’s email address in the
To field.
.
•
If you are sending the email message to several
recipients, separate the email addresses with a
comma. You can add as many message
recipients as you want.
.
a unique name (Ex: Work), then tap Done
.
6. Press
and then tap Add Cc/Bcc to add
Opening an Exchange Email
additional carbon copy recipients.
•
•
Use the Cc field to carbon copy additional
recipients.
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
(Email).
Use the Bcc field to blind copy additional
recipients.
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to
open the complete email account list page.
3. Select an exchange email account and tap
an email message.
7. Tap the Subject field and enter the email
subject.
8. Tap the email text field and compose your
email message.
Refreshing Exchange Email
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
•
To add a picture attachment, tap Attach (from
the bottom of the screen) and make a category
selection.
(
Email).
2. Select an exchange email account.
3. Press and then tap Refresh
.
Messaging
109
•
•
Tap the file you wish to attach. If selecting an
image, you can choose to select a variation of
the image size.
3. Toggle either the Sync Contacts or Sync
Calendar fields to force the device to
manually resync either the exchange
Contacts or Calendar entries.
– or –
Tap
to delete the attached file.
Note: If you attach an image to your email, you
have the option to resize it prior to delivery.
Choose from: Original, Large (70%),
Tap Account settings and specify any other
email settings you wish to synchronize:
• Account name displays the name used by the
device to track the account.
Medium (30%), or Small (10%). Once
chosen, tap OK
.
• Add signature activates the email signature
feature.
9. Once complete, tap Send
.
Deleting an Exchange Email Message
• Signature allows you to create an outgoing
email signature attached to new email
messages sent from your phone.
ꢀ
Touch and hold an email (from your inbox
list) and select Delete from the on-screen
context menu.
• Default account assigns this account as the
default used when sending out new email
messages.
– or –
With the email message displayed, tap
• Always Cc/Bcc myself allows you to include
your own email address in either the CC, Bcc, or
None fields. Lets you always receive a copy of
outgoing emails.
(
Delete).
ConfiguringMicrosoftExchangeEmail
Settings
1. Press
Accounts and sync.
2. Tap adjacent to the Microsoft
Exchange account field to reveal the
account’s synchronization settings screen.
➔
and then tap
➔
• Period to sync email to assign the sync range
for your incoming and outgoing email messages
between your phone and your external exchange
server. How many days worth of email messages
should the phone and server synchronize.
Choose from: 1 day
,
3 days, 1 week, 2 weeks,
or 1 month
.
110
• Empty server trash: allows you to delete your
email account’s trash bin remotely.
• Vibrate assigns a vibration when a new or
upcoming event is pending.
• Sync schedule allows you to configure your
email sync schedule.
• Incoming settings provides access to the
Domain, password, and Exchange server
settings.
• Out of office settings allows you to configure
your email’s out of office notification settings.
• Period to sync Calendar assigns a period for
your phone to sync calendar events.
• Sync Contacts synchronizes the contacts
between your phone and the remote exchange
server.
• Sync Calendar synchronizes your exchange
calendar entries between your phone and the
remote exchange server.
• Size to retrieve emails configures the incoming
email size allowed to pass through to your phone
automatically without user interaction. Emails
with attachments larger than configured will
have to be retrieved manually.
• Sync Tasks synchronizes your exchange tasks
entries between your phone and the remote
exchange server.
• Security options: allows you to enable several
security options such as: Encryption, Encryption
algorithm, Sign, Sign algorithms, Email
certificates, and Security policy list. These
security policies could restrict some functions
from corporate servers.
4. Press
to return to the previous page.
Using Google Mail
Google Mail (Gmail) is Google’s web-based
email. When you first setup the phone, Gmail is
configured. Depending on the synchronization
settings, Gmail is automatically synchronized
with your Gmail account.
–
Security policy list: lists the current email’s
security policy. These policies could restrict some
functions from corporate servers.
Signing into Google Mail
1. rom the Home screen, tap
• Email notifications enables the device to
display a status bar icon when new email
messages have been received.
➔
(Gmail).
Note: You must sign in to your Gmail account in
order to access features such as Google
Mail and Android Market.
• Select ringtone assigns an audible ringtone
when a new or upcoming event is pending.
Messaging
111
2. Tap Next to add a Google account.
4. Press
and select Add Cc/Bcc to add a
carbon or blind copy.
3. Tap Create if you do not have a Google
account.
– or –
5. Enter the subject of this message in the
Subject field.
6. Tap the Compose Mail field and begin
composing your message.
Tap Sign in if you have a Google account.
The Inbox loads conversations and email.
7. Once complete tap
(Send).
Opening Gmail
1. From the Home screen, tap
Viewing a Gmail Message
➔
1. From the Gmail Inbox, tap a message to
view the following options:
• Archive: archives the selected Email.
• Delete: deletes the Email.
(
Gmail).
2. Tap an existing email message.
Refreshing Google Mail
ꢀ
From within the Gmail message list, press
• <: displays older Emails.
and then tap Refresh to send and
• >: displays newer Emails.
receive new emails and synchronize your
email with the Gmail account.
2. Press
to select one of the following
additional options:
• Change labels: changes the label on the email
or conversation.
Composing a Gmail Message
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
(
Gmail).
2. From the Gmail Inbox, press
tap Compose
• Mark unread: unread messages or threads with
unread messages display in boldface text in the
Inbox.
and then
.
3. Enter the recipients Email address in the To
• Mark important/Not important: to change the
important state of an email.
field.
• Go to inbox: displays the Google Mail Inbox.
• Mute: mutes the conversation.
Tip: Separate multiple recipient email addresses
with a comma.
112
• Add/Remove star: click a message's star to
add or remove the star (just like clicking flags in
Outlook).
3. Tap Add account and follow the same steps
as referenced in the previous section. For
• More
:
–
–
–
–
Report spam: reports the Email message as
spam.
Google Talk
Google Talk™ is a free Windows and web-based
application for instant messaging offered by
Google. Conversation logs are automatically
saved to a Chats area in your Gmail account.
This allows you to search a chat log and store
them in your Gmail accounts.
Settings: allows you to configure the General, or
Notification settings.
Help: launches the browser and displays Google
Mobile Help information.
Select text: allows you to select text to copy and
paste.
You can now use Google Talk to not only have
voicechats but also video conferences with
connected friends.
Creating an Additional Gmail Account
1. From the Home screen, tap
Gmail).
➔
Note: Before using this application, you must first
have an active Gmail account available and
be currently logged in.
(
2. If you already have other email account
setup:
•
Tap the account name field (upper-right) to open
the complete email account list page.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Talk).
➔
(
Account name
Note: If you are not already logged into Google,
refer to the instructions for signing in on
2. Begin using Google Talk.
Messaging
113
Note: The Network confirms your login and
processes. This could take up to 5 minutes
to complete.
114
Section 8: Multimedia
This section explains how to use the multimedia
features of your phone, including the Camera/
Camcorder, Music Player, and how to manage
your photos, images and sounds.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Camera).
2. Using the phone’s main display screen as a
viewfinder, adjust the image by aiming the
camera at the subject.
This section explains how to use the camera on
your phone. You can take photographs and shoot
video by using the built-in camera functionality.
Your camera produces photos in JPEG format.
3. If desired, before taking the photo, use the
left area of the screen to access various
camera options and settings.
4. You can also tap the screen to move the
focus to a desired area of interest.
Important! Do not take photos of people without
their permission.
5. Press
(Camera key) until the shutter
Do not take photos in places where
cameras are not allowed.
Do not take photos in places where
you may interfere with another
person’s privacy.
sounds. (The picture is automatically
stored within your designated storage
location. If no microSD is installed, all
pictures are stored on the Phone.) For
Using the Camera
Taking Photos
1
8
Taking pictures with your device’s built-in
camera is as simple as choosing a subject,
pointing the camera, then pressing the camera
key.
2
3
7
6
Note: When taking a photo in direct sunlight or in
bright conditions, shadows may appear on
the photo.
4
5
Multimedia
115
Camera and Camcorder
Options
Options are represented by icons across both
sides of the screen.
Settings:
Edit shortcuts: allows you to set shortcut
icons for the settings that you use the
most.
Camera Options
The following shortcuts are available for the
camera:
Self portrait: allows you to set the front
camera so you can take pictures of
yourself or video chat.
Flash: allows you to set the flash options
to Off, On, or Auto flash.
Note: The options disappear after a few seconds.
Touch the screen to display the tab, then
touch the tab to view these options.
Shooting mode: allows you to set the
shooting mode. Options are:
•
Single shot: takes a single photo and
view it before returning to the
shooting mode.
Focusarea:displaystheareaoftheimage
used as the main focus area.
•
Smile shot: the camera focuses on
the face of your subject. Once the
camera detects the person’s smile, it
takes the picture.
Self portrait: allows you to set the front
camera so you can take pictures of
yourself or video chat.
•
Panorama: takes a landscape photo
by taking an initial photo and then
adding additional images to itself.
The guide box lets you view the area
where the second part of the
Flash: allows you to set the flash options
to Off, On, or Auto flash.
A
panoramic picture should fall within.
116
Settings (continued):
Resolution: allows you to set the image
size to either: 3.2M (2048x1536), 2M
(1600x1200), or 0.3M (640x480).
Scene mode: allows you to set the Scene
to help take the best pictures possible.
Options include None, Portrait,
Landscape, Night, Sports, Party/Indoor,
Beach/Snow, Sunset, Dawn, Fall color,
Firework, Text, Candlelight, and
Backlight.Helpfultipsareshownforeach
scene mode at the bottom of the display
screen.
White balance: allows you to set this
option to one of the following choices:
Auto, Daylight, Cloudy, Incandescent, or
Fluorescent.
Metering: allows you to set how the
camera measures or meters the light
source: Centre-weighted, Spot, or
Matrix.
Exposure value: allows you to adjust the
brightness level by moving the slider.
GPS tag: allows you to turn GPS On or Off
(alsoknownasGeotagging).Thelocation
of where the picture is taken is attached
to the picture. (Only available in Camera
mode.)
Focus mode:allows you to set this option
to Auto focus, Macro, or Face detection.
Use Auto focus for all other focal
situations.
•
Auto focus: automatically focuses the
image based on the on-screen focus
area.
Shutter sound: allows you to set the
Shutter sound to On or Off.
Storage: allows you to configure the
default storage location for images or
videosaseitherPhoneorMemorycard(if
inserted).
•
Macro: allows you to take close-up
pictures.
Timer: allows you to set a timer for how
long to wait before taking a picture.
Options include:Off, 2sec, 5sec, and 10
sec.
Reset: allows you to reset all camera or
camcorder settings to the default values.
Effects: allows you to change the color
toneorapplyspecialeffectstothephoto.
Options include: None, Negative,
Grayscale, and Sepia.
Multimedia
117
Video options
Camera / Camcorder Mode: allows you to
take a photo in various modes. Once you
change the mode, the corresponding
indicator appears at the top left of the
display.SlidethebuttonupforCamera,or
down for Camcorder.
• Share: allows you to share a video using
AllShare, Messaging, YouTube, Bluetooth, Gmail,
Email, Kodak, and Snapfish.
• Play: allows you to playback the current video
file.
• Delete
:
allows you to delete the current video.
Camera button: takes a photo when
pressed in Camera mode.
• More: provides additional options.
–
–
Send to: allows you to send the file to a
Contacts entry, New Email address, or New
Phone number.
Image viewer: allows you to access the
Image viewer and the various viewing
options for a selected picture. The last
picture you took, will be displayed as a
thumbnail in the Image viewer icon.
Set Default Destination: allows you to assign a
default action to take after taking an image
(Contacts, New Email address, or New Phone
number).
Pictures and Videos Image Viewer
Options
After you take a photo or record a video, you can
access various options.
–
–
Play: allows you to replay the current video file.
Rename: allows you to rename one or more
video files.
Photo options
• Share: allows you to share a picture using
AllShare, Messaging, Picasa, Bluetooth, Gmail,
Email, Kodak, or Snapfish.
• Delete
:
allows you to delete the current picture.
Tap OK to delete or Cancel
.
118
Camera Gallery Options
The Gallery is where you can access the Gallery
of stored camera images.
1. From the
Home screen,
tap
Camera Image Options
When you take a picture, the file is saved in the
Photo folder. You can view your pictures
immediately or view them anytime in the Photo
folder.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Gallery).
(Applications)
2. Select a folder location and tap a file to
open it in the Image viewer. Touch and
drag a picture to the left to see the next
picture or to the right to see the previous
picture.
➔
(Gallery).
2. Select a
folder
location (ex:
3. Tap the on-screen image and use either of
the following image menu options:
• Send via: allows you to share a picture using
Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, Messaging, Kodak, or
Snapfish.
Camera) and
select an
image by
tapping it
once to place
a green check mark on the file.
• Delete
:
allows you to delete the current image.
3. Press
to reveal gallery-specific options Send via
Delete, and More
from this main Gallery screen
4. Press
and then tap Set as to select
,
additional options:
• Share via: allows you to share a picture using
AllShare or Picasa.
.
• Set as: allows you to assign the current image
as either as Contact icon, Home screen
Wallpaper, or Lock screen Wallpaper.
Multimedia
119
–
–
–
–
–
Rotate left: allows you to rotate the view of the
current image in a counterclockwise direction.
Rotate right: allows you to rotate the view of the
current image in a clockwise direction.
Slideshow: adds the selected photo to a
custom slideshow.
Rename: allows you to change the name of the
current file.
Send to: allows you to send the file to a
Contacts entry, New Email address, or New
Phone number.
–
–
Set Default Destination: allows you to assign a
default action to take after taking an image
(Contacts, New Email address, or New Phone
number). The default storage location for
pictures is DCIM > Camera folder.
Details: files details such as Title, Type, Date
taken, Album, Location, Latitude, Longitude,
etc..
Assigning an Image as a Contact Icon
• More: provides you with the additional options
such as:
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Gallery).
–
Copy: allows you to copy one or more pictures to
a different folder.
2. Select a folder location and tap a file to
open it.
–
Crop: provides an on-screen box that allows you
to crop the current picture. Tap Save to update
the image with the new dimensions or tap
Discard to ignore any changes.
3. With the image displayed, press
then tap Set as Contact icon
4. Tap a contact to make a selection.
and
➔
.
120
5. Crop the image and tap Save
.
Note: To ensure the Camcorder can record the
Assigning an Image as a Wallpaper
1. From the Home screen, tap
video, use an SDHC memory card.
(
Applications) ➔
(Gallery).
Shooting Video
2. Select a folder location and tap a file to
Tip: When shooting video in direct sunlight or in
bright conditions, it is recommended that you
provide your subject with sufficient light by
having the light source behind you.
open it.
3. With the image displayed, press
then tap Set as.
and
4. Select one of the two options:
• Home screen Wallpaper assigns the current
image to the home screen background. This
image is spread across all available screens.
• Lock screen Wallpaper assigns the selected
image to the background for the lock screen.
5. Touch and drag the crop box anywhere on
the picture. Touch and drag the sides of
the crop box to zoom in or out to create a
cropped area.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Camera)
to activate the camera mode.
2. Tap and slide the Camera mode button
down to Camcorder Mode.
3. Using the phone’s main display screen as a
viewfinder, adjust the image by aiming the
camcorder at the subject.
4. Tap the Video key (
) to begin shooting
video. The red light will blink while
recording.
6. Tap Save to assign the wallpaper image.
– or –
5. Tap the Video key (
) again to stop the
Tap Discard to stop without updating the
wallpaper image.
recording and save the video file to your
Camera folder.
6. Once the file has been saved, tap the
Using the Camcorder
In addition to taking photos, the camera also
doubles as a camcorder that also allows you to
record, view, and send high definition videos.
image viewer, then tap
video for review.
to play your
7. Press
to return to the viewer.
Multimedia
121
Camcorder Options
You can change options using your keypad in
capture mode. The following short cuts are
available:
Settings:
Edit shortcuts: allows you to set shortcut
icons for the settings that you use the
most.
Flash: allows you to set the flash options
toOfforOn.WhenyousettheflashtoOn,
it stays on continually while you are
taking a video.
Recording mode: allows you to set the
recording mode to: Normal, which is
limited only by available space on the
destination location, Limit for MMS,
whichislimitedbyMMSsizerestrictions,
and Self recording which activates the
front-facing camera so you can video
yourself.
Recording mode: allows you to set the
recording mode to:
•
•
•
Normal: is limited only by available
space on the destination location.
Limit for MMS: is limited by MMS size
restrictions.
Flash: allows you to set the flash options
toOfforOn.WhenyousettheflashtoOn,
it stays on continually while you are
taking a video.
Self-recording: activates the front-
facing camera so you can video
yourself.
Exposure value: allows you to adjust the
brightness level by moving the slider.
Timer: allows you to set a timer for how
long to wait before taking a video.
Optionsinclude:Off, 2sec, 5sec, and10
sec.
122
Settings (continued):
Image viewer: allows you to access the
Image viewer and the various viewing
options for a selected video. Image
viewer options are described in the
following section. The last video you
took, will be displayed as a thumbnail in
the Image viewer icon.
Effects: allows you to change the color
toneorapplyspecialeffectstothephoto.
Options include: None, Negative,
Grayscale, and Sepia.
Resolution: allows you to set the image
size to either: 640x480, 320x240, or
176x144.
Accessing Videos
White balance: allows you to set this
option to one of the following choices:
Auto, Daylight, Cloudy, Incandescent, or
Fluorescent.
When you shoot a video, the file is saved in the
Camera folder. You can view your videos
immediately or view them anytime in the Camera
folder.
Storage: allows you to configure the
default storage location for images or
videosaseitherPhoneorMemorycard(if
inserted).
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Gallery).
2. Select a folder location and tap a video
icon to begin video playback.
– or –
Reset: allows you to reset all camera or
camcordersettingstothedefaultvalues.
Touch and hold the video icon from the
main Gallery to select the video (green
check mark) and display the following
video menu context options:
Camera / Camcorder Mode: allows you to
take a photo in various modes. Once you
change the mode, the corresponding
indicator appears at the top left of the
display. Slide the button up for Camera
mode or down for Camcorder mode.
• Send via: allows you to share a video using
Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, Messaging, Kodak, and
Snapfish.
Camcorder button: shoots and stops
video recording when pressed in
Camcorder mode.
Multimedia
123
• Delete
:
allows you to delete chosen/selected
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Files).
pictures. Tap the checkmark, to turn it green, next to
(
(
any file or folder you want to delete, then tap Confirm
Note: Navigation in this viewer works on a
hierarchy structure with folders, subfolders,
etc.
deletions
.
• More: provides you with the additional options
such as:
–
–
–
–
Share via: allows you to share your file via
YouTube.
Opening and Navigating within Files
DCIM is the default location for pictures or video
taken by the device. These files are actually
stored in the DCIM folder location.
Play via: allows you to play your selected via
AllShare.
Rename: allows you to rename one or more
video files.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Files).
Send to: allows you to send the file to a
Contacts entry, New Email address, or New
Phone number.
2. Tap a folder and scroll down or up until you
locate your selected file.
• Up tab allows you to back up into a higher
directory.
–
Set Default Destination: allows you to assign a
default action to take after taking an image
(Contacts, New Email address, or New Phone
number).
• Home tab allows you to back up to the root
directory.
•
Press
way the files are displayed on-screen. Choose
from: List List and details, or Thumbnail
Press for these additional options: Share
Create folder Delete View by List by, and
More (Move, Copy, Rename, and Settings).
and then tap View by to change the
–
Details: displays video file information.
,
.
Files
•
,
Files allows you to manage your sounds, images,
videos, Bluetooth files, Android files, and other
memory card data in one convenient location.
This application allows you to launch a file if the
associated application is already on your phone
(ex: MP4).
,
,
,
3. Once you have located your file, tap the file
name to launch the associated application.
124
1. From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Videos). A list of
The Gallery
(
(
The Gallery is where you view photos and play
back videos. For photos, you can also perform
basic editing tasks, view a slideshow, set photos
as wallpaper or caller image, and share as a
picture message.
videos sorted on the SD card displays in
the Video list.
2. Tap a video file to begin viewing.
Media Hub
Samsung Media Hub is your one stop for the
hottest movie and TV content. With hundreds of
titles available, entertaining your family on the go
was never easier. You can rent or purchase your
favorite content and watch from any location.
Featuring the stunning viewing quality Samsung
is known for, Samsung Media Hub is your
gateway to mobile video like you've never
experienced it before.
Note: If the phone displays a memory full
message when accessing the Gallery,
access Files and remove some of the media
files from the folders, and then open the
Gallery.
Opening the Gallery
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
(
(
Note: Media Hub usage is based on service
availability.
Note: If you stored your files in folders (directories)
on the storage card, Gallery displays these
folders as separate albums. The top left
album contains all the pictures in the
storage card.
Important! You must be using an active Wi-Fi/4G
connection to preview and download a
media file.
You must have a microSD card
installed prior to initiating the service.
This card acts as a storage location for
your downloaded rental or purchase.
Using the Video Player
TheVideoPlayerapplicationplaysvideofilesstored
on the SD card.
Multimedia
125
• My Media: allows you to view all of the media
that you have purchased or rented. Touch a
media entry to view it.
Creating a New Media Hub Account
Before you can rent or buy media, you must first
create an account. Enter the required
information.
• Movie Store: displays movies that are available
for rent or purchase. Scroll through the movie
categories at the top of the screen. Touch a
category and movies of that type display.
• TV Store: displays TV shows that are available
for purchase. Scroll through the movie
categories at the top of the screen. Touch a
category and TV shows of that type display.
4. Scroll through the media listings and tap
on an item you would like to purchase or
rent.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(MediaHub).
2. If prompted, read the End-User License
Agreement (EULA) and tap Accept to
continue or Decline to exit.
3. Press
and then tap My Account.
4. Use the keypad to enter the required
information, then tap Create Account
Follow the on-screen instructions to
complete your registration.
.
5. From the My Account screen, you can edit
5. Tap WATCH PREVIEW to watch a short
parameters such as: My Details
Purchases My Payment Methods
My Devices Log out, or Reset Media Hub
,
My
preview or tap Rent or Own.
,
,
Manage
6. Choose a payment method and then follow
the on-screen instructions. The media
stores to the My Media folder.
,
.
Using Media Hub
1. From the Home screen, tap
Media Hub Notices
Any media item (Media Content) may be rented or
purchased after you create an account in Media
Hub.
(
Applications) ➔
(MediaHub).
•
•
•
2. Read the End-User License Agreement
(EULA) and tap Accept to continue or
Decline to exit.
Media Content that is downloaded may be viewed
concurrently on up to five (5) devices with Media
Hub that are also registered to the same account.
You may choose to remove a device from your
account no more than once every 30 days.
3. At the Media Hub screen select one of the
following options:
• What’s new: shows recently added media that
is available for rent or purchase.
126
•
You may remove Media Content from a device as
many times as you’d like. You will have the ability to
re-download the Media Content at a later point in
time subject to content re-download availability and
studio permissions.
•
In no event will rented Media Content be
available for a period of more than thirty (30)
days (or shorter on a title-by-title basis) after the
Media Content has been rented (e.g., if you
begin viewing rented Media Content on the 29th
day after the rental transaction, but do not finish
viewing the entire title, that rented Media
Content may not be available for the entire
twenty-four (24) consecutive hour period if such
period would extend the viewable time beyond
the thirty (30) day rental window).
•
•
•
You MUST be in network coverage to license Media
Content you have acquired through the Service.
You must have Wi-Fi connectivity in order to
download Media Content.
Unlike purchased Media Content, rented Media
Content will be viewable on only 1 device in your
account.
•
You cannot play any media content downloaded
from Media Hub through any output on your mobile
phone, including All Share.
•
•
•
Media Content is downloaded and saved onto the
SD card.
Music
Your Media Content may pause/stop or not
download in networks where there is a weak signal.
You may begin watching downloaded Media Content
as soon as a) license acquisition has occurred and
b) sufficient amount of the Media Content has been
buffered.
Playing Music
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
player tips display.
2. Tap Done
3. Tap a tab to select the music category: All
Playlists Albums, or Artists
(Music). Music
.
•
You must finish watching rented Media Content
within 24 consecutive hours of start of playback.
,
,
.
•
Stopping, pausing or restarting rented Media
Content does not extend the available viewing
time.
4. Scroll through the list and tap an entry to
begin playback.
Note: The 5.1 channel sound effect works when
earphones or sound is connected through
the headset jack only.
Multimedia
127
5. The following controls are available once a
Making a Song a Phone Ringtone
1. From the Home screen, tap
song is played:
(
Applications) ➔
(Music).
Pause the song.
2. Tap the All tab.
Start the song after pausing.
3. Touch and hold a song from the list to
Pressandholdtorewindthesong.Tap
to go to previous song.
reveal the on-screen context menu.
4. Tap Set as
➔
Phone ringtone.
Press and hold to fast-forward the
song. Tap to go to next song.
Volume control.
Music Player Options
The Music Player Settings menu allows you to
set preferences for the music player such as
whether you want the music to play in the
background, sound effects, and how the music
menu displays.
5.1Ch
Allowsyoutolistentomusicusing5.1
Virtual Surround Sound.
( ( ) )
Plays the entire song list once.
ꢀ
With the music player application
displayed and playing a song, press
and select one of the following options:
• Add to quick list: adds the selected music file to
a quick playlist.
Replays the current list when the list
ends.
Repeats the currently playing song.
shuffles the current list of songs
randomly.
• Via Bluetooth: plays the music through a
Bluetooth stereo headset.
songs play in order and are not
shuffled.
• Share music via: shares a music file via
AllShare, Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, or Messaging.
• Set as: sets this song as a Phone ringtone,
Caller ringtone, or Alarm tone.
lists the current playlist songs
List
[song name]
displaysthecurrentsongintheplayer
window
• Add to playlist: adds a song to the playlist.
• More
:
128
–
Settings: allows you to activate or deactivate the
Equalizer, Sound effects, Music menu, or
Visualization. The Music menu allows you to
decide what you want to display. Selections are:
Albums, Artists, Genres, Folders, Composers,
Years, Most played, Recently played, or Recently
added. Tap each item that you want to display in
the Music menu.
Adding Music to a Playlist
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Music).
2. Tap the Playlists tab.
3. Tap the playlist name in which to add
music.
4. Press
and then tap Add.
– or –
–
–
Details: displays details about the selected
music.
Tap
(Add music).
Stop playing music: stops playing the
currently selected song or playlist.
Note: If a playlist is empty, add a song by touching
a holding a song name from the main
screen to open the context menu. Select
Using Playlists
Add to playlist
.
Playlists are used to assign music files into
groups for playback. These Playlists can be
created using the Music player on this device, or
using a third-party application (such as Windows
Media Player) and downloading those files to an
SD card inserted into the device.
5. Tap a music file, or tap Select all to add all
the music tracks to this playlist then tap
Add
.
Removing Music from a Playlist
1. From the Home screen, tap
Creating a Playlist
(
Applications) ➔
(Music).
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. Tap the Playlists tab.
3. Press and then tap Create
(Music).
2. Tap the Playlists tab.
3. Tap the playlist name in which to delete
music.
.
4. Touch and hold a song to reveal the on-
screen context menu.
4. Backspace over the default playlist title
and type a new name for this playlist, then
tap Save
.
5. Tap Remove
➔
OK.
Multimedia
129
Editing a Playlist
Besides adding and removing music files in a
playlist, you can also share, delete, or rename
the playlist.
Removing Music Files
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Music).
2. Tap the All tab.
Only those playlist you have created can be
edited. Default playlists can not be renamed.
1. From the Home screen, tap
3. Touch and hold a song entry to reveal the
on-screen context menu.
4. Tap Delete
➔
OK. The music file(s) is
(
Applications) ➔
(Music).
deleted.
2. Tap the Playlists tab.
T-Mobile TV HD
T-Mobile TV HD is an application that allows you
to get both live Standard and High definition TV
and Video on Demand.
3. Touch and hold a playlist entry to reveal
the on-screen context menu.
4. Tap Edit title
5. Enter a new name for this playlist and tap
Save
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
.
(
Applications) ➔
(T-Mobile TV HD).
Transferring Music Files
Music files can be downloaded to the phone
using one of two methods:
The T-Mobile Terms and Conditions page
displays.
Note: A data plan is required to use this feature.
Charges may apply. Please contact your
service provider for further details.
1. Downloaded to the phone from or Android
Market. Music files are directly stored on
your phone.
2. Downloaded to the phone via a direct USB
connection. Music files are stored into a
Music folder on the SD card.
2. Tap Accept if you accept the Terms and
Conditions.
– or –
Tap Exit to close the application.
Note: It is recommended that you place your
music into either a media or music folder. If
these doe not currently exist in your card,
you should create them prior to transfer.
130
Note: T-Mobile TV must be initialized over a
cellular network before it can be used.
During this initial registration process, any
current Wi-Fi connections must be disabled.
3. Tap Disable Wi-Fi if you currently have an
active Wi-Fi connection.
4. Tap Start Trial to begin a free 30-day trial of
the service.
5. Tap any of the following categories to
begin viewing: Live TV
,
On Demand, My
media More Info Browse, or Live Channels.
,
,
YouTube
YouTube is a video sharing website on which
users can upload and share videos, and view
them in MPEG-4 format.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. Tap Accept if you accept the Terms and
Conditions, or tap Exit
(YouTube).
.
3. When the screen loads you can begin
searching and viewing posted videos.
4. Press
➔
Settings
➔
High quality on
mobile if you prefer high quality output.
Multimedia
131
Section 9: Applications and Development
This section outlines the various applications
that are available on your phone.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Accounts and sync).
(
(
Applications
The Applications list provides quick access to all
the available applications on the phone.
AllShare
description of each Application, its function, and
how to navigate through that particular
application. If the application is already
described in another section of this user manual,
then a cross reference to that particular section
is provided.
This application wirelessly synchronizes your
Samsung mobile phone with your TV, streams
content and even keeps tabs on who calls or
sends text messages with real-time, on-screen
monitoring. Samsung’s AllShare makes staying
connected easy.
Allows users to share their in-device media
content with other external devices using DLNA
certified™ (Digital Living Network Alliance)
Devices. These external devices must also be
DLNA-compliant. Wi-Fi capability can be
provided to TVs via a digital multimedia
streamer.
411 & More
Provides more than just single tap access to
directory assistance and other portals. Available
categories include: 411 Directory Assistance,
Current Weather, and more.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(411 & More).
Important! You must activate Wi-Fi to use this
application. For more information,
2. Tap an on-screen options and follow the
on-screen prompts.
Accounts and sync
1. From the Home screen, tap
This application allows you to configure general
synchronization settings that determine whether
the background data is synchronized, and
whether you automatically synchronize data with
the phone.
(
Applications) ➔
(AllShare).
2. Follow the on-screen prompts.
132
The application contains two separate streaming
media options:
• Default memory: allows you to have media
saved to your Phone or Memory Card. Tap an
option.
• My device allows you to stream/share selected
multimedia content from your device to DLNA
compliant device connected to the same WAP.
• Subtitles: allows you to see subtitles on shared
media.
• Remote device allows you to receive and
playback media stored externally (server, laptop,
etc.) directly on your device.
Depending on the setting you changed, a
pop-up screen may display to restart
AllShare. Tap Yes to continue.
Configuring AllShare Settings
Transmitting Media via AllShare
The AllShare™ application must first be
configured prior to its initial use. You must setup
parameters such as connected Wi-FI, Items to
share, source server address, and external
device acceptance rights.
1. Tap the My device tab, select Videos
,
Photos, or Music, and then tap on the
media that you would like to share.
2. At the Select device screen, any devices
that you can share with are displayed.
3. Tap on a device to share media.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Applications) ➔
(AllShare).
Receiving Media via AllShare
1. Tap the Remote device tab at the top of the
screen.
2. Press and then tap Settings and
configure the following settings as desired:
• Device name: defaults to your phone. Use the
keypad to enter a new Media server if desired,
All devices that you can receive media
from are displayed.
and tap Save
.
• Share video/photos/audio: allows you to
restrict what is shared from your phone. Tap the
items you want to share.
2. Tap a device name. Media that you can
receive from the other device is listed.
•
Tap an item that you want to stream to your
phone.
• Upload from other devices: allows you set the
phone to select how uploads from other devices
3. Press
to return to the previous page.
are started. Tap Always accept
,
Always ask, or
Always reject
.
Applications and Development
133
3. Once installed, locate the Widget on your
screen and tap Launch
4. Follow the on-screen prompts.
Bejeweled 2
.
Bejeweled 2 is a free web-based game, sequel
to Bejeweled. Start by clicking two adjacent
pieces to create a line of three or more identical
gems.
Books
Use Google Books to read over 3 million ebooks
on the go.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Bejeweled 2).
(
(
Note: This application might be updated after
connection. This would require a user to
follow the on-screen instructions to update
the related application icon and features.
Blio
Blio is an eReading application that presents
eBooks just like the printed version, in full color,
and with all of the features you’d want from an
eReader.
Build your ebooks library in the cloud with
Google Books: jump right into a bestseller or
select from nearly 3 million free ebooks.
Personalize the reader to your liking, pick up
reading where you left off on your phone or
computer, and settle down with a great book on
your Android phone!
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. Read the on-screen welcome information
and tap Close
3. Tap an available on-screen option and
follow the prompts. Choose from: Get
Shop Search, and Read
(blio).
.
,
1. From the Home screen, tap
,
.
(
Applications) ➔
(Books).
Bonus Apps
2. If prompted, tap Turn sync on. This
synchronizes your books you have
previously selected between your Books
account and your device.
Provides the procedures necessary to install the
T-Mobile Bonus Apps Widget that allows you to
discover those applications that are compatible
specifically with your phone.
3. Tap
to begin searching for both free
1. From the Home screen, tap
and paid ebooks.
(
Applications) ➔
(Bonus Apps).
4. Follow the on-screen prompts to download
2. Read the Widget installation and tap OK
.
the ebook to your phone.
134
Calculator
Important! You must have previously added an
account (Facebook, Microsoft
Using this feature you can use the phone as a
calculator. The calculator provides the basic
arithmetic functions; addition, subtraction,
multiplication, and division. You can also use this
as a scientific calculator.
Exchange ActiveSync, or Google) prior
to using the Calendar.
1. From the Home screen, tap
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Calendar). The
(Applications) ➔
(Calculator).
Calendar displays four tabs:
• Month: displays the Month view.
• Week: displays the Week view.
• Day: displays the Day view.
2. Enter the first number using the numeric
keys.
3. Enter the operation for your calculation by
tapping the Plus, Minus, Multiplication, or
Division key.
• List: allows you to search for events for the
selected Month, Week, or Day, or you can look
for events for a future date.
4. Enter the next number.
5. To view the result, tap the = (equals) key.
6. Repeat steps 1 to 4 as many times as
required.
2. Press
options:
and select one of the following
• Create: creates a new Event.
• Go to: displays a specific date.
Note: Place the screen in Landscape mode to
• Today: displays the date highlighted with a Blue
box highlighting the date.
reveal additional scientific functions.
• Search: allows you to search within current
events.
Calendar
With the Calendar feature, you can consult the
calendar by day, week, or month, create events,
and set an alarm to act as a reminder. Google
Calendar is built into the phone and synchronizes
both new and existing entries between your
phone and your online Google account.
• Delete: allows you to delete All events, All events
before today, or an individual event.
• Settings: displays a list of configurable settings.
Applications and Development
135
To manually sync calendar events:
1. Press and then tap
Accounts and sync
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Camera).
➔
➔
(
(
.
2. Locate the email account containing the
events you wish to synchronize.
Clock
3. Tap
within the adjacent account field
Here you can set an alarm, configure and view
the World clock, use a stopwatch, set a timer,
and display the desk clock. The applications
display in a tabular format and quickly accessed
with the touch of a finger.
to reveal the account’s synchronization
settings screen.
4. Tap Sync Calendar to activate the
synchronization of calendar events
between your device and the remote
exchange server. A green checkmark
indicates the feature is enabled.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Clock).
(
(
Contacts
The default storage location for saving phone
numbers to your Contacts List is your phone’s
built-in memory.
Downloads
Provides quick access to tabs containing a list of
your current downloaded files (Internet and
Other).
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Downloads).
Camera
Use your 3.0 megapixel camera feature to produce
photosinaJPEGformat.TheCamcordershootsHigh
Definition video in an MP4 format.
2. Tap an available file category tab (Internet
downloads or Other downloads) and select
the desired file. Compatible document
formats can be opened by Polaris Office
Note: An SD card must be inserted before the
Camera will take and store photos.
136
Email
Gmail
Email enables you to review and create email
using most email services. The device alerts you
when you receive an email message.
Google Mail (Gmail) is a web-based email
service. Gmail is configured when you first set
up your phone. Depending on your
synchronization settings, Gmail can
automatically synchronize with your Gmail
account on the web.
Files
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Gmail).
Organize and store data, images, and more in
your own personal file folders. Files are stored to
the memory card in separate (user defined)
folders.
(
(
Google Search
Use Google Search to search the Web.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Files).
(
(
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Google Search) and
(
(
Gallery
enter the search text.
– or –
The Gallery is where you view photos and play
back videos. For photos, you can also perform
basic editing tasks, view a slideshow, set photos
as wallpaper or caller image, and share as a
picture message.
Tap
on the Google Search bar and
say the search information.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Gallery).
(
(
Applications and Development
137
3. Enable options within these stations/
Highlight
channels.
This downloadable application/widget allows you
to stay up to date on relevant news, Android
Market apps and games (specific to your phone),
T-Mobile ringtones, CallerTunes and more.
1. From the Home screen, tap
4. Press
to exit the application.
Kies air
Kies air allows you to sync your Windows PC
wirelessly with your phone provided they are
both on the same Wi-Fi network. You can view
and share call logs, videos, photos, music,
bookmarks, ringtones, and even send SMS
messages from your PC.
(
Applications) ➔
(Highlight).
2. Follow the on-screen installation
instructions. Locate a screen with enough
room to place the new widget onto.
3. Tap
access the Quick Launch Bar and
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Kies air).
manage your selected apps (channels/
stations) of selected information.
4. Enable or disable apps and press
exit the bar.
(
(
to
Latitude
5. The Highlight application then displays
Google Latitude allows you and your friends
share locations and status messages with each
other. It also lets you send instant messages and
emails, make phone calls, and get directions to
your friends’ locations.
information corresponding to the channel
categories you selected.
To adjust the Highlight settings:
1. Locate the on-screen Highlight application.
2. Tap
(Settings) from the upper-right of
Important! You must sign in to your Google
account, enable Wi-Fi, and enable the
Location feature before you can use
this application. For more information,
the application to access the Highlight
Settings page.
•
From here you can manage content, access the
Quick Launch Bar, and review information about
the application such as: About, Terms &
Conditions, and Third Party License Agreements.
138
2. Press
3. Tap Select from Contacts or Add via email
address
4. Tap a contact or enter an email address,
then tap Add friends
➔
Add friends.
Note: Although you do not have to enable location
services in order to use Latitude, it is
recommended for best accuracy.
.
.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Latitude).
5. Tap Yes at the Send sharing requests
prompt.
Important! For best results, it is recommended
that you enable all of your location
Your friend will receive an email or text
message with your location marked on a
map. They will also receive instructions on
how to view your location from the web or
use Latitude on their phone or tablet
provided it is available. Once they
acknowledge your request, their location
will display on your tablet. They can share
their location from their computer, phone,
or tablet. For more information, go to
services. For more information, refer to
2. Tap Share location with family or friends to
share your location and launch the Friends
screen.
3. Tap Wi-Fi Disabled - Click to enable
connection to navigate to the Wi-Fi Settings
menu where you can turn on Wi-Fi if it is
4. If prompted with the Improve My Location
screen, tap Settings to configure the
necessary settings or Skip to continue on
without making a change.
6. To view the map, press
Latitude Options
.
➔
See map.
ꢀ
From the map display, press
to
display the following options:
• Search: allows you to search for a place of
interest.
Sharing your Location with Friends
1. From the Latitude map screen, tap
to
• Directions: displays navigation directions to a
location from a starting point.
display your Latitude friends. At first, only
your name is displayed.
Applications and Development
139
• Clear Map: allows you to remove all markings
and layers from the map.
Lookout Anti-Virus
The Lookout™ Anti-Virus security application
provides mobile device-specific security features
that are coupled with a minimal performance hit.
This application provides key security options
that are unique to the mobile market. Along with
the antivirus and anti-malware tech, there's a
lost and stolen phone locator service, an
application privacy adviser, and a backup
service.
• More: provides access to additional features
such as: Map, Places, Navigation, Latitude,
Location history, and My Places.
• Settings: allows you to select the following
additional options:
–
Cache Settings: allows you to set options to
pre-fetch map tiles when not using Wi-Fi and to
clear the cache that holds the map tiles.
Location reporting: allows you to configure the
location reporting parameters.
1. From the Home screen, tap
–
–
(
Applications) ➔
(Lookout Anti-Virus).
2. Read the on-screen descriptions and tap
Get started to begin your configuration.
3. Read the on-screen information about
Security and if desired, tap the Enable
Security field to activate the feature.
Labs: this is a testing ground for experimental
features that aren’t ready for primetime. They
may change, break or disappear at any time.
Click on a Lab to enable or disable it.
Terms, Privacy & Notices: displays the Terms
and Conditions, Privacy Policy, o r Legal Notices
information. Select the desired information from
the pop-up menu.
–
–
–
4. Tap Next
.
5. Read the on-screen information about
Backup and if desired, tap the Enable
Backup field to activate the feature.
About: displays general information about
Google maps such as Version, Platform, Locale,
Total data sent, Total data received, Free
memory, etc.
6. Tap Next
.
7. Read the on-screen information about the
feature that can help locate your missing
phone and if desired, tap the New user (to
setup a new account) or Existing user (to
log into your account field to activate the
feature.
Help: displays the Google Mobile Help web
page where you can receive help on Google
Maps.
140
8. Tap Start Lookout
.
Enabling a Location source
From the main application, the main features are
presented as buttons. Tap one to reveal a button
that will run the feature.
Before you use Google Maps and find your
location or search for places of interest, you
must enable a location source. To enable the
location source you must enable the wireless
network, or enable the GPS satellites.
Maps
Google Maps allow you to track your current
location, view real-time traffic issues, and view
detailed destination directions. There is also a
search tool included to help you locate places of
interest or a specific address. You can view
locations on a vector or aerial map, or you can
view locations at the street level.
Important! The more location determining
functions are enabled, the more
accurate the determination will be of
your position.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Location and security
.
Important! Before using Google Maps you must
have an active data (3G/4G) or Wi-Fi
connection. The Maps application does
not cover every country or city.
2. Tap Use wireless networks to enable GPS to
determine location based on nearby cell
towers.
3. Tap Use GPS satellites to enable the GPS
satellite.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Maps).
(
(
4. Tap Use sensor aiding to enhance
positioning and save power using sensors.
Important! For best results, it is recommended
that you enable all of your location
Tip: When using Google Maps you can turn on
Enable GPS satellites. Selecting GPS satellites
allows you to locate places of interest at the
street-level. However, this also requires a
clear view of the sky and uses more battery
power.
services. For more information, refer to
Applications and Development
141
–
–
Transit Lines: displays the overlapping transit
lines on your map.
Opening Maps
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Maps).
Latitude: allows you to see your friend's
locations and share your location with them.
My Maps: displays a list of your preferred maps.
Bicycling: displays the overlapping cycling trails
on your map.
2. Locate the top row of the applications to
access additional options:
–
–
• Search Maps: allows you to search for a place
of interest.
• Places: provides access to the places menu
where you can quickly locate a business or
person, find out more information about a
business, see coupons, public responses, and
listed places (Restaurants, Coffee, Bars,
Attractions, ATMs, Gas Stations, Explore Nearby,
or Add your own place.)
–
Wikipedia: displays any Wikipedia markers and
info on your map.
• My Location: when touched, the location
displays on the map with a blinking blue dot.
3. Press
options:
and select one of the following
• Search: allows you to search for a place of
interest.
A list of places within this category displays.
• Layers: allows you to switch map views:
• Directions: displays navigation directions to a
location from a starting point.
–
Traffic: (available only in selected areas) Real-
time traffic conditions are displayed over roads
as color-coded lines. Each color represents how
fast the traffic is moving.
• My Places: marks favorite locations on the map.
These items are automatically synchronized with
maps.
• Clear Map: after viewing or following directions,
this option resets the map.
–
Satellite: Maps uses the same satellite data as
Google Earth. Satellite images are not real-time.
Google Earth acquires the best imagery
available, most of which is approximately one to
three years old.
• Join Latitude: lets you and your friends share
locations and status messages with each other.
It also lets you send instant messages and
emails, make phone calls, and get directions to
your friends’ locations.
–
Terrain: combines a topographical view of the
area’s terrain with the current map location.
142
• More
:
Note: This application might be updated after
connection. This would require a user to
follow the on-screen instructions to update
the related application icon and features.
–
Labs: a testing ground for experimental features
that are not ready to use publically.
–
Cache Settings: provides the ability to setup
maps that are cached into the phone’s memory
(while not on a Wi-Fi connection) or to clear the
cache of map titles.
Accessing the Market
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. If not already logged in with your Google
account, tap Next
(Market).
–
–
Help: uses the browser to display a searchable
Google Mobile Help screen.
.
Terms, Privacy & Notices: displays the Terms
and Conditions, Privacy Policy, or Legal Notices
information. Select the desired information from
the pop-up menu.
3. Tap Sign in and enter your Google account
information.
4. Tap Accept to agree to the Android Market
terms of service.
–
About: displays general information about
Google maps such as Version, Platform, Locale,
Total data sent, Total data received, Free
memory, etc.
Downloading a New Google
Application
Market
Android Market provides access to downloadable
applications and games to install on your phone.
Android Market also allows you to provide
feedback and comments about an application, or
flag an application that might be incompatible
with your phone.
To download a new application, you will need to
use your Google account to sign in to Android
Market. The Android Market home page provides
several ways to find applications. The home
page features applications and includes a list of
item applications by category, a list of games, a
link to search, and a link to My apps.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Market).
Applications and Development
143
2. Browse through the categories, find an
application you're interested in, and tap
the name.
7. After the item is downloaded and installed
on your phone, the content download icon
appears in the notification area of
the status bar.
3. Read the application descriptions.
8. On the Android Market screen, press
and then tap My apps, tap the installed
Important! If the selected application requires
access to data or control of a function
on your phone, Market displays the
application in the list, and then tap Open
.
information the application will access.
Tip: The newly downloaded applications display in
the applications list and are shown in
alphabetical order if the View Type is set to
Alphabetical grid or Alphabetical list, or at the
end of the list if View type is set to
Tap OK if you agree to the conditions of
the application. Once you tap OK on
this screen you are responsible for
using this application on the phone
and the amount of data it uses. Use
this feature with caution.
Customizable grid.
Note: A data plan is required to use this feature.
Charges may apply. Please contact your
service provider for further details.
4. Tap Install
.
Note: Use caution with applications which request
access to any personal data, functions, or
significant amounts of data usage times.
Launching an Installed Google
Application
1. From the Home screen, tap
5. If prompted, follow the on-screen
instructions to pay for the application.
6. Check the progress of the current
download by opening the Notifications
panel.
(
Applications).
2. Tap the newly installed application. This
application is typically located on the last
Applications page.
144
the remaining memory and resources for each of
the applications on your phone and clear the
data, cache, or defaults.
Android Development
This device can be used for Android application
development. You can write applications in the
SDK and install them on this device, then run the
applications using the hardware, system, and
network.
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
Manage
(Settings) ➔ Applications
➔
applications
.
Clearing application cache and data
Warning! Android Dev Phones are not intended for
non-developer end-users. Because the
device can be configured with system
software not provided by or supported
by Google or any other company, end-
users operate these devices at their own
risk.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Applications
applications
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Manage
.
2. Tap an application in which to clear the
cache or data.
3. Tap Force stop Uninstall, Clear data, Move
,
to SD card, Clear cache, or Clear defaults
Uninstalling third-party applications
You can uninstall any application you
.
Unknown sources
This feature can be used for Android application
development. The feature allows developers to
install non-Market applications.
downloaded and installed from Android Market.
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Applications Manage
applications
2. Tap the third-party application, and from
the Application info screen, tap Uninstall
➔
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Applications
sources
➔
and then tap
(
➔
(
➔
Unknown
.
.
Unknown sources displays a check mark
to indicate it is active.
.
Media Hub
Manage applications
This feature allows you to manage and remove
installed applications. You can also view the
amount of memory or resources used as well as
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔ MediaHub).
(
Applications and Development
145
• Sort by: allows you to sort by Date or Color.
Memo
• More: provides the following options:
This feature allows you to create a memo.
–
–
–
SNS log in: allows you to log into your
1. From the Home screen, tap
Facebook, Twitter, or Linkedin accounts.
Sync memo: allows you to sync your memos
Google Docs or send individual memos.
PIN lock: allows you to set a PIN lock so that a
PIN must be entered before reading a memo.
(
Applications) ➔
(Memo).
2. Tap Create memo
.
Note: If this is your first memo, you are
automatically taken to the new memo
screen.
2. Touch and hold the memo then select Send
and choose the method to send this
3. Compose the memo.
memo: Bluetooth Email, or Messaging.
,
4. Press
Save
and select a color, then tap
3. From the memo list, touch the upper-left
.
edit button and select a color for the
memo’s background, then tap Save
.
Messaging
Memo options
This application allows you to use the Short
Message Service (SMS) to send and receive
short text messages to and from other mobile
phones.
1. While viewing the list of Memos, press
and select one of the following
options:
• Create: allows you to create a memo.
• Delete: allows you to delete one or more
memos.
You can also use the Multi Media Service (MMS)
to create multimedia messages to send and
receive from other mobile phones.
• Search: allows you to search within the current
set of memos.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Messaging).
(
(
• Send: allows you to send one or several of your
memos at one time. Select a memo and tap
send to deliver it via: Bluetooth, Email, or
Messaging.
146
3. Tap Auto update if you want the settings to
Mini Diary
automatically update.
This application allows you to create a mini diary
where you can add a photo, and text to describe
an event or other memorable life event.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Deleting a Mini Diary entry
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
.
(Applications) ➔
(Mini Diary). Any
2. Press
and then tap Delete all.
diary entries display in a list.
2. If prompted, tap Yes to allow required
network connectivity.
Mini Diary options
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. Select a diary.
3. Press and select one of the following
options:
.
3. Tap the Tap to add photo field to add a
photo for this diary event and touch the
source. Selections are: Camera, or Gallery
.
4. Tap the Add location area of the screen,
• Create: creates a new diary entry.
• Delete: deletes the displayed entry.
• Edit: allows you to edit the current diary entry.
• Change photo: replaces the photo in this entry
by allowing you to take another photo or use
another image.
enter text, then tap Done
5. Tap the Tap to add text area of the screen
and enter text then tap Done
.
.
6. Tap the weather data icon in the upper,
right corner (above the photo) and select a
weather condition from the list to describe
the weather conditions for this entry.
• Delete photo: deletes the photo from this entry
when you touch Yes to confirm.
7. Tap Save
.
• More: provides additional options such as:
Publish (SNS service such as Facebook) and
Send via (to deliver the entry via either Email or
Messaging).
Mini Diary settings
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. From the main Diary listings page, press
and then tap Settings
(Mini Diary).
.
Applications and Development
147
• Settings: Provides access to configuration
settings such as: Get Better Deals, Connect with
Facebook, and Terms & Conditions.
More for Me
Provides customized offers, discounts and deals
right to your phone by providing some brief
customer and location information. The
application uses your current location to bring
you the best deals in your area.
Music
This application allows you to play music files
that you have stored on your microSD card. You
can also create playlists.
Initial Setup
1. From the Home screen, tap
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Music).
(
Applications) ➔
(More for Me).
(
(
2. Read the on-screen information and
configure the necessary options such as:
Gender, Age, and agreements.
3. Tap Continue to complete the setup
process.
My Account
This option provides you with account specific
information such as your current activity, billing
information, and Plan Services information. You
can also set alerts for minute or message usage,
payment reminder, or power saver.
Using the More for Me Application
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(More for Me).
2. Access an available tab for more options:
• Just for Me: displays a listing of current offers
available within your current area.
Note: You may be prompted to log into the Android
Market to receive the latest version of the T-
Mobile My Account application.
• All Deals: Provides you with common categories
to choose from, such as: Food & Drinks, Health
& Beauty, Retail & Service, Activities, Events,
Other, and All nearby.
The differences between My Account and My
Device are these:
• My Account: check Activity, set Alerts and
Events, review Billing, and review your current
Plan and services.
• My Deals: displays a list of previously redeemed
offers.
• My Device: access Support, view Quick Tools,
Personalize settings, and Storage & Battery.
148
–
–
Message Usage: tracks the number of
messages used and remaining in your plan. If
you plan includes unlimited messages this
setting does not apply.
Tip: Use the Menu key to toggle between My
Account and My Device.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Data Usage: tracks data used and remaining in
your plan. If you plan includes unlimited data
usage this setting does not apply.
(
Applications) ➔
2. Read the on-screen information and tap
OK
(My Account).
.
–
–
Payment Reminder: alerts when your bill is
due.
The initial screen displays four tabs: Activity, Set
Alerts, Billing, and Plan.
Power Saver: sends an alert when the battery
level reaches 30 percent. The alert displays in
the notification window. This alert is
Activity
The Activity tab displays your current minute and
message activity. You can view what percentage
of minutes were used as well as the number of
messages used for a particular start date.
automatically set to On
.
–
Support Alerts: allows you to enable
automated troubleshooting.
Alerts and Events
From this screen you can activate alerts to notify
you of the following:
• Recent Oder Status: Displays details about your
recent orders.
• Account Events: provides details about your
recent account events.
• Alert Settings: sets when you would receive
alerts for the following:
–
Minute Usage: tracks the number of minutes
used and remaining in your plan. Minute Usage
Reminder: sends an alert when the number of
minutes used reaches 75 percent of the total
available minutes in the plan. Over Limit Alert:
sends an alert when usage exceeds your plan’s
total available minutes.
Billing
This provides a billing summary.
Plan
This screen displays specific information and
charges for your current plan and services. The
screen also displays additional services
information and charges. Included categories
include: My plan & services, Additional Services,
and T-Mobile Offers.
Applications and Development
149
Quick Tools
My Device
Quick Tools is a shortcut that allows you to view
and configure the following features and
parameters: Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, Data Roaming,
GPS, Brightness, Screen Timeout, and Phone
Info.
Use the My Device application to configure
device settings, view support information,
personalize your CallerTunes, Ringtones, or
Wallpapers, or view battery storage information.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Personalize
(
Applications) ➔
2. Read the on-screen information and tap
OK
(My Device).
Using this menu you can personalize
CallerTunes, Ringtone, and Wallpapers.
• Caller Tunes: allows you to choose songs for
your callers to hear.
.
Tip: Use the Menu key (
) to toggle between My
Account and My Device.
• Ringtones: you can personalize your phone’s
ringtones by choosing from recordings, voices,
and more.
The differences between My Account and My
Device are these:
• Wallpapers: you can personalize your phone’s
background by selecting wallpapers from the
Shop, Gallery, Live Wallpapers, and the
Wallpaper Gallery.
• My Account: check Activity, set Alerts and
Events, review Billing, and review your current
Plan and services.
• My Device: access Support, view Quick Tools,
Storage & Battery
Personalize settings, and Storage & Battery.
From this tab you can view Memory storage
information for the phone or memory card. You
can also view the battery level percentage and
other information.
The initial screen displays four tabs: Personalize,
Quick Tools, Support, and Storage Battery.
Support
Displays support information such as: Device
Restart, Device Storage, My Account Feedback,
T-Mobile Forums, T-Mobile on Twitter, and T-
Mobile® Tech Assist™.
150
3. Tap Use GPS satellites. A green check mark
indicates the GPS location feature is
enabled.
Navigation
Google Maps Navigation (Beta) is an internet-
connected turn-by-turn, GPS navigation system
with voice guidance.
4. Tap Use sensor aiding. A green check mark
indicates the phone is enhancing its
positioning ability and save power by using
sensors.
Caution! Traffic data is not real-time and
directions may be wrong, dangerous,
prohibited, or involve ferries.
Navigation options
1. From the Home screen, tap
➔
Important! To receive better GPS signals, avoid
using your device in the following
conditions:
(
Navigation). The navigation application
can be configured from the main screen.
2. Read the on-screen disclaimer and tap
- inside a building or between
buildings
Accept
.
- in a tunnel or underground passage
- in poor weather
3. Choose from the following on-screen
options:
- around high-voltage or
electromagnetic fields
- in a vehicle with tinted windows
• Driving/Walking: configures the method of
travel. Selection of Walking would negate the
need to track traffic jams and obstructions.
–
Driving mode enables the Settings feature:
allows you to configure your Route options such
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Navigation).
Enabling GPS Location
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Location and security
(
(
as: Avoid highways or Avoid tolls
.
• Maps: enables the on-screen real-time map
functionality.
➔
(
• Speak Destination: allows you to use the voice
recognition feature to search for matching
locations in your area.
2. Tap Use wireless networks. A green check
mark indicates the GPS location feature
has been enhanced by using Wi-Fi and/or
mobile networks to increase accuracy.
Applications and Development
151
• Type Destination: allows you to manually enter
a destination address (via the on-screen
keypad).
• Gas Stations: displays gas station location
relative to your current location.
• ATMs & Banks: displays ATM and Bank
locations relative to your current location.
• Restaurants: displays restaurant and eatery
locations relative to your current location.
• Contacts: allows you to receive turn-by-turn
directions to the address stored for a selected
Contacts entry.
• Starred Places: allows you to obtain directions
to locations that have been starred within Google
Press
to access additional options:
•
Search: manually search for a destination address,
place, name of business, or even a type of business.
Set Destination: returns you to the navigation
options screen where you can access a destination
by either Speaking, Typing, or selecting from a
Contacts entry or Starred Place.
Navigation Map options
Once on the map screen, you can access the
following features:
Destination: returns you to the previous Navigation
options screen.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Layers: allows you to switch map views. See
previous description.
Search by voice: Speak your destination instead of
typing.
Mute: allows you to mute the audio readout and
directional information.
Layers: allows you to switch map views:
• Traffic view: (available only in selected areas)
Real-time traffic conditions are displayed over
roads as color-coded lines. Each color
represents how fast the traffic is moving.
• Satellite: Maps uses the same satellite data as
Google Earth. Satellite images are not real-time.
Google Earth acquires the best imagery
available, most of which is approximately one to
three years old.
•
•
Exit Navigation: terminates the application.
More: provides additional application information
such as: Help and Terms, Privacy & Notices.
Caution! Navigation is a beta product. Use
caution.
• Parking: displays parking information relative to
your current location.
152
–
Application version: displays the application
version number.
News & Weather
The News & Weather application allows you to
view the news and weather in your area.
1. From the Home screen, tap
To access the settings:
1. Press and then tap Settings
2. Tap an available option: Weather settings
News settings Refresh settings, and
Application version
.
(Applications) ➔
(News & Weather).
,
2. Select from any of the available scrollable
,
tabs located at the top of the screen:
.
Weather
Entertainment
,
Top Stories, U.S., Sports, and
Places
.
Google Places displays company logos on a layer
of Google Maps. When viewing an area you can
quickly locate a business or person, find out
more information about the business, see
coupons, public responses, and more.
1. From the Home screen, tap
3. Tap the temperature to display a graph
mapping the days temperature and
humidity.
4. While on the Weather screen, press
to display the following options:
• Refresh: allows you to refresh the screen. Your
location and the weather is updated if there have
been any changes.
(
Applications) ➔
(Places).
2. Locate and tap one of the listed places
(Restaurants, Cafes, Bars, Attractions,
[user added searches], or IN THIS AREA) A
list of places within this category displays.
3. Tap the Maps icon to launch the related
maps feature.
• Settings: allows you to set weather, news, and
refresh settings.
–
Weather settings: allows you to choose
location(s) and set the metric for temperature
displays.
4. Press
and then tap Add a search. The
functions adds additional search shortcuts
to the places screen.
–
News settings: allows you to choose topics,
configure settings for fetching articles and
images, and view the terms of service for news
service.
–
Refresh settings: allows you to choose options
for updating content.
Applications and Development
153
Polaris Office
Settings
Polaris Office Mobile for Android is a Microsoft
Office compatible office suite. This application
provides a central place for managing your
documents online or offline.
This icon navigates to the sound and phone
settings for your phone. It includes such settings
as: display, security, memory, and any extra
settings associated with your phone.
The application can also open Adobe PDF
(Portable Document Format) files.
1. From the Home screen, tap
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Settings).
– or –
(
(
(
Applications) ➔
(Polaris Office).
Press
➔
and then tap
2. Read the registration information and enter
your Name and Email information (if
desired).
(
Settings).
3. Tap Later to ignore this registration or
Register to complete the process.
4. On its initial launch, tap an available tab:
Slacker
Slacker offers free, internet radio for mobile
phones.
•
(New): creates a new office document.
1. From the Home screen, tap
• My Files: This is where you keep your
documents on this device. You can manage
documents, or send them to others, and upload
the documents.
(
Applications) ➔
(Slacker).
Important! You must register and create a free
account prior to using this service.
• Recent docs: provides a list of recently opened
documents.
2. If prompted, enter your Email address and
password.
– or –
• Web files: This provides your online storage
documents to others without using email
attachments.
Tap Create Account if you have not created
an account.
•
(Search): allows you to search for
3. Begin selecting the music you want to
document files by using a text string.
listen to.
154
Social Hub
T-Mobile Mall
This downloadable application provides access
to several phone features and tunes.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Allows you to easily and intuitively satisfy all of
your communication needs from within a single-
user interface. E-mails, instant messaging,
social network contents, and calendar contents
from all major service providers are available.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. Read the on-screen disclaimer and tap
agree
3. Read the consecutive legal disclaimer
(T-Mobile Mall).
I
.
(Applications) ➔
(Social Hub). The
Welcome to Social Hub page describes all
of the available features.
screen and tap Yes or No to agree/disagree
to its terms.
2. Tap Setup now to setup your Social Hub
account.
4. Tap OK to complete the activation process.
5. Review the on-screen options such as:
3. Tap on an account type that you would like
to setup. Choose from either email
accounts, SNS accounts, or other IM
accounts.
•
•
•
•
•
Recommended
Ringtones
CallerTunes
Applications
Games
4. If you choose an SNS account, read the
SNS disclaimer, tap the I accept all the
terms above checkbox, then tap Agree to
continue.
T-Mobile Name ID
Allows you to modify the on-screen Caller ID
information. Name ID identifies unknown callers
by Name, City, and State.
5. Tap Next
.
6. Follow the on-screen instructions for
adding an account.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(T-Mobile Name ID).
7. From the Social Hub main screen, tap the
Feeds or Messages tabs to see information
pertaining to your account.
2. Choose an on-screen option.
8. To add another account, press
➔
Add
account.
Applications and Development
155
4. Tap the Due date field and enter a due date
name using the keypad. If there is no date
that the task is due, tap the No due date
checkbox.
T-Mobile TV HD
T-Mobile TV is an application that allows you to
get live TV and Video on Demand.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ T-Mobile TV HD).
5. If desired, enter Task
and Notes then tap Save
6. At the Task list screen, press
display the following options:
,
Priority
.
,
Reminder
,
(
(
to
Talk
• Create: allows you to create a new task.
• View by task: allows you to view tasks by task
categories.
You can instant message with Google Talk.
Google Talk allows you to communicate with
other people who are also connected with
Google Talk on the phone or on the web.
• Delete: allows you to delete one or all of your
tasks.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Talk).
• Search: allows you to search your tasks for a
particular word or words.
(
(
• List by: allows you to sort by Due date, Status, or
Priority.
Task
• Sync Task: allows you to sync your tasks to any
of your accounts.
Allows you to keep track of both your current and
upcoming tasks. You can also sync these tasks
with different accounts.
From the Task list screen, tap a task once you
have completed it and a checkmark appears
next to the task. The task name is also grayed
out so that you can still read it.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Task).
2. Tap Create task to start a new task entry.
3. Tap the Name field and enter a task name
using the keypad.
156
• Storage displays a visual graph indicating the
available and used space within the System
storage location, USB storage, and SD card
location.
Task Manager
Sometimes your phone might seem to slow down
over time, and the biggest reason for this are
background applications. These are applications
that were not properly closed or shutdown and are
stillactivebutminimized.TheTaskManagernotonly
lets you see which of these applications are still
active in the background but also easily lets you
choose which applications are left running and
which are closed.
• Help provides additional battery saving
techniques.
2. From the Active applications tab, tap Exit to
close selected applications or tap Exit all to
close all background running applications.
TeleNav GPS
TeleNav GPS Navigator is a driving aid that uses
both audible and visual directions for GPS
navigation.
Shutting Down Applications
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Applications) ➔
(
Task manager).
– or –
1. From the Home screen, tap
Press and hold
then tap Task
(
Applications) ➔
(TeleNav GPS).
manager. This screen contains the
following tabs:
2. If prompted, read the GPS Settings
notification, tap GPS Settings button and
follow the on-screen prompts to enable the
necessary GPS location feature.
• Active applications display those currently
active applications running on your phone.
• Downloaded displays any installed packages or
applications from the Market that are taking up
memory space. Tap Uninstall to remove them
from your phone.
3. Read the agreement and tap Accept to
accept the terms, or tap Exit to close the
window. Wait for the application to load
required first-time use files.
• RAM, displays the amount of current RAM
(Random Access Memory) currently being used
4. Enter a phone number and tap Submit
.
5. If you have already registered an account
and allow you to Clear memory
.
with your phone number, enter your
existing 4-digit PIN and tap Sign In
.
– or –
Applications and Development
157
Create a new PIN code and tap Create
.
• Sharing allows you to setup sharing
preferences.
6. Use the available on-screen functions.
–
–
–
–
Facebook: set up your Qik credentials for
Facebook posting of videos.
Tetris
Tetris is a puzzle video game in which falling
tetrominoes must be manipulated to form
complete lines, which are then cleared from the
grid.
Twitter: set up your Twitter account sharing
preferences.
YouTube: set up your Qik credentials for
YouTube posting of videos.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Tetris).
People: set up your contact sharing parameters.
2. Follow the on-screen setup and usage
• Privacy allows you to select who can find you
and see your videos.
instructions.
• M2M Settings allows you to configure the
Mobile to Mobile video chat settings.
Video Chat
This is a mobile video sharing and 2-way video
calling service. This application also lets you
record and share experiences with your friends,
family, and your favorite social networks.
1. From the Home screen, tap
• Location allows you to select the level of location
accuracy that is embedded into your Qik videos.
When posting or sharing Qik video information
with others, you can decide how accurate the
related location information can be. Choose
(
Applications) ➔
(Video Chat) ➔ Sign
up.
from: Off City level, Street level, or Track live.
,
2. Fill in the Email address, Username, and
Password, then tap Sign up to create your
new account.
• Video encoding quality allows you to assign a
video quality to the outbound video. Choose
from: Low Normal, or High.
,
3. Follow the on-screen instructions. For
• About displays the version information for the
more information, visit: http://qik.com/
.
Qik Video Chat application.
To adjust application settings:
Recording a Video Chat
1. From the Home screen, tap
1. Press
and then tap Settings.
2. Choose from any of the following options:
(
Applications) ➔
(Video Chat).
158
2. Tap Record & Share
.
3. Read the one-time disclaimer describing
Voice Recorder
the public nature of your videos and tap
OK
.
The Voice Recorder allows you to record an
audio file up to one minute long and then
immediately send it as a message.
1. From the Home screen, tap
4. Tap Record to start recording.
– or –
Tap Stop to end the recording process.
(
Applications) ➔
(Voice recorder).
5. Enter a title for your video segment and
select those services you wish to use to
distribute your video.
2. Tap Record icon to record an audio file.
3. Tap Stop to stop recording. The file
automatically saves to the Voice list.
4. From the Recorded files page, press
and then tap Share and select a method in
which to share this audio file. Selections
are: Messaging, Bluetooth, Gmail, or
Email. Refer to each specific section,
depending on the method you selected to
send this voice recording.
Services such as Twitter, Facebook, YouTube,
SMS, and E-mail ask that you select a recipient
for your video segment.
Videos
The Video Player application plays video files
stored on your microSD card.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Videos).
(
(
Voice Search
The Voice Search feature is a voice-activated
application that allows you to tell the phone what
to search for and then the phone activates a
Google search based on what you said.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Visual Voicemail
Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of
people who left a voicemail message, and listen
to the any message they want without being
limited to chronological order.
(
Applications) ➔
(Voice Search).
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Visual Voicemail).
(
(
Applications and Development
159
2. Tap Speak now and then speak your search
command slowly and clearly.
Google searches for the information and
displays related information in the
browser.
2. If prompted, log into your existing account
or create a new one.
3. Follow the on-screen prompts.
YouTube
YouTube is a video sharing website on which
users can upload and share videos, and view
them in MPEG-4 format.
Web
Open the browser to start surfing the web. The
browserisfullyoptimizedandcomeswithadvanced
functionality to enhance the Internet browsing
feature on your phone.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(YouTube).
2. When the screen loads you can begin
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Web).
searching and viewing posted videos.
(
(
To configure YouTube Settings:
ꢀ
Press
and then tap Settings and
configure the following parameters:
• High quality on mobile, when enabled, allows
you to start all videos in high quality mode while
you are connected to a mobile network.
• Caption font size allows you to set the font size
used by on-screen captions. Choose from:
Small, Medium, Large, or Extra Large.
Wi-Fi Calling
This feature allows you to make calls using a Wi-
Fi over the T-Mobile network.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Wi-Fi Calling).
(
(
• Clear search history allows you to clear any
previous YouTube searches from appearing
within the search box.
Yelp
Yelp is an online urban city guide that helps
people find cool places to eat, shop, drink, relax
and play. Its the fun and easy way to find, review
and talk about what's great in your world
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Yelp).
160
• SafeSearch filtering allows you to configure
block settings for videos containing restricted
content. This option blocks these videos from
appearing within your search results. Choose
from: Don’t filter, Moderate, or Strict blocking.
• Help provides answers to most YouTube
questions.
• Feedback allows you to provide user feedback
to YouTube.
• Google Mobile Terms of Service
• YouTube Terms of Service
• Google Mobile Privacy Policy
• YouTube Privacy Policy
• Application version displays the software
version for the current YouTube application.
To watch a high quality video:
ꢀ
Press
and then tap Settings
➔
High
quality on mobile
.
Zinio Reader
Launches a digital magazine reader. Zinio has
transformed your favorite print magazines into
digital format.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Applications) ➔
(Zinio Reader).
2. Tap sign in if you already have an account
or tap create an account to continue.
3. Follow the on-screen prompts.
Applications and Development
161
Section 10: Connections
Your phone is equipped with features that allow
you to quickly connect to the web.
•
•
Hot Trends: provides quick links to current Internet
hot topics.
Internet
Quick Links: provides a series of application
shortcuts. These shortcuts can be edit and
managed.
Your phone is equipped with a Google browser to
navigate the mobile web. This section explains
how to navigate the browser and use the basic
features.
•
•
Headlines: displays current Weather and headline
information. These entries can be edit and
configured.
Accessing the Internet
To access the Browser:
Directory: provides a grid listing of additional social
media, news, and other links. Tap Show More
Categories to reveal additional entries.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Web).
(
(
Navigating with the Browser
1. To select an item, touch an entry.
2. To scroll through a website, sweep the
screen with your finger in an up or down
motion.
Note: You must disable your Wi-Fi connection if
you wish to view the web2go home page
Homepage
When you access the Browser, the web2go home
3. To return to the previous page, press
.
page displays the following topics:
Browser Options
•
•
Google Search: allows you to quickly search for
online topics using the Google search engine.
Advertisement: provides an on-screen
advertisement bubble providing suggested phone
applications.
1. From the home page, press
to access
the following options:
• New window: displays a new window so you
can browse multiple URLs. For more information,
refer to “Adding and Deleting Windows”
on page 164.
•
Recommended: provides recommended apps.
162
• Windows: displays a list of the windows you
have open.
–
Settings: allows you to change the way you
view your web pages by changing these options.
See “Browser Settings” on page 166.
• Browser brightness: allows you to manually
adjust the screen brightness.
Entering a URL
You can access a website quickly by entering the
URL. Websites are optimized for viewing on your
phone.
Note: If the Automatic brightness feature is
enabled (Settings
➔
Display
➔
Brightness),
you can not modify the browser’s brightness
setting.
To enter a URL and go to a particular website:
ꢀ
From the web2go homepage, locate the
• Stop/Refresh: stops the load of the new page or
reloads the contents of the current page.
• Forward: forwards the browser to another web
page.
URL field at the top of the screen, enter the
URL and tap
.
Note: This is not the same application as the
Google Search Widget. The web2go screen
can not be accessed via a Wi-Fi connection.
• More: displays the following additional options:
–
Add bookmark: allows you to add a URL to
your bookmark list.
Search the Internet
–
Add shortcut to Home: adds a shortcut to your
web2go homepage on your phone’s Home
screen.
To perform an internet search using keywords:
1. From within the Google search application,
tap the Google search field, enter the
keyword(s) to search using the
–
–
–
–
Find on page: allows you to search in the
current page.
on-screen keypad.
Page info: displays information about the
selected page.
2. Tap
displays.
. A list of search results
Share page: allows you to share the page using
Gmail or as a message.
3. Tap a link to view the website.
Downloads: displays the download history.
Connections
163
Adding and Deleting Windows
You can have up to eight Internet windows open
at one time. To add a new window, follow these
steps:
Using Bookmarks
While navigating a website, you can bookmark a
site to quickly and easily access it at a future
time. The URLs (website addresses) of the
bookmarked sites display in the Bookmarks
page. From the Bookmarks page you can also
view your Most visited websites and view your
History.
1. From the webpage, tap
Bookmarks page displays. Additional
pages include Most visited and History
2. Press to display the following
options:
1. From your browser, press
tap New window.
– or –
and then
Press
and then tap Windows
➔
New
. The
window
.
2. A new browser window displays.
.
3. Press
and then tap Windows to see a
list of all open windows.
• Bookmark last-viewed page: Creates a new
bookmark for the last webpage that you viewed.
• List/Thumbnail view: Select Thumbnail view
(default) to view a thumbnail of the webpage with
the name listed, or select List view to view a list
of the bookmarks with Name and URL listed.
• Create folder: Creates a new folder in which to
store new bookmarks.
Note: This icon will display a number that
corresponds to the current number of active
browser windows,
4. Scroll across the screen to view the
currently active windows and tap an entry
to launch the selected Internet window.
5. Tap
window.
next to the listing to delete the
• Change order: Rearranges the current
bookmarks.
• Move to folder: Selected bookmarks are moved
to a selected folder.
• Delete: Erases selected bookmarks.
164
3. Tap a bookmark to view the webpage, or
touch and hold a bookmark for the
following options:
3. Assign a folder location. Home is the
default.
4. Tap OK. The new save page now appears
on the Bookmarks page.
• Open: Opens the webpage of the selected
bookmark.
Editing Bookmarks
1. From the Bookmarks page, touch and hold
the bookmark you want to edit.
• Open in new window: Opens the webpage in a
new window.
• Edit bookmark: Allows you to edit the name or
URL of the bookmark. For more information,
refer to “Editing Bookmarks” on page 165.
• Add shortcut to Home: Adds a shortcut to the
bookmarked webpage to your phone’s Home
screen.
2. Tap Edit bookmark
.
3. Use the on-screen keypad to edit the name
of the bookmark or the URL.
4. Tap OK
.
Deleting Bookmarks
1. From the Bookmarks page, touch and hold
the bookmark you want to delete.
• Share link: Allows you to share a URL address
via Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, or Messaging.
• Copy link URL: Allows you to copy the URL
address to use in a message.
2. Tap Delete bookmark
.
3. At the confirmation window, tap OK
.
Emptying the Cookies
• Delete bookmark: Allows you to delete a
bookmark. For more information, refer to
“Deleting Bookmarks” on page 165.
• Set as homepage: Sets the bookmark to your
new homepage.
A cookie is a small file placed on your phone by a
website during navigation. In addition to
containing some site-specific information, a
cookie can also contain some personal
information (such as a username and password)
which might pose a security risk if not properly
managed. You can clear these cookies from your
phone at any time.
Adding Bookmarks
1. From the Home webpage, tap
➔
Add
.
1. From the Home webpage, press
and
2. Use the on-screen keypad to enter the
then tap More
cookie data
➔
Settings
➔
Clear all
name of the bookmark and the URL.
.
Connections
165
2. Tap OK to delete the cookies or tap Cancel
2. Tap any entry to display the selected
to exit.
webpage.
Using Web History
Browser Settings
To make configure browser settings, follow these
steps:
The History list displays a list of the most
recently viewed websites. These entries can be
used to return to previously unmarked web
pages.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Web).
1. From the Home webpage, tap
➔
2. Press and then tap More
➔
Settings.
History tab.
3. Choose from the following on-screen
A list of the most recently viewed websites
displays.
options:
• Default zoom: Adjusts the zoom feature. Set to
Far, Medium, or Close.
2. Tap an entry to display the webpage.
– or –
• Open pages in overview: Displays an overview
of recently viewed web pages.
Press
delete the current History list.
Using Most Visited
The Most visited list provides you with a list of
the most visited and bookmarked websites.
These entries are used to return to previously
unmarked web pages.
and then tap Clear history to
• Text encoding: Adjusts the current text
encoding.
• Block pop-up windows: Prevents popup
advertisement or windows from appearing on-
screen. Remove the checkmark to disable this
function.
1. From the Home webpage, tap
Most visited tab.
➔
• Load images: Allows web page images to load
along with the other text components of a loaded
website.
A list of your most frequently visited
webpages displays. The most frequently
visited web pages display at the top of the
list.
• Auto-fit pages: Allows web pages to be resized
to fit as much of the screen as possible.
• Landscape view only: Displays the browser in
only the horizontal position.
166
• Enable JavaScript: Enables javascript for the
current Web page. Without this feature, some
pages may not display properly. Remove the
checkmark to disable this function.
• Clear form data: Deletes any stored data from
previously filled out forms. Tap OK to complete
the process.
• Enable location: Allows websites to request
access to your location.
• Enable plug-ins: Allows the download of plug-
ins such as Adobe Flash.
• Clear location access: Clears location access
for all websites. Tap OK to complete the process.
• Remember passwords: Stores usernames and
passwords for visited sites. Remove the
checkmark to disable this function.
• Open in background: New pages are launched
in a separate page and displayed behind the
current one. Remove the checkmark to disable
this function.
• Set home page: Sets the current home page for
the Web browser.
• Clear passwords: Deletes any previously stored
usernames or passwords. Tap OK to complete
the process.
• Default storage: Sets the default storage to
Memory card.
• Show security warnings: Notifies you if there is
a security issue with the current website.
Remove the checkmark to disable this function.
• Set search engine: Allows you to choose a
default search engine for your phone. Choose
• Clear cache: Deletes all currently cached data.
Tap OK to complete the process.
• Clear history: Clears the browser navigation
history. Tap OK to complete the process.
• Accept cookies: Allows sites, that require
cookies, to save and read cookies from your
device.
from: Google Yahoo!, or Bing.
,
• Website settings: View advanced settings for
individual websites.
• Clear all cookie data: Deletes all current
browser cookie files.
• Reset to default: Clears all browser data and
resets all settings to default.
• Remember form data: Allows the device to
store data from any previously filled out forms.
Remove the checkmark to disable this function.
Connections
167
Bluetooth Status Indicators
The following icons show your Bluetooth
connection status at a glance:
Bluetooth
About Bluetooth
Bluetooth is a short-range communications
technology that allows you to connect wirelessly
to a number of Bluetooth devices, such as
headsets and hands-free car kits, and Bluetooth-
enabled handhelds, computers, printers, and
wireless devices. The Bluetooth communication
range is usually up to approximately 30 feet.
Displays when Bluetooth is active.
Displays when Bluetooth is connected
(paired) and communicating.
Bluetooth Settings
The Bluetooth settings menu allows you to set up
many of the characteristics of your device’s
Bluetooth service, including:
Turning Bluetooth On and Off
To turn Bluetooth on:
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Bluetooth settings
➔
and then tap
•
•
•
Entering or changing the name your device uses for
Bluetooth communication and description
Setting your device’s visibility (or “discoverability”)
for other Bluetooth devices
(
➔
.
2. Tap the Bluetooth field to activate the
feature (checkmark indicates active).
Displaying your device’s Bluetooth address
When active,
area.
displays in the Status
To access the Bluetooth Settings menu:
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Bluetooth settings
➔
To turn Bluetooth off:
(
➔
1. Press
➔
and then tap
.
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
2. Verify Bluetooth is active. Indicated by a
Bluetooth settings
.
green check mark in the Bluetooth field.
2. Tap the Bluetooth field to deactivate the
3. Tap the Device name
,
Visible, and Search
feature.
for devices fields to set the options.
168
To change your Bluetooth name:
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.
Pairing Bluetooth Devices
The Bluetooth pairing process allows you to
establish trusted connections between your
device and another Bluetooth device. When you
pair devices, they share a passkey, allowing for
fast, secure connections while bypassing the
discovery and authentication process.
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap
Device name
.
3. Enter a new name.
4. Tap OK to complete the rename process.
To set visibility:
Note: Pairing between two Bluetooth devices is a
one-time process. Once pairing is
1. Verify your Bluetooth is active.
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap
established the devices continue to
recognize their partnership and exchange
information without entering a passcode.
Visible
.
Making your device visible allows other
devices to pair and communicate.
To pair your device with another Bluetooth device:
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.
Note: Your device is visible for up to 120 seconds
(2 minutes). This value appears as a
countdown within this field.
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap
Visible
.
Your device must be visible to successfully
pair with an external device.
To scan for Bluetooth devices:
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap Scan
for devices to search for visible external
Bluetooth-compatible devices such as
headsets, devices, printers, and
computers.
3. Tap Scan for devices. Your device displays
a list of discovered in-range Bluetooth
devices.
4. Tap a device from the list to initiate pairing.
5. Enter the passkey or PIN code, if needed,
and tap OK
.
Connections
169
6. The external device must accept the
connection and enter your device’s PIN
code.
3. Tap OK to confirm disconnection.
– or –
From the Bluetooth settings page, touch
and hold the name of the previously paired
Once successfully paired to an external
device,
displays in the Status area.
device, and select Disconnect
.
Note: Due to different specifications and features
of other Bluetooth-compatible devices,
display and operations may be different,
and functions such as transfer or exchange
may not be possible with all Bluetooth-
compatible devices.
Note: Disconnections are manually done but often
occur automatically if the paired device
goes out of range of your phone or it is
powered off.
Deleting a Paired Bluetooth Device
Deleting a device from your list removes its
“connection record” and upon reconnection
would require that you re-enter all the previous
pairing information.
Disconnecting a Paired Bluetooth
Device
Disconnecting a paired device breaks the
connection between the device and your phone,
but retains the knowledge of the pairing. At a
later point when you wish to reconnect the
device, there is no need to setup the connection
information again.
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, touch
and hold the name of the previously paired
device (from the bottom of the page). This
opens the connected device’s menu
options.
1. Verify your Bluetooth is active.
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, touch
the previously paired device (from the
bottom of the page).
3. Tap Unpair to delete the paired device.
170
Sending Contacts via Bluetooth
Enable Downloading for Web
Applications
Depending on your paired devices’ settings and
capabilities, you may be able to send pictures,
Contact information, or other items using a
Bluetooth connection.
Important! Before you can download a web
application you must insert an SD into
the phone and enable the Unknown
sources feature (enables
Note: Prior to using this feature, Bluetooth must
first be enabled on both your phone and the
external device, and the recipient’s device
must be visible.
downloading). For more information,
1. Verify your Bluetooth is active and your
phone is visible.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Applications
.
2. From the Home screen, tap
(
Contacts).
2. Tap the Unknown sources check box.
3. Tap OK to allow install of non-Market
applications. Tap again to remove the
checkmark and disable the installation of
non-market applications.
3. Tap the entry to open the overview page.
4. Press
via
and then tap Send namecard
➔
Bluetooth and select a paired
external Bluetooth device.
Warning! Not all web applications are safe to
download. In order to protect your phone
and data, use Android Market to install
web applications. For more information,
Note: The external Bluetooth device must be
visible and communicating for the pairing to
be successful.
5. A Bluetooth share notification displays in
your notifications list.
Connections
171
PC Connections
Note: To use any downloaded market application
that requires a USB connection between
your phone and your PC, you should first set
You can connect your device to a PC using an
optional PC data cable using various USB
connection modes. Mass storage is the default
connection method.
the USB setting to Mass storage
.
Mass storage: allows you to use the onboard
storage capacity of the phone to store and
upload files. This option allows your computer to
detect the phone as a removable storage drive.
2. Connect the multifunction jack on your
device to a PC using an optional PC data
cable.
A pop-up window displays on the PC when
connected.
Kies air: allows you to sync your Windows PC
wirelessly with your phone provided they are
both on the same Wi-Fi network.
3. Open the folder to view files.
4. Copy files from the PC to the memory card.
Connecting as a Mass Storage Device
PriortousingKiesairforPhoneUpdate
Before using Kies air to upgrade your device, it is
recommended that you backup your personal
data prior to use.
You can connect your device to a PC as a
removable disk and access the file directory. If
you insert a memory card in the device, you can
also access the files directory from the memory
card by using the device as a memory card
reader.
To export a Contact list to your microSD card:
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Contacts).
2. Press
3. Tap Export to SD card
Note: The file directory of the memory card
displays as a removable disk, separate from
the internal memory.
and then tap Import/Export
.
➔
1. Insert a memory card into the device to
transfer files from or to the memory card.
Verify your images and videos are on your microSD
card:
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Gallery).
172
2. Verify the Gallery contains all of your
pictures and videos.
4. If prompted, select a network. Choose
from either Wi-Fi or Portable Wi-Fi hotspot
.
3. Remove the back cover and remove the
internal microSD card prior to initiating a
Kies air update.
5. Write down the on-screen URL address.
Important! Both your phone and your computer
must be connected to the same
Enabling USB Debugging
Wireless Access Point (WAP).
USB debugging must be enabled before being
able to use the Development feature.
6. From your computer, enter the URL in your
Web browser.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Development.
(Settings) ➔ Applications
➔
7. If prompted, an Access Request prompt is
displayed on your device. Tap Allow to
permit connection between the computer
and device.
2. Tap the USB debugging field to verify the
feature is active before connecting your
USB cable.
3. Using an optional PC data cable, connect
the multifunction jack on your device to a
PC.
8. On your computer, you may be prompted
to run a Java plugin for a
TransferManagerApplet. Click Run
.
Kies Air
9. Tap the Remember for today checkbox if
you will be using Kies air with the same PC
later.
Kies Air allows you to sync your Windows PC
wirelessly with your phone provided they are
both on the same Wi-Fi network. You can view
and share call logs, videos, photos, music,
bookmarks, ringtones, and even send SMS
messages from your PC.
10. From your PC, a security warning may be
displayed asking if you want to run this
application. Click Run to continue.
11. On your PC, the Kies air screen is
1. Sign onto the same Wi-Fi network from
your phone and from your PC.
displayed. On your phone, the
icon
appears at the top of your screen.
2. From the Home screen, tap
(Applications) ➔
(Kies air).
3. From the Kies air homescreen, tap Start
.
Connections
173
12. Follow the on-screen instructions to view
and share information between your phone
and PC.
Activating Wi-Fi
By default, your device’s Wi-Fi feature is turned
off (deactivated). Activating Wi-Fi allows your
device to discover and connect to compatible in-
range WAPs (Wireless Access Points).
13. Click a link from the left navigation pane to
access one of several device file
categories such as:
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
2. Tap Wi-Fi to activate the feature. A
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Wi-Fi
•
[Device Name] - provides an overview of all the
main categories.
.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Photos/Videos/Music
Ringtones
checkmark indicates that Wi-Fi is active.
The device scans for available in-range
wireless networks and displays them
under Wi-Fi networks on the same screen.
Bookmarks
Messages/Call Log/Contacts
File Explorer
Connecting to a Wi-Fi Network
Language settings
1. Press
➔
and then tap
14. To exit the Kies air application, tap Stop on
your device, then close out the Web
browser on your computer.
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Wi-Fi
settings
.
The network names and security settings
(Open network or Secured with WEP) of
detected Wi-Fi networks display in the Wi-
Fi networks section.
Wi-Fi
About Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi (short for "wireless fidelity") is a term used
for certain types of Wireless Local Area Networks
(WLAN). Wi-Fi communication requires access to
an existing and accessible Wireless Access Point
(WAP). These WAPs can either be Open
(unsecured) as within most Hot Spots, or
Secured (requiring knowledge of the Router
name and password).
2. Tap the network you wish to connect to.
Note: When you select an open network you are
automatically connected.
3. Enter a wireless password (if necessary).
174
Activate and Deactiavte Wi-Fi from the
Notification bar.
Manually Add a New Network
Connection
1. Tap Add Wi-Fi network
.
Note: Use of wireless data connections such as
Wi-Fi and Bluetooth can reduce battery life
and use times.
2. Enter the Network SSID (the name of your
Wireless Access Point).
3. Tap the Security field and select a security
option. This must match the current
security setting on your target WAP.
4. Enter your WAP’s password if the WAP is
secure.
Manually Scan for a Wi-Fi Network
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
2. Press
Wi-Fi Status Indicators
➔
Wi-Fi
.
5. Tap Save to store the new information and
connect to the target WAP.
and then tap Scan
.
The following icons indicate the Wi-Fi connection
status:
Note: No prompt to enter the WAP key displays if
this is the second time to connect to a
previously accessed or secured wireless
network. The WAP key is required when the
device is reset using factory default
settings.
Displays when Wi-Fi is connected,
active, and communicating with a
Wireless Access Point (WAP).
Displays when Wi-Fi is active and
there is an available open wireless
network.
Deactivating Wi-Fi
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Wi-Fi Advanced Settings
The Wi-Fi settings - Advanced menu allows you
to set up many of the device’s Wi-Fi services,
including:
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Wi-Fi
settings
.
2. Tap the Wi-Fi field to deactivate the
feature. The checkmark grays.
– or –
•
•
•
Setting the Wi-Fi sleep policy
Viewing the device’s MAC Address
Configuring use of either a DHCP or Static IP
Connections
175
To access the Wi-Fi Advanced Settings menu:
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
2. Press
4. Tap USB tethering from the Tethering
menu. This places a green check mark
next to the entry and activates the feature.
A Tethering or Hotspot active notification
briefly appears on the screen. Look for the
➔
(
➔
Wi-Fi
.
and then tap Advanced
.
Tethering active icon
bar area of the screen.
in the Status
Tethering
This option allows you to share your phone’s
mobile data connection via a direct USB
connection between your phone and computer. A
wireless version of this same functionality would
be the Portable Wi-Fi feature.
To disconnect tethering:
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Tethering and portable hotspot
➔
and then tap
(
➔
.
2. Tap USB tethering from the Tethering menu
to remove the check mark and deactivate
the feature.
Note: You can not mount your phone’s microSD
card to your computer while using the USB
tethering feature. If additional software or
USB drivers are required, navigate to: http://
3. Remove the USB cable from the phone.
Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot
This feature allows you to turn your phone into a
Wi-Fi hotspot. The feature works best when used
in conjunction with HSPA+ (4G) data services
(although 3G service can also be used).
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Tethering and portable hotspot
➔
and then tap
(
➔
.
2. Plug in the USB cable between your
computer and your phone.
Important! The Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot service can
not be active at the same time as Wi-
Fi. Please close your Wi-Fi connection
prior to launching the Portable Wi-Fi
service.
3. When prompted for a USB mode, press
to exit the menu.
176
Note: You must have a tethering plan on your
account to use the Wi-Fi hotspot. You can
not use data on the device while it is being
used as a hotspot.
Note: Using your 4G service and Portable Wi-Fi
Hotspot drains your phone’s battery at a
much faster rate than when using any other
feature combination.
The best way to keep using the phone as a
hotspot is to have it connected to a power
supply.
To activate the Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot service:
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Tethering and portable hotspot
2. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot settings
➔
and then tap
(
➔
➔
To connect to the Hotspot:
.
1. Enable Wi-Fi (wireless) functionality on
your target device (laptop, media device,
etc.).
OK
.
3. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot. This places a
checkmark in the adjacent field to activate
the service.
2. Scan for Wi-Fi networks from the device
and select your phone hotspot from the
network list.
4. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot
➔
Yes to
continue with the activation.
•
The SSID name for your phone’s hotspot is
determined by what you entered into the
Network SSID field.
5. Tap Configure portable Wi-Fi hotspot
.
6. Create a new Network SSID name,
configure the desired fields and tap Save
Write down the SSID name.
.
•
You can change the name by tapping Configure
portable Wi-Fi hotspot
➔
Network SSID and
7. Confirm the Portable Wi-Fi Portable Wi-Fi
changing the entry.
service icon
screen.
appears at the top of the
3. Select this Hotspot and follow your on-
screen instructions to complete the
connection.
Note: By default, the connection is open and not
secured. It is recommended that you access
the Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot settings and
create a secure connection by using a
password for communication.
4. Launch your Web browser to confirm you
have an Internet connection.
Connections
177
To secure the Portable Hotspot service:
The two most common methods for securing
your connection to the Hotspot are to a security
method (WPA2 PSK) and to Hide your phone’s
SSID name.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Tethering and portable hotspot
Wi-Fi hotspot settings
Wi-Fi hotspot
➔
Portable
➔
Configure portable
.
2. Tap the Security field and select WPA2 PSK
3. With security enabled, enter a new
password into the Password field.
.
Important! The more complex the password, the
harder it will be for intruders to break
your security. It is recommended that
you not use names, birthdays, or other
personal information.
4. Tap Save to store the new settings.
178
Section 11: Time Management
This section describes how you can manage
time using time-related applications such as the
Calendar, Alarm Clock, Analog or Digital clock,
and the World clock.
• Delete: allows you to delete All events, All events
before today, or an individual event.
• Settings: displays a list of configurable settings.
Creating a Calendar Event
1. From the Home screen, tap
Calendar
With the Calendar feature, you can consult the
calendar by day, week, or month, create events,
and set an alarm to act as a reminder.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Calendar).
2. From the Month tab, press
➔
Create.
Calendar Settings
(
Applications) ➔
(
Calendar). The
Using the Calendar settings you can select the
day with which you want the calendar to begin.
You also select how you want to view the
calendar, by Month, Week, or Day or determine
how to manage events, notifications, sounds,
and defaults reminders.
Calendar displays four tabs:
• Month: displays the Month view.
• Week: displays the Week view.
• Day: displays the Day view.
• List: allows you to search for events for the
selected Month, Week, or Day, or you can look
for events for a future date.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
.
2. Press Settings
➔
.
2. Press
options:
and select one of the following
3. Tap Calendars and select the calendar
categories you want to display or tap All
• Create: creates a new Event.
• Go to: displays a specific date.
• Today: displays the date highlighted with a Blue
box highlighting the date.
calendar. A check mark indicates selection.
4. Tap Default view and select a view: Month
Week Day, or List
5. Tap Day view and select a type: Time grid
or Event list
6. Tap First day of week and select either
Monday or Sunday
Time Management
,
,
.
,
• Search: allows you to search within your current
events.
.
.
179
7. Tap Hide declined events to activate this
option. A check mark indicates selection.
8. Tap Hide contacts’ anniversaries to activate
this option. A check mark indicates
selection.
Setting an Alarm
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Clock).
2. Tap Create alarm).
(
3. Use the plus or minus symbols to enter the
hour, and minutes, then tap AM or PM
(toggles depending on which was last
selected).
9. Tap Lock time zone (to lock event time
based on your current user-selected time
zone). Select a time zone from within the
Select time zone field.
4. Tap the Alarm repeat field and tap the
number of times you want this alarm to
10. Tap Set alerts and notifications to adjust the
event notification method. Choose from:
repeat. Selections are: One-time event
,
Alert
11. Tap Vibrate to activate this notification
option. Selections are: Always Only in
Silent mode, or Never
,
Status bar notification, and Off.
Daily Every weekday(Mon-Fri), or One-time
,
event. If you selected Weekly, a button row
displays. Tap each day of the week in
which you want this alarm to repeat, then
,
.
tap OK
.
12. Tap Select ringtone to assign a ringtone to
a calendar event notification.
5. Tap the Alarm type field and select one of
the following: Melody
and melody, or Briefing
,
Vibration Vibration
.
,
13. Tap Calendar sync and select the type of
general synchronization settings you want.
A check mark indicates selection.
6. Slide the slider bar left or right in the Alarm
volume field to decrease or increase the
alarm volume. A sample of the volume
level plays.
Clock
This feature allows you to create an alarm to ring
at a specified time, track time in other parts of
the world, use a stopwatch, or set a timer.
7. Tap the Alarm tone field and select one of
the following: Sounds, or Go to My files
Locate a sound to use as an alarm ringtone
then tap OK to activate the ringtone.
.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Clock).
(
(
180
8. Tap the radio button to activate a tone for
the Snooze. Tap the field to assign a
duration time (3 minutes, 5 minutes, 10
minutes, 15 minutes, or 30 minutes) and
snooze repetition (1 time, 2 times, 3 times,
5 times, and 10 times).
Turning Off an Alarm
ꢀ
To stop an alarm when it sounds, touch
and slide to the right.
Setting the Snooze Feature
ꢀ
To activate the Snooze feature after an
alarm sounds, touch and slide
left. Snooze must first be set in the alarm
settings.
to the
• Duration indicates the length of time the alarm
will remain silent between alarm notifications
(snooze time).
World Clock
This feature allows you to find out what time it is
another part of world.
• Snooze repeat indicates the numbers of snooze
sessions that are assigned to this alarm. How
many times will the snooze silence the alarm.
9. Tap the radio button to activate Smart
alarm which slowly increases screen
brightness and the volume of nature tones
to simulate dawn breaking.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
2. Tap the World clock tab.
3. Tap Add city) then scroll and select
(Clock).
(
the desired city, or tap in the search field to
locate a city.
Tap the field to assign a duration time (3
min, 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, or 30 min) and
nature tone (Morning, Breeze, Mist, Forest,
Light, or Rain).
• Duration indicates the length of time the alarm
will remain silent between alarm notifications.
• Tone provides one of several nature sounds that
are used as the alarm tone.
To assign DST settings:
1. Locate a desired city from the World Clock
list.
2. Touch and hold a city and select DST
settings
.
3. Select a DST setting (Automatic, Off, 1
hour or 2 hours).
10. Tap the Name field and enter a name for
this Alarm.
11. Tap Save to store the new alarm event.
Time Management
181
Stopwatch
This feature allows you to capture elapsed time
while letting the stopwatch keep running.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Configuring a Desk Clock
This feature lets you activate an on-screen clock
that can be viewed when the device is docked.
ꢀ
From the Home screen, tap
Applications) ➔ Clock) ➔ Desk
clock tab.
(
Applications) ➔
(Clock) ➔
(
(
Stopwatch tab.
2. Tap Start to start the stopwatch counter.
3. Tap Lap to begin the lap time counter.
4. Tap Stop to stop the counter.
5. Tap Restart to restart the lap counter. You
can have multiple lap times.
6. Tap Reset to reset the counter.
Setting a Timer
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications) ➔
(Clock) ➔ Timer tab.
2. Tap the hr min, or sec field and use the on-
,
screen keypad to enter the hour, minute, or
seconds. The timer plays an alarm at the
end of the countdown.
3. Tap Start to start the timer.
4. Tap Stop to stop the timer or Reset to reset
the timer and start over.
5. Tap Restart to resume the timer counter.
182
Section 12: Changing Your Settings
This section explains the sound and phone settings
for your phone. It includes such settings as: display,
security,memory,andanyextrasettingsassociated
with your phone.
2. Tap Wi-Fi. A check mark displayed
indicates Wi-Fi is active.
Wi-Fi settings
Once set up for Wi-Fi connectivity, your phone
automatically uses Wi-Fi, when available, for all
your mobile phone services.
Wireless and Networks
Using Flight mode
Flight mode allows you to use many of your
phone’s features, such as Camera, Games, and
more, when you are in an airplane or in any other
area where making or receiving calls or data is
prohibited.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
2. Configure the settings as desired.
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Wi-Fi
.
The available connection types displayed with a
security type displayed next to them.
Important! When your phone is in Flight mode, it
cannot send or receive any calls or
access online information or
applications.
Network Notification
By default, when Wi-Fi is on, you receive
notifications in the Status bar anytime your
phone detects an available Wi-Fi network. You
can deactivate this feature if you do not want to
receive notifications.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
.
2. Tap Flight mode. A check mark displayed
next to the feature indicates Flight mode is
active.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Wi-Fi
.
Activating Wi-Fi
2. Tap Network notification. A check mark
displayed next to the feature indicates
Network notification is active.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Wi-Fi
settings
.
Changing Your Settings
183
3. Tap Network notification again to remove
the check mark and deactivate this
feature.
3. Tap Add Wi-Fi network
4. Enter the SSID (Service Set Identifier) and
Security settings then tap Save
.
.
WPS Button Connection
Note: An SSID is a unique key which identifies a
wireless LAN. Its purpose is to stop other
wireless equipment from accessing your
LAN — whether accidentally or
The WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) button is a
standard for easy and secure wireless network
set up and connections. To use WPS, the
connecting device must support WPS and be
compatible with Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA)
security. WPS can automatically set up a random
network name and WPA wireless security for
wireless Wi-Fi phones, routers, access points,
computers, adapters, and other electronic
devices.
intentionally. To communicate, wireless
devices must be configured with the same
SSID.
Bluetooth settings
In this menu you can activate Bluetooth, view or
assign a device name, activate your phone so
other Bluetooth devices can discover it, or scan
for other, available Bluetooth devices with which
to pair.
WPS allows you to push buttons instead of
entering a network name and wireless security
PIN.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
2. Tap WPS button connection
➔
and then tap
Activating Bluetooth
(
➔
Wi-Fi
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
.
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
.
Bluetooth settings and tap Bluetooth to turn
it on.
3. Press the WPS button on your Wi-Fi access
point within 2 minutes.
Manually Adding a Wi-Fi Network
Note: Bluetooth must be enabled prior to use.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Wi-Fi
settings
.
2. Tap Wi-Fi to turn it on.
184
Activating the Device Name
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Important! Some Bluetooth devices are secured
and require a PIN number to confirm
and pair with them.
➔
(
➔
Bluetooth settings
➔
Device name. The
assigned device name displays.
2. Press to erase the current device
3. Enter a PIN to pair with the device, if one is
required, and tap Accept or Decline
.
name and enter a new name for this
device using the keyboard.
Tethering
This option allows you to share your phone’s
mobile data connection via a direct USB
connection between your phone and computer. A
wireless version of this same functionality would
be the Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot feature.
3. Tap OK to confirm your setting.
Activating Visibility
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Bluetooth settings Visible
➔
and then tap
(
➔
➔
.
Note: You can not mount your phone’s microSD
card to your computer while using the USB
tethering feature. If additional software or
USB drivers are required, navigate to: http://
The phone is now activated for discovery
for 119 seconds so you can pair with
another device. After 119 seconds the
phone becomes undiscoverable again.
Scanning for Devices
This option allows you to scan for active
Bluetooth devices so you can pair with them.
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Tethering and portable hotspot
➔
and then tap
(
➔
.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Bluetooth settings
➔
Search for devices.
Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot
Your phone begins scanning and lists any
discovered devices in the Bluetooth
devices section.
This feature allows you to turn your phone into a
Wi-Fi hotspot. The feature works best when used
in conjunction with HSPA+ (4G) data services
(although 3G service can also be used).
2. Tap a device name to pair with the device.
Changing Your Settings
185
To establish a PPTP VPN (Point-to-Point Tunneling
Protocol):
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this
connection).
Important! The Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot service can
not be active at the same time as Wi-
Fi. Please close your Wi-Fi connection
prior to launching the Portable Wi-Fi
service.
2. Assign a server by using Set VPN server.
3. Enable encryption (if desired).
4. Set the DNS search domains.
To add an L2TP VPN (Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol):
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this
connection).
VPN settings
The VPN settings menu allows you to set up and
manage Virtual Private Networks (VPNs).
2. Assign a server by using Set the VPN
server.
Important! Before you can use a VPN you must
3. Enable L2TP secret.
establish and configure one.
4. Set L2TP secret.
Adding a VPN
5. Set the DNS search domains.
Before you add a VPN you must determine which
VPN protocol to use: PPTP (Point-to-Point
Tunneling Protocol), L2TP (Layer 2 Tunneling
Protocol), L2TP/IPSec PSK (Pre-shared key
based L2TP/IPSec), or L2TP/IPSec CRT
(Certificate based L2TP/IPSec).
To add an L2TP/IPSec PSK VPN (Pre-shared key
based L2TP/IPSec):
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this
connection).
2. Assign a server by using Set the VPN
server.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
settings
➔
and then tap
3. Utilize the Set IPSEc pre-shared key.
4. Enable L2TP secret.
(
➔
VPN
.
5. Set L2TP secret.
2. Tap Add VPN
.
6. Set the DNS search domains.
186
To add an L2TP/IPSec CRT VPN (Certificate based
L2TP/IPSec):
Use packet data
Allows you to activate data usage on your phone.
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this
connection).
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks Use packet data
Data Roaming
➔
and then tap
(
➔
2. Assign a server by using Set the VPN
server.
➔
.
3. Enable L2TP secret.
4. Set L2TP secret.
Data roaming allows you to connect to your
service provider’s partner networks and access
data services when you are out of your service
providers area of coverage.
5. Set user certificate.
Note: A user certificate must be installed to use
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks
➔
and then tap
this setting.
(
➔
.
6. Set CA certificate.
2. Tap Data roaming to connect to data
services while roaming outside your
network.
– or –
Note: A CA certificate must be installed to use this
setting.
7. Set the DNS search domains.
Tap Data roaming again to remove the
green check mark and deactivate the
feature.
Mobile networks
Before you use applications such as Google
Maps and find your location or search for places
of interest, you must enable the Mobile networks
options.
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks
The following options display:
➔
and then tap
(
➔
.
Changing Your Settings
187
Access Point Names
To access a wireless access point:
2. Tap GSM/WCDMA (Auto mode). A check
mark displays next to this option to
indicate that it is active. This is the default
mode for this phone.
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks Access Point Names. A
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Using the 2G (EDGE) Network Only
➔
If you are not using applications that require the
3G network speed (any application that accesses
the network or uses a browser), using the 2G
network saves battery life.
list of the Access point names display. The
active access point displays a bright green,
filled circle to the right of the name.
Network mode
You can configure your phone to either manually
detect and use either a 2G (GSM) or 3G (WCDMA)
data network connection.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks Network mode
➔
and then tap
(
➔
➔
.
2. Tap GSM only. A check mark displays next
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
to this option to indicate that it is active.
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Mobile networks
➔
Network Mode.
Note: Connecting to 2G networks slows the data
transfer speed and time.
Using the Fastest Available Network
To confirm you are always using the fastest
possible connection, the phone has an automatic
detection method where it finds both the fastest
and most stable connection/communication
method. This phone is capable of using either
4G/3G services for this connection.
Using the 4G Network Only
If you are using applications that require the 4G
network speed, follow these instructions to
connect to the 4G network.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks Network mode
➔
and then tap
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks Network Mode
➔
and then tap
(
➔
(
➔
➔
.
➔
.
2. Tap WCDMA only. A check mark displays
next to this option to indicate that it is
active.
188
Network Operators
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
➔
Using this feature you can view the current
network connection. You can also scan and
select a network operator manually, or set the
network selection to Automatic.
Mobile networks
➔
Network operators.
2. Tap Default setup
.
3. Tap Manual to locate and connect to a
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Wireless and network
Mobile networks
➔
and then tap
network manually.
– or –
(
➔
.
Tap Automatic to allow the device to
automatically select a network.
2. Tap Network operators. The current
network connection displays at the bottom
of the list.
Call Settings
To access the Call settings menu:
Important! You must deactivate data service prior
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔Call
– or –
From the Home screen, tap
Settings Call
➔
and then tap
to searching for an available network.
(
.
3. Tap Search networks to manually search
for a network.
➔
➔
.
4. Tap Select automatically to automatically
select a network connection.
Configuring General Call Settings
Configure the general call settings using this
option.
Note: Connecting to 2G networks slows the data
transfer speed and time.
1. From the Home screen, tap
Settings Call
2. Tap one of the following options:
➔
➔
.
Default Setup Options
Your phone default is set to Automatic (to
automatically search for an available network.
You can set this option to Manual to select a
network each time you connect.
• Call rejection: allows you to manage your
rejection mode and rejection list.
–
Auto reject mode: sets the phone to
automatically reject incoming calls or messages.
Changing Your Settings
189
–
Reject list: provides access to current rejection
entries and numbers.
• Turn on proximity sensor: allows you to turn off
the LCD when the phone is near your face during
a call so you do not accidentally tap a key.
• Call forwarding: configures call forwarding
• Set reject messages: allows you to manage
both existing rejection messages and create new
ones.
• Call alert: allows you to assign call alert tones
and activate call alerts and vibration.
• Additional settings: allows you to additional call
–
Outgoing call vibration: vibrates the phone
when the called party answers.
–
Call status tones: assigns sounds settings
during the call. Choose from: Call connect tone,
Minute minder, and Call end tone.
• Voicemail service: allows you to select the
carrier used for your voicemail service. For more
–
Alerts on call: selects whether alarm and
message notification is turned off during a call.
Choose from: Off, Sound, Voice or Vibration.
• Voicemail: allows you to view the settings for
your voicemail.
• Call answering/ending: allows you to manage
the settings for answering and ending calls.
• Hearing aids: allows you to enable/disable
hearing aid compatibility. For more information,
–
Answering key allows you to press a key to
answer the phone.
–
Automatic answering, when connected,
automatically answers a call via the headset after
a period of time. Selections are: off, After 1
second, After 2 seconds, After 3 seconds, After
4 seconds, or After
Configuring Call Forwarding
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Call
➔
Call forwarding.
2. Tap an available option:
5 seconds.
• Always forward: incoming calls are re-routed to
a secondary number that you specify.
–
Power key ends calls allows you to press the
power key to end the current call.
• Forward when busy: forwards all your calls to
voicemail when your phone is busy.
190
• Forward when unanswered: automatically
forwards to your voicemail number when the
phone is not answered, and otherwise allows
you to enter a voicemail number.
• Call waiting: notifies you of an incoming call
while you are on another call.
• Auto redial: automatically redial the dialed
number if it is unable to connect or the call is cut
off.
• Forward when unreachable: automatically
forwards to your voicemail number when the
phone is not in service, or is turned off.
Fixed Dialing Numbers
Fixed Dial Number (FDN), allows you to restrict
outgoing calls to a limited set of phone numbers.
Enabling FDN
HAC Mode
This menu is used to activate or deactivate
Hearing Aid Compatibility for this device.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Call
Fixed Dialing Numbers
2. Tap Enable FDN
3. At the prompt, enter your PIN2 code and
tap OK
➔
and then tap
Additional settings
.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
➔
➔
(
Settings) ➔ Call
.
2. Tap the Hearing aids field to activate the
feature (green check mark), or tap it again
to deactivate the feature. Off is the default
setting.
.
.
Important! Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code. If
your SIM card does not, this menu
does not display.
Configuring Additional Voice Call
Settings
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Call
➔
Additional settings.
The PIN2 code is provided by your
carrier. Entering the PIN2 incorrectly
three times will cause the device to
lock. Contact customer service for
assistance.
2. Tap one of the following options:
• Caller ID: chooses whether your number is
displayed when someone answers your outgoing
call. Choose from: Network default, Hide
number, or Show number.
• Call barring: blocks specific types of calls (All
outgoing calls, International calls, etc..).
Changing Your Settings
191
Changing the PIN2 Code
4. Tap FDN list then press
and then tap
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Add contact or edit the contacts that were
(Settings) ➔ Call
➔
Additional settings
➔
stored.
Fixed Dialing Numbers
2. Tap Change PIN2
.
Important! Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code. If
your SIM card does not, this menu
does not display.
.
3. At the prompt, enter your old PIN2 code.
4. At the prompt, enter a new PIN2 code.
5. Confirm your PIN2 code.
The PIN2 code is provided by your
carrier. Entering the PIN2 incorrectly
three times will cause the device to
lock. Contact customer service for
assistance.
Important! Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code. If
your SIM card does not, this menu
does not display.
The PIN2 code is provided by your
carrier. Entering the PIN2 incorrectly
three times will cause the device to
lock. Contact customer service for
assistance.
Voicemail
From this menu, you can either view your
voicemail number or enter a new one.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Call
2. Tap My carrier
3. Tap Voicemail
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Voicemail service.
.
Managing the FDN List
➔
Voice mail number to now
When this feature is enabled, you can make calls
only to phone numbers stored in the FDN list on
the SIM card.
view your number within the Voicemail
number field.
– or –
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Call
➔
Additional settings
➔
To enter a new voicemail number, tap
Fixed Dialing Numbers
2. Tap Enable FDN
.
Voicemail
number and tap OK
➔
Voice mail number, enter a
.
.
3. At the prompt, enter your PIN2 code and
tap OK.FDN is enabled.
192
2. Tap Vibration and select a vibration mode.
Choose from: Always Never Only in silent
mode, or Only when not in silent mode
Sound Settings
From this menu you can control the sounds on
the phone as well as configure the display
settings.
,
,
.
Note: The Phone vibrate setting is independent of
other call sounds settings. For example, if
you have Silent mode enabled along with
Phone vibrate, your phone won’t play a
ringtone, but will vibrate for an incoming
call.
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Sound settings
.
The following options display:
Silent mode
Silent mode is convenient when you wish to stop
the phone from making noise, in a theater for
example. In Silent Mode the speaker is muted
and the phone only vibrates to notify you of
incoming calls, or other functions that normally
have a defined tone or sound as an alert.
Note: Use both the Silent mode and enable the
Only when not in silent mode option to
guarantee no vibrations or sounds from your
phone.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Sound settings
.
Adjusting the Volume Settings
The Volume menu now provides access to
various volume settings within one on-screen
popup menu.
2. Tap Silent mode
.
– or –
From the Home screen, press and hold the
Lock key until Phone options displays.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Sound settings
2. Touch and drag the on-screen slider to
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Volume.
3. Tap Silent mode to activate or deactivate
this mode (the current mode displays).
assign the volume settings for any of the
following volume levels.
Setup Phone Vibration
1. Press
➔
and then tap
• Incoming call
,
Media, System, or Notification.
(Settings) ➔ Sound settings
3. Tap OK to assign the volume levels.
Changing Your Settings
193
Setup the Voice Call Ringtone
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Sound settings
2. Tap Phone ringtone
Screen Lock Sounds
The screen lock sounds option is used to
activate/deactivate sounds when locking and
unlocking the screen.
➔
(
.
.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
3. Tap a ringtone from the available list. The
ringtone briefly plays when selected.
4. Tap OK to assign a ringer.
(Settings) ➔ Sound settings
.
2. Tap Screen lock sounds. A check mark
displayed next to these features indicates
active status.
Setting a Notification Ringtone
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Notification
Display Settings
(Settings) ➔ Sound settings
➔
In this menu, you can change various settings for
the display such as the font, orientation, pop-up
notifications, puzzle lock feature, animation,
brightness, screen timeout, power saving mode,
and tv out settings.
ringtone
.
2. Tap one of the ringtones and tap OK
.
Audible Tone Settings
The Audible touch tones and Audible selection
options are used when you use the dialing pad or
making a screen selection. Each time you press
a key or make a selection the selected tone
sounds.
Adjusting the Screen Display
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Display.
2. Configure the following screen display
1. Press
➔
and then tap
settings:
• Screen display
(Settings) ➔ Sound settings
.
2. Tap Audible touch tones or Audible
selection. A check mark displayed next to
these features indicates active status.
–
Font style: sets the fonts used on the LCD
display. Selections are: Default font. Tap Get
fonts online to download additional fonts.
Home screen Wallpaper: assigns an image
from either the Gallery, Live wallpapers, or
Wallpaper gallery to the Home screen.
–
194
–
–
–
Lock screen Wallpaper: assigns an image
from either the Wallpaper gallery or Gallery to
the Lock screen.
• Screen timeout: adjusts the delay time before
the screen automatically turns off. Selections
are:
15 seconds, 30 seconds, 1 minute, 2 minutes,
10 minutes, and 30 minutes.
Clock position: assigns the on-screen clock
position to either the top, MIddle or Bottom of
the screen.
• Touch key light duration: to adjust the light
duration of the touch keys..
Event notifications: assigns what type of on-
screen notification you are prompted with.
Choose from either: New messages or New
emails.
• Horizontal calibration: uses the accelerometer
to calibrate the phone when held in a horizontal
position.
• Brightness: adjusts the on-screen brightness
level.
Adjusting Screen Brightness
This feature configures the LCD Brightness
levels.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Display
2. Touch and slide the on-screen slider to
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Brightness
.
• Auto-rotate screen: when enabled, the phone
automatically switches from portrait to landscape
orientation and vice versa. When this setting is
disabled, the phone displays in portrait mode
only.
adjust the level and tap OK
.
Horizontal Calibration
Calibrate your phone by using the built-in
accelerometer.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Display
calibration
➔
and then tap
Horizontal
• Animation: determines whether some or all of
the window elements animate. Selections are:
No animations, Some animations, or All
animations.
(
➔
.
Changing Your Settings
195
2. Place the phone on a level surface and tap
Calibrate. The phone adjusts the level of
the accelerometer. During the calibration
process a green circle appears on-screen
and the center circle adjusts to the center
position.
To activate additional power saving features:
1. Activate Power saving mode.
2. Tap any of the available fields to activate
additional power saving parameters.
Choose from:
• Turn Off Wi-Fi to disable Wi-Fi when it is not
connected to an AP.
Power Saving Mode
• Turn Off Bluetooth to disable Bluetooth when
not in use or actively transmitting data.
• Turn Off GPS to disable the GPS location system
when not in use.
This feature allows you both automatically set
the phone to use a power saving mode and
configure additional power saving options
manually, all in an effort to conserve battery
power.
• Turn off Sync to disable the feature when the
phone is not synchronizing with the server.
• Brightness to enable or disable the adjustment
of screen brightness. This field must be enabled
before being able to adjust the brightness value.
• Brightness to select the brightness percentage
• Screen time-out to adjust the time delay before
the screen turns off.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Power saving mode
.
2. Confirm
appears at the top of the
screen. This indicates the power saving
mode is active.
To automatically enable power saving options:
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Power saving mode
.
2. Tap Use Power saving mode to enable this
feature when the battery level is low.
3. Tap Power saving mode on at to assign the
“battery low” level at which the power
saving mode is activated. It is at this level
that the automatic power saving function
will “kick in”.
• Power saving tips to display additional on-
screen power saving information.
4. Tap OK to store the new battery level.
196
Location and Security
Screen Unlock Pattern
Settings
To secure data and limit phone access, set the
phone to require a screen unlock pattern each
time you turn on the device, or every time the
phone wakes up from sleep mode (when the
screen automatically turns off).
The Location and Security settings allow you to
configure phone location and security settings.
Using Wireless Networks
Before you use applications such as Google
Maps and find your location or search for places
of interest, you must enable the Use wireless
networks option or enable the GPS satellites.
Setting an Unlock Pattern
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Creating a screen unlock pattern increases
security on the phone. When you enable the User
visible pattern field, you will draw an unlock
pattern on the screen whenever you want to
unlock the phone’s buttons or touch screen.
When you activate the User tactile feedback
field, you feel vibration as feedback while
drawing the pattern.
(Settings) ➔ Location and security
.
2. Tap Use wireless networks to enable
location information using the wireless
network.
Enabling the GPS Satellites
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Location and security.
Note: Make sure the Require Pattern field is
2. Tap Use GPS satellites enable the GPS
activated.
satellite.
Enabling the sensor aiding
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Location and security
2. Tap Set screen lock Pattern
3. Read the instructions then tap Next
➔
and then tap
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
.
➔
.
.
4. Review the onscreen animation procedure
for drawing a pattern and tap Next when
you are ready to draw a pattern.
2. Tap Use sensor aiding enhances positioning
and save power while using the sensors.
Changing Your Settings
197
5. Draw your pattern by touching your first
on-screen point. Then, without removing
your finger from the screen, drag your finger
over adjacent points until the gray trace line
overlaps each point and they are
Using Visible a Pattern
When enabled, this feature displays the onscreen
lock grid that is used to unlock the phone.
PIN Lock and Unlock
1. Press
➔
and then tap
highlighted with a green circle.
(
Settings) ➔ Location and security
2. Tap Set screen lock
3. Tap PIN
.
6. When you have connected at least four
dots in a vertical, horizontal or diagonal
direction, lift your finger from the screen
.
.
4. Enter a PIN number using the numeric
keypad and touch Continue to confirm the
password.
and tap Continue
.
7. Confirm the new pattern by redrawing it
and then tapping Confirm. The Unlock
pattern is set.
5. Confirm the PIN by re-entering it and tap
OK to confirm.
Changing the Screen Lock Pattern
Your phone now requires you to enter this
PIN number in order to unlock the phone.
This feature allows you to change the previously
stored unlock pattern and update it if necessary.
This process is similar to changing your
password from time to time.
Password Lock and Unlock
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Location and security
2. Tap Set screen lock
3. Tap Password
.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Location and security
2. Tap Change screen lock
➔
and then tap
.
(
.
.
.
4. Enter a password using the keypad and tap
Continue to confirm the password.
5. Confirm the password by re-entering it and
tap OK to confirm.
3. Retrace your current pattern on the screen.
4. Tap Pattern and repeat steps 3 - 7 from the
previous section.
198
Setting up SIM Card Lock
Prevent another user from using your SIM card to
make unauthorized calls or from accessing
information stored on your SIM card by
Device Administration
Activating this feature allows Google to
administrate your phone in a way similar to IT
security settings on a corporate PC. This would
be beneficial in the case that your phone was
lost or stolen. The phone could be “deactivated”
or “restricted” (through administration) from a
remote location.
protecting the information using a PIN code.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Location and security
2. Tap Set up SIM card lock
3. Tap Lock SIM card, enter your SIM PIN
code, then tap OK
➔
and then tap
(
.
.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Location and security
.
.
2. Tap Select device administrators to begin
configuring this setting.
Note: You must activate Lock SIM card before you
can change your SIM PIN code.
3. Select an administrator device and follow
the prompts.
To change an existing SIM Card PIN:
Credential Storage
1. Tap Change SIM PIN
2. Enter the old SIM PIN code and tap OK
3. Enter the new SIM PIN code and tap OK
.
This option allows certain applications to access
secure certificates and other credentials.
Certificates and credentials can be installed to
the SD card and password protected.
.
.
4. Re-type the new SIM PIN code and tap OK
.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Password Settings
When you create a phone password you can also
configure the phone to display the password as
you type it instead of using an asterisk (*).
(Settings) ➔ Location and security
.
2. Tap Use secure credentials to activate this
feature. A check mark displayed next to
the feature indicates secure credentials is
active.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Location and security
.
3. Tap Install from USB storage to install
encrypted certificates from the USB
Storage location.
2. Tap Visible passwords to activate this
feature.
Changing Your Settings
199
4. Tap Set password to set or change the
credential storage password.
Note: If you are notified that you can not download
a Market application because it comes from
an “Unknown source”, enabling this option
corrects this issue.
5. Tap Clear storage to clear the storage (SD
card or phone memory) of all contents and
reset the credentials password.
Managing Applications
Applications
This feature allows you to manage installed
applications. You can view and control currently
running services, or use the device for
application development.
This phone can be used for Android
development. You can write applications in the
SDK and install them on this device, then run the
applications using the hardware, system, and
network. This feature allows you to configure the
device for development.
You can also view the amount of memory or
resources used as well as the remaining memory
and resources for each of the applications on
your phone and clear the data, cache, or
defaults.
Warning! Android Dev Phones are not intended for
non-developer
end-users. Because the device can be
configured with system software not
provided by or supported by Google or
any other company, end-users operate
these devices at their own risk.
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
Manage
(Settings) ➔ Applications
➔
applications
.
Clearing Application Cache and Data
Important! You must have downloaded
applications installed to use this
feature.
Unknown Sources
Before you can download a web application you
must enable the Unknown sources feature
(enables downloading). Developers can use this
option to install non-Market applications.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Applications
applications
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Manage
1. Press
➔
and then tap
.
(Settings) ➔ Applications
.
2. Tap an application in which to clear the
2. Tap Unknown sources to active this feature.
cache or data.
200
3. Tap Force stop, Clear data, or Clear cache
.
Important! Only certain downloaded applications
are capable of being moved from
phone to card.
Uninstalling Third-party Applications
Important! You must have downloaded
applications installed to use this
feature.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Applications
applications
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Manage
.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Applications
applications
➔
and then tap
2. Tap the Downloaded tab and select your
desired application.
(
➔
Manage
.
3. Tap Move to SD card (from within the
Storage section of the Application info
page).
2. Tap the Downloaded tab and select your
desired application.
3. Tap Uninstall (from within the top area of
the Application info page).
Once the application has been moved to the
microSD card, this button now reads “Move to
phone”.
4. At the prompt, tap OK to uninstall the
application.
Running Services
5. Select a reason for uninstalling the
The Running services option allows you to view
and control currently running services such as
Backup, Google Talk, SNS (messaging), Swype,
and more.
application, then tap OK
.
Moving Third-party Applications to your SD
Card
Your phone’s built in memory is augmented by
using a microSD card to store additional data.
When the phone’s built-in memory capacity is
reached, it can be possible to move some
applications over to the internal microSD card.
Freeing up memory space on the phone can help
avoid any sluggish performance when the phone
has to work harder to manage memory
resources.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Applications
services
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Running
.
The screen displays all the processes that
are running.
2. Tap a process to stop the process from
running.
Changing Your Settings
201
When you stop the process the service or
application will no longer run until you start
the process or application again.
Android Development
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Applications
➔
Development.
Important! Stopping a process might have
undesirable consequences on the
application.
Important! These features are used for
development purposes only.
USB Debugging
This feature is used for development purposes
only.
Memory Usage
This option allows you to view a list of the
memory usage for currently active applications.
Allowing Mock Locations
This feature is used for development purposes
only.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Memory
(Settings) ➔ Applications
➔
usage. The All tab is opened and displays a
list of the current applications.
If you are a developer who is testing a GPS
applications using this device, you can tell the
device that the phone is at different GPS
locations. In other words, the phone is allowed to
“mock” the coordinates.
2. Press
the list from being sorted either
alphabetically or by largest memory usage.
Battery Usage
and then tap Sort to change
This option allows you to view a list of those
components using battery power.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
Battery usage
and then tap Refresh to update
(Settings) ➔ Applications
➔
.
2. Press
the list.
– or –
Tap an entry to view more detailed
information.
202
Synchronizing a Google Account
By default, there are no accounts managed by
the device. These must be manually added.
Accounts and Synchronization
Your phone provides the ability to synchronize
data from a variety of different sources or sites.
These accounts can range from Google, a
Corporate Microsoft Exchange Email Server, and
other social sites such as Facebook, Twitter, and
MySpace. Corporate and Google accounts
provide the ability to synchronize Calendar
events and Contacts.
To manage an existing Google account
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Accounts and sync
2. Tap Add account Google
3. Tap Next Sign in
:
➔
(
.
➔
.
➔
.
To enable the auto-sync feature:
Note: If you do not already have a Google account,
tap Create and follow the on-screen
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Accounts and sync
.
prompts to create your new account.
2. Tap Auto-sync. A green checkmark
indicates the feature is enabled. This
feature enables the synchronization of data
between your phone and external sites or
servers.
4. Touch the Username (@gmail.com) and
Password fields and enter your
information.
5. Tap Sign in. Your phone then
communicates with the Google servers to
confirm your information. Your existing
Gmail account then appears within the
Manage accounts area of the screen.
•
The three main components are Contacts Email,
and Calendar Events. Before these can be
synchronized, they must be added to the
managed accounts list.
•
Any changes or updates to your Gmail account
are then automatically updated to your device.
• Background data: allows your phone to use
data in the background.
Changing Your Settings
203
To configure the Google management settings:
1. Press and then tap
Settings) ➔ Accounts and sync
– or –
Press
➔
➔
and then tap
(
.
(Settings) ➔ Accounts and sync.
2. Tap
within the Google account field to
2. Locate the email account containing the
reveal the account’s synchronization
settings screen.
events you wish to synchronize.
3. Tap
within the adjacent account field
3. Tap the parameters you wish to
to reveal the account’s synchronization
settings screen.
synchronize (Sync Contacts Sync Gmail, or
Sync Calendar). A green checkmark
indicates the feature is enabled.
,
4. Toggle the check mark adjacent to either
the Sync Contacts or Sync Calendar fields to
manually sync the account.
4. Press
screen.
to return to the previous
Motion Settings
This feature allows you to assign specific
functions to certain phone actions that are
detected by both the accelerometer and
gyroscope.
SynchronizingYourCorporateAccount
By default, there are no Corporate Calendar
events managed by the device. These must be
manually added.
To activate motion:
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ Motion
To activate different motion functions:
Activate the motion feature.
➔
and then tap
(
➔
Motion activation.
Note: Once a corporate email account is created,
it is automatically added as a managed
account.
ꢀ
• Turn over to mute activates the mute function
for incoming calls and playing sounds.
• Tutorials provide on-screen visual explanations
of the above features.
Use the following procedure to configure your
phone to synchronize with a corporate email
account.
1. From the Home screen, tap
(
Applications)➔ Settings
sync
204
➔
Accounts and
.
Privacy Settings
Location settings, backup configurations, or
reset the phone to erase all personal data.
Verify your images and videos are on your microSD
card:
1. From the Home screen, tap
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Privacy
.
Mobile Backup and Restore
The phone can be configured to back up your
current settings, application data and settings.
1. Press
(
Applications) ➔
(Gallery).
2. Verify the Gallery contains all of your
pictures and videos.
➔
and then tap
3. Remove the back cover and remove the
internal microSD card prior to initiating a
Kies air update.
(Settings) ➔ Privacy
.
2. Tap Back up my data to create a backup of
your current phone settings and
applications.
Factory Data Reset
From this menu you can reset your phone and
sound settings to the factory default settings.
3. Tap Automatic restore to assist in the re-
installation of a previously installed
application (including preferences and
data).
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Privacy. (You will see a
disclaimer.)
Prior to doing a Factory Reset
Before using Kies air to upgrade your device, it is
recommended that you backup your personal
data prior to use.
2. Tap Factory data reset
➔
Reset phone.
3. If necessary, enter your password and tap
Erase everything
.
The phone resets to the factory default
settings automatically and when finished
displays the Home screen.
To export a Contact list to your microSD card:
1. From the Home screen, tap
(Contacts).
2. Press
and then tap Import/Export
.
Note: Select Format USB storage to also erase all
data on the USB storage.
Changing Your Settings
205
–
–
Use My Location: uses your My Location
information for Google search results and
services.
SD Card & Phone Storage
From this menu you can view the memory
allocation for the memory card as well as mount
or unmount the SD card.
Search on google.com: allows you to use
www.google.com instead of your local domain
(www.google.com).
For more information about mounting or
–
–
Terms of Service: displays the applications’
service terms.
To view the memory allocation for your external SD
card:
Open Source Licenses: displays the
applications’ open source license information.
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Storage.The available
Language&KeyboardSettings
This setting allows you to configure the language
in which to display the menus. You can also set
on-screen keyboard options.
memory displays under the Total space
and Available space headings.
Search Settings
Use Google Search to search the Web.
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
.
(Search).
2. Press
➔
Search settings
.
3. Tap any of the following search parameters
to then alter the settings:
• Google search opens a screen where you can
set your Google search preferences.
–
Clear history: erases the history for recently
selected search results.
–
Show web suggestions: includes search
matches from Google’s online search engine.
206
• Show tips: turns on an on-screen flashing
indicator that provides helpful user information.
Swype Advanced settings
Advanced settings provide access to Swype
operation parameters.
Language Settings
To set the language that the menus display on
the phone:
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
Select language
➔
and then tap
(
➔
• Word suggestion: uses a built-in word database
to predict words while entering text in Swype.
.
2. Select a language and region from the list.
• Auto-spacing: automatically inserts a space
between words. When you finish a word, just lift
your finger or stylus and start the next word.
• Auto-capitalization: automatically capitalizes
the first letter of a sentence.
Select Input Method
There are two input methods available: Swype
and Samsung keypad.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
Select input method
➔
and then tap
(
➔
• Show complete trace: determines whether or
not to display the complete Swype trace path on-
screen.
.
2. Select an input method.
Swype Settings
• Speed vs. accuracy: sets how quickly Swype
responds to on-screen input. Move the slider
between Fast Response (speed) or Error Tolerant
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
Swype
➔
and then tap
(accuracy) and tap OK
.
(
➔
• Personal dictionary: manages your personal
dictionary.
.
2. Tap one of the following Swype
• Reset Swype’s dictionary: deletes all words
you’ve previously entered and added to Swype’s
dictionary.
preferences to activate the setting:
• Language: allows you to select the current text
input language. Default language is US English.
• Audio feedback: turns off sounds generated by
the Swype application.
Changing Your Settings
207
Swype Help settings
Help settings provide access to Swype help
operation parameters.
5. Tap the Keypad sweeping field if you want
to sweep the keypad and change from ABC
6. Tap the Auto-capitalization field to
automatically capitalize the first letter of a
sentence.
• Swypehelp: displays the on-screen Swype User
Manual.
• Tutorial: provides an on-screen tutorial that
shows you how to input text faster in Swype
input mode.
7. Tap Voice input to activate the Voice input
feature. This is an experimental feature
that uses Google’s networked speech
recognition application.
About
Provides information about the current Swype
application version.
Samsung Keyboard Settings
8. Tap Auto-full stop to automatically insert a
full stop by tapping the space bar twice.
9. Tap the Tutorial field to view a short tutorial
on use of the Samsung keyboard.
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Language and keyboard
➔
Samsung keypad
.
2. Tap Portrait keypad types and select a text
XT9 Advanced Settings
input method:
The following XT9 Advanced settings are
available when the XT9 field is selected.
1. Tap the XT9 field to select XT9 (predictive
text) mode, then tap XT9 advanced
•
•
Qwerty Keypad
3x4 Keypad
3. Tap Input languages and select a language.
4. Tap XT9 to use XT9 Predictive text method.
settings
.
2. Tap the Word completion field to enable
word completion. Your phone predicts how
to complete the word typed.
208
3. Tap the Word completion point field then
touch 2 letters 3 letters 4 letters, or the
letters radio button. Word completion
10. To add a new word to the T9 dictionary:
Tap XT9 my words Add word or press
and then tap Add
Enter the new word in the Register to XT9
my words field, then tap Done
,
,
5
➔
.
begins after 2 or more (depending on your
selection).
.
4. Tap the Spell correction field. This option
corrects typographical errors by selecting
from a list of possible words that reflect
the characters of the keys you touched as
well as the characters of nearby keys.
5. Tap the Next word prediction field to enable
word prediction.
11. Tap XT9 auto-substitution to add words to
substitute (for example youve becomes
you’ve). A list of substitutions displays.
12. If you do not see the substitution you want,
press
and then tap Add, then input
the Shortcut word and Substitution word.
13. Tap Done
.
6. Tap the Auto-append field to automatically
add predictions.
Voice Input and Out Settings
Configuring Voice Input Recognition
This feature allows the phone to correctly
recognize verbal input.
7. Tap the Auto-substitution field to
automatically replace words that you are
typing. This option assists with correcting
misspelled words.
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Voice input and output
Voice recognition settings
➔
and then tap
(
➔
8. Tap the Regional correction field. This
option sets the device to automatically
correct mistyped words according to
normal spelling for your region.
.
2. Configure the available options to alter the
settings associated with this feature:
• Language: selects an input language and
associated dialect recognition (if available).
• SafeSearch: sets the explicit image filter
settings. These settings apply to only Google
9. Tap the Recapture field. This option sets
the device to re-display the word
suggestion list when you select the wrong
word from the list.
voice search results. Choose from: Off
,
Moderate, or Strict
.
Changing Your Settings
209
• Block offensive words: allows you to block
recognition of known offensive words or
language. (A green check mark indicates the
feature is active).
• Default engine: sets the speech synthesis
engine that will be used for the spoken text.
Choices include: Pico TTS
.
• Install voice data: confirms the installation of
necessary data required for voice synthesis.
• Speech rate: adjusts the rate at which on-
screen text is spoken by the device. Choose
3. Press
screen.
to return to the previous
Configuring Text-to-speech (Voice
Output)
This feature allows the phone to provide a verbal
readout of on-screen data such as messages
and incoming caller information.
from: Very slow
,
Slow, Normal, Fast, and Very
fast.
• Language: assigns the language used for verbal
readout. Choose from German (Germany),
English (United Kiingdom), English (United
States), Spanish (Spain), French (France), or
Italian (Italy).
1. Press
Settings) ➔ Voice input and output
Text-to-speech settings
➔
and then tap
(
➔
.
2. Configure the available options to alter the
settings associated with this feature:
• Listen to an example: plays a short example of
what the text-to-speech feature sounds like on
your device when activated.
• Samsung TTS: configures the Samsung TTS
settings for various languages.
• Pico TTS: configures the pico TTS settings for
various languages.
Accessibility Settings
• Driving mode: incoming calls and new
notifications are automatically ready out loud.
• Driving mode settings: allows you to select
applications to use TTs while Driving mode is on.
• Always use my settings: accepts an override of
application settings with personal configurations
for this text-to-speech settings screen. If
enabled, your device defaults to using the text-
to-speech feature.
This service lets you enable and disable
downloaded accessibility applications that aid in
navigating your Android device, such as
TalkBack (uses synthesized speech to describe
the results of actions), KickBack (provides haptic
feedback for actions), and SoundBack (plays
sounds for various actions). Also lets you enable
use of the power key to end calls.
210
1. Press
➔
and then tap
5. Tap Set time and use the plus or minus
(
Settings) ➔ Accessibility
.
icons, set Hour, and Minute. Tap PM or AM,
then select Set
.
Note: Initially, it might be necessary to download
accessibility applications from the Android
Market.
•
Optional: Tap Use 24-hour format. If this is not
selected the phone automatically uses a 12-hour
format.
6. Tap Select date format and touch the date
2. Tap Accessibility to activate the feature,
then select the services for which you
want data to log.
format type.
About Phone
This menu contains legal information, system
tutorial information, and other phone information
such as the model number, firmware version,
baseband version, kernel version, and software
build number.
3. Select The power key ends calls field to
activate this feature which ends any
current calls.
Date and Time
This menu allows you to change the current time
and date displayed.
To access phone information:
ꢀ
Press
Settings) ➔ About phone. The following
information displays:
➔
and then tap
1. Press
➔
and then tap
(
(
Settings) ➔ Date and time
.
2. Tap Automatic to allow the network set the
• Status: displays the battery status, the level of
the battery (percentage), the phone number for
this device, the network connection, signal
strength, mobile network type, service state,
roaming status, mobile network state, IMEI
number, IMEI SV, Wi-Fi MAC address, Bluetooth
address, and Up time.
date and time.
Important! Deactivate Automatic to manually set
the rest of the options.
3. Tap Set date and use the plus or minus
icons to set the Month
,
Day, and Year then
touch Set
.
• Battery usage: displays the applications or
services (in percentages) that are using battery
power.
4. Tap Select time zone, then touch a time
zone.
Changing Your Settings
211
• Legal information: This option displays
information about Open source licenses as well
as Google legal information. This information
clearly provides copyright and distribution legal
information and facts as well as Google Terms of
Service, Terms of Service for Android-powered
Phones, and much more pertinent information
as a reference.
Software Update
The Software Update feature enables you to use
your phone to connect to the network and upload
any new phone software directly to your phone.
The phone automatically updates with the latest
available software when you access this option.
ꢀ
Press
➔
and then tap
(Settings) ➔ Software update
.
Read the information and terms, then press
to return to the Settings menu.
The phone automatically updates the
software (if available).
• Model number: displays the phone’s model
number.
• Android version: displays the firmware version
loaded on this handset.
• Baseband version: displays the baseband
version loaded on this handset.
• Kernel version: displays the kernel version
loaded on this handset.
• Build number: displays the software, build
number.
Note: Firmware, baseband, kernel and build
numbers are usually used for updates to the
handset or support. For additional
information please contact your T-Mobile
service representative.
212
Section 13: Health and Safety Information
published have failed to show an association
between exposure to radio frequency from a cell
phone and health problems.
This section outlines the safety precautions
associated with using your phone. The terms
“mobile device” or “cell phone” are used in this
section to refer to your phone. Read this
The low levels of RF cell phones emit while in
use are in the microwave frequency range. They
also emit RF at substantially reduced time
intervals when in the stand-by mode. Whereas
high levels of RF can produce health effects (by
heating tissue), exposure to low level RF that
does not produce heating effects causes no
known adverse health effects.
information before using your mobile device
.
Exposure to Radio Frequency
(RF) Signals
The U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA) has
published information for consumers relating to
Radio Frequency (RF) exposure from wireless
phones. The FDA publication includes the
following information:
The biological effects of radio frequency energy
should not be confused with the effects from
other types of electromagnetic energy.
Do cell phones pose a health hazard?
Many people are concerned that cell phone
radiation will cause cancer or other serious
health hazards. The weight of scientific evidence
has not linked cell phones with any health
problems.
Very high levels of electromagnetic energy, such
as is found in X-rays and gamma rays, can ionize
biological tissues. Ionization is a process where
electrons are stripped away from their normal
locations in atoms and molecules. It can
permanently damage biological tissues including
DNA, the genetic material.
Cell phones emit low levels of Radio Frequency
(RF) energy. Over the past 15 years, scientists
have conducted hundreds of studies looking at
the biological effects of the radio frequency
energy emitted by cell phones. While some
researchers have reported biological changes
associated with RF energy, these studies have
failed to be replicated. The majority of studies
The energy levels associated with radio
frequency energy, including both radio waves
and microwaves, are not great enough to cause
ionization of atoms and molecules. Therefore, RF
energy is a type of non-ionizing radiation. Other
types of non-ionizing radiation include visible
Health and Safety Information
213
light, infrared radiation (heat), and other forms of
electromagnetic radiation with relatively low
frequencies.
usage for more than 5,000 people with brain
tumors (glioma and meningioma) and a similar
number of healthy controls.
While RF energy does not ionize particles, large
amounts can increase body temperatures and
cause tissue damage. Two areas of the body, the
eyes and the testes, are particularly vulnerable to
RF heating because there is relatively little blood
flow in them to carry away excess heat.
Research Results to Date: Is there a
connection between RF and certain health
problems?
The results of most studies conducted to date
say no. In addition, attempts to replicate and
confirm the few studies that have shown a
connection have failed.
Results of this study did NOT show that cell
phones caused brain cancer. In this study, most
people had no increased risk of brain cancer
from using cell phones. For people with the
heaviest use of cell phones (an average of more
than ½ hour per day, every day, for over 10
years) the study suggested a slight increase in
brain cancer. However, the authors determined
that biases and errors prevented any conclusions
being drawn from this data. Additional
information about Interphone can be found at
http://www.iarc.fr/en/media-centre/pr/2010/pdfs/
pr200_E.pdf.
Interphone is the largest cell phone study to
date, but it did not answer all questions about
cell phone safety. Additional research is being
conducted around the world, and the FDA
continues to monitor developments in this field.
InternationalCohortStudyonMobilePhone
Users (COSMOS)
The COSMOS study aims to conduct long-term
health monitoring of a large group of people to
determine if there are any health issues linked to
long-term exposure to radio frequency energy
from cell phone use. The COSMOS study will
follow approximately 300,000 adult cell phone
users in Europe for 20 to 30 years. Additional
The scientific community at large therefore
believes that the weight of scientific evidence
does not show an association between exposure
to Radio Frequency (RF) from cell phones and
adverse health outcomes. Still the scientific
community has supported additional research to
address gaps in knowledge. Some of these
studies are described below.
Interphone Study
Interphone is a large international study
designed to determine whether cell phones
increase the risk of head and neck cancer. A
report published in the International Journal of
Epidemiology (June, 2010) compared cell phone
214
information about the COSMOS study can be
found at
Cell Phone Industry Actions
Although the existing scientific data do not justify
FDA regulatory actions, the FDA has urged the
cell phone industry to take a number of steps,
including the following:
.
RiskofBrainCancerfromExposuretoRadio
Frequency Fields in Childhood and
Adolescence (MOBI-KIDS)
•
Support-needed research on possible biological
effects of RF for the type of signal emitted by cell
phones;
MOBI-KIDS is an international study investigating
the relationship between exposure to radio
frequency energy from communication
technologies including cell phones and brain
cancer in young people. This is an international
multi-center study involving 14 European and
non-European countries. Additional information
about MOBI-KIDS can be found at
•
•
Design cell phones in a way that minimizes any
RF exposure to the user; and
Cooperate in providing users of cell phones with
the current information on cell phone use and
human health concerns.
http://www.creal.cat/programes-recerca/
en_projectes-creal/view.php?ID=39.
The FDA also is working with voluntary standard-
setting bodies such as the Institute of Electrical
and Electronics Engineers (IEEE), the
International Commission on Non-Ionizing
Radiation Protection (ICNIRP), and others to
assure that safety standards continue to
adequately protect the public.
Surveillance, Epidemiology, and End
Results (SEER) Program of the National
Cancer Institute
The National Cancer Institute (NCI) actively
follows cancer statistics in the United States to
detect any change in rates of new cases for
brain cancer. If cell phones play a role in risk for
brain cancer, rates should go up, because heavy
cell phone use has been common for quite some
time in the U.S. Between 1987 and 2005, the
overall age-adjusted incidence of brain cancer
did not increase. Additional information about
SEER can be found at
Reducing Exposure: Hands-Free Kits
and Other Accessories
Steps to Reduce Exposure to Radio
Frequency Energy
If there is a risk from being exposed to radio
frequency energy (RF) from cell phones - and at
this point we do not know that there is - it is
probably very small. But, if you are concerned
.
Health and Safety Information
215
about avoiding even potential risks, you can take
a few simple steps to minimize your RF
exposure.
CellPhoneAccessoriesthatClaimtoShield
the Head from RF Radiation
Because there are no known risks from exposure
to RF emissions from cell phones, there is no
reason to believe that accessories which claim to
shield the head from those emissions reduce
risks. Some products that claim to shield the
user from RF absorption use special phone
cases, while others involve nothing more than a
metallic accessory attached to the phone.
•
Reduce the amount of time spent using your cell
phone;
•
Use speaker mode or a headset to place more
distance between your head and the cell phone.
Hands-Free Kits
Hands-free kits may include audio or Bluetooth®
headsets and various types of body-worn
accessories such as belt-clips and holsters.
Combinations of these can be used to reduce RF
energy absorption from cell phones.
Studies have shown that these products
generally do not work as advertised. Unlike
“hands-free” kits, these so-called “shields” may
interfere with proper operation of the phone. The
phone may be forced to boost its power to
compensate, leading to an increase in RF
absorption.
Headsets can substantially reduce exposure
because the phone is held away from the head in
the user's hand or in approved body-worn
accessories. Cell phones marketed in the U.S.
are required to meet RF exposure compliance
requirements when used against the head and
against the body.
Children and Cell Phones
The scientific evidence does not show a danger
to any users of cell phones from RF exposure,
including children and teenagers. The steps
adults can take to reduce RF exposure apply to
children and teenagers as well.
Because there are no known risks from exposure
to RF emissions from cell phones, there is no
reason to believe that hands-free kits reduce
risks. Hands-free kits can be used for
convenience and comfort. They are also required
by law in many states if you want to use your
phone while driving.
•
•
Reduce the amount of time spent on the cell phone;
Use speaker mode or a headset to place more
distance between the head and the cell phone.
Some groups sponsored by other national
governments have advised that children be
discouraged from using cell phones at all. For
example, The Stewart Report from the United
216
Kingdom made such a recommendation in
December 2000. In this report, a group of
independent experts noted that no evidence
exists that using a cell phone causes brain
tumors or other ill effects. Their recommendation
to limit cell phone use by children was strictly
precautionary; it was not based on scientific
evidence that any health hazard exists.
•
•
Health Protection Agency:
US Food and Drug Administration:
http://www.fda.gov/Radiation-EmittingProducts/
HomeBusinessandEntertainment/CellPhones/
SpecificAbsorptionRate(SAR)
Certification Information
Your wireless phone is a radio transmitter and
receiver. It is designed and manufactured not to
exceed the exposure limits for Radio Frequency
(RF) energy set by the Federal Communications
Commission (FCC) of the U.S. Government.
Additional information on the safety of RF
exposures from various sources can be obtained
from the following organizations (updated 10/1/
2010):
•
•
•
FCC RF Safety Program:
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA):
Occupational Safety and Health Administration
(OSHA):
These FCC RF exposure limits are derived from
the recommendations of two expert
organizations: the National Council on Radiation
Protection and Measurement (NCRP) and the
Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers
(IEEE). In both cases, the recommendations were
developed by scientific and engineering experts
drawn from industry, government, and academia
after extensive reviews of the scientific literature
related to the biological effects of RF energy.
.
(Note: This web address is case sensitive.)
National Institute for Occupational Safety and Health
(NIOSH):
•
•
•
World Health Organization (WHO):
International Commission on Non-Ionizing Radiation
Protection:
The RF exposure limit set by the FCC for wireless
mobile phones employs a unit of measurement
known as the Specific Absorption Rate (SAR).
The SAR is a measure of the rate of absorption of
RF energy by the human body expressed in units
Health and Safety Information
217
of watts per kilogram (W/kg). The FCC requires
wireless phones to comply with a safety limit of
1.6 watts per kilogram (1.6 W/kg).
accessory that contains no metal and that
positions the mobile device a minimum of 1.0
cm from the body.
The FCC SAR limit incorporates a substantial
margin of safety to give additional protection to
the public and to account for any variations in
measurements.
Use of other accessories may not ensure
compliance with FCC RF exposure guidelines.
The FCC has granted an Equipment Authorization
for this mobile phone with all reported SAR levels
evaluated as in compliance with the FCC RF
exposure guidelines. The maximum SAR values
for this model phone as reported to the FCC are:
SAR tests are conducted using standard
operating positions accepted by the FCC with the
phone transmitting at its highest certified power
level in all tested frequency bands. Although the
SAR is determined at the highest certified power
level, the actual SAR level of the phone while
operating can be well below the maximum
reported value. This is because the phone is
designed to operate at multiple power levels so
as to use only the power required to reach the
network. In general, the closer you are to a
wireless base station antenna, the lower the
power output of the phone.
Cellular/PCS WCDMA/GSM/EDGE and AWS WCDMA
•
•
•
•
Head: 0.76 W/Kg.
Body-worn Accessory: 0.86 W/Kg.
Product Specific (Wireless Router): 1.00 W/kg;
Simultaneous Transmission: 1.04 W/kg.
WLAN
•
•
•
•
Head: 0.16 W/Kg.
Body-worn Accessory: 0.18 W/Kg.
Product Specific (Wireless Router): 0.18 W/kg;
Simultaneous Transmission: 1.04 W/kg
Before a new model phone is available for sale to
the public, it must be tested and certified to the
FCC that it does not exceed the SAR limit
established by the FCC. Tests for each model
phone are performed in positions and locations
(e.g. at the ear and worn on the body) as
required by the FCC. For body-worn operation,
this phone has been tested and meets FCC RF
exposure guidelines when used with an
SAR information on this and other model phones
can be accessed online on the FCC's website
To find information that pertains to a particular
model phone, this site uses the phone FCC ID
number which is usually printed somewhere on
the case of the phone. Sometimes it may be
.
necessary to remove the battery pack to find the
number. Once you have the FCC ID number for a
218
particular phone, follow the instructions on the
website and it should provide values for typical
or maximum SAR for a particular phone.
Additional SAR information can also be obtained
at
However, there is no guarantee that interference
will not occur in a particular installation. If this
equipment does cause harmful interference to
radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment off and on,
the user is encouraged to try to correct the
interference by one or more of the following
measures:
.
FCC Part 15 Information to
User
Pursuant to part 15.21 of the FCC Rules, you are
cautioned that changes or modifications not
expressly approved by Samsung could void your
authority to operate the device.
•
•
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the equipment and
receiver.
•
•
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit
different from that to which the receiver is
connected.
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) This device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV
technician for help.
Smart Practices While Driving
On the Road - Off the Phone
The primary responsibility of every driver is the
safe operation of his or her vehicle.
Note: This equipment has been tested and found
to comply with the limits for a Class B digital
device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules.
These limits are designed to provide reasonable
protection against harmful interference in a
residential installation. This equipment
Responsible drivers understand that no
secondary task should be performed while
driving whether it be eating, drinking, talking to
passengers, or talking on a mobile phone -
unless the driver has assessed the driving
conditions and is confident that the secondary
task will not interfere with their primary
generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in
responsibility. Do not engage in any activity while
driving a moving vehicle which may cause you to
accordance with the instructions, may cause
harmful interference to radio communications.
Health and Safety Information
219
take your eyes off the road or become so absorbed
in the activity that your ability to concentrate on
the act of driving becomes impaired. Samsung is
committed to promoting responsible driving and
giving drivers the tools they need to understand
and address distractions.
Notice regarding legal restrictions on mounting
this device in an automobile:
Laws in some states may prohibit mounting this
device on or near the windshield of an
automobile. In other states, the law may permit
mounting this device only in specific locations in
the automobile. Be sure to consult the state and
local laws or ordinances where you drive before
mounting this device in an automobile. Failure to
comply with these restrictions could result in
fines, penalties, or other damages.
Check the laws and regulations on the use of
mobile devices and their accessories in the areas
where you drive. Always obey them. The use of
these devices may be prohibited or restricted in
certain areas. For example, only hands-free use
may be permitted in certain areas.
Never mount this device in a manner that will
obstruct the driver's clear view of the street and
traffic.
Before answering calls, consider your
circumstances. Let the call go to voicemail when
driving conditions require. Remember, driving
comes first, not the call!
Never use wireless data services such as text
messaging, Web browsing, or e-mail while
operating a vehicle.
If you consider a call necessary and appropriate,
follow these tips:
Never watch videos, such as a movie or clip, or
play video games while operating a vehicle.
•
•
•
•
•
Use a hands-free device;
Secure your phone within easy reach;
Place calls when you are not moving;
Plan calls when your car will be stationary;
Do not engage in stressful or emotional
conversations;
For more information, go to http://www.ctia.org
.
Battery Use and Safety
Important! Handle and store batteries properly to
avoid injury or damage. Most battery
issues arise from improper handling of
batteries and, particularly, from the
•
•
Let the person with whom you are speaking know
that you are driving and will suspend the call if
necessary;
continued use of damaged batteries.
Do not take notes or look up phone numbers while
driving;
220
•
•
Do not disassemble, crush, puncture, shred, or
otherwise attempt to change the form of your
battery. Do not put a high degree of pressure on the
battery. This can cause leakage or an internal
short-circuit, resulting in overheating.
•
•
Do not handle a damaged or leaking battery. Do
not let leaking battery fluid come in contact with
your eyes, skin or clothing. For safe disposal
options, contact your nearest Samsung-authorized
service center.
Do not let the phone or battery come in contact
with liquids. Liquids can get into the phone's
circuits, leading to corrosion. Even when the phone
appears to be dry and appears to operate normally,
the circuitry could slowly corrode and pose a safety
hazard. If the phone and/or battery get wet, have
them checked by your service provider or contact
Samsung, even if they appear to be working
properly.
Avoid dropping the cell phone. Dropping the
phone or the battery, especially on a hard surface,
can potentially cause damage to the phone and
battery. If you suspect damage to the phone or
battery, take it to a service center for inspection.
Never use any charger or battery that is
•
•
damaged in any way
.
Do not allow the battery to touch metal objects
.
Accidental short-circuiting can occur when a
metallic object (coin, key, jewelry, clip, or pen)
causes a direct connection between the + and -
terminals of the battery (metal strips on the battery),
for example when you carry a spare battery in a
pocket or bag. Short-circuiting the terminals may
damage the battery or the object causing the short-
circuiting.
•
•
Do not place your battery in or near a heat
source. Excessive heating can damage the phone
or the battery and could cause the phone or the
battery to explode. Do not dry a wet or damp battery
with an appliance or heat source such as a
microwave oven, hair dryer, iron, or radiator. Avoid
leaving your phone in your car in high temperatures.
Do not dispose of the phone or the battery in a
fire. The phone or the battery may explode when
overheated.
Important! Use only Samsung-approved batteries,
and recharge your battery only with
Samsung-approved chargers which
are specifically designed for your
phone.
Health and Safety Information
221
WARNING!
Proper disposal of your mobile device and its
battery is not only important for safety, it benefits
the environment. Batteries must be recycled or
disposed of properly.
Use of a non-Samsung-approved battery or
charger may present a risk of fire, explosion,
leakage, or other hazard. Samsung's warranty
does not cover damage to the phone caused by
non-Samsung-approved batteries and/or
chargers.
Recycling programs for your mobile device,
batteries, and accessories may not be available
in your area.
•
Do not use incompatible cell phone batteries
and chargers. Some websites and second-hand
dealers not associated with reputable
We've made it easy for you to recycle your old
Samsung mobile device by working with
respected take-back companies in every state in
the country.
manufacturers and carriers, might be selling
incompatible or even counterfeit batteries and
chargers. Consumers should purchase
Drop It Off
You can drop off your Samsung-branded
mobile device and batteries for recycling at
one of our numerous Samsung Recycling
Direct (SM) locations. A list of these locations
may be found at:
manufacturer or carrier-recommended products and
accessories. If unsure about whether a replacement
battery or charger is compatible, contact the
manufacturer of the battery or charger.
•
Misuse or use of incompatible phones, batteries,
and charging devices could result in damage to
the equipment and a possible risk of fire,
explosion, or leakage, leading to serious
injuries, damages to your phone, or other
.
Samsung-branded devices and batteries will
be accepted at these locations for no fee.
Consumers may also recycle their used
mobile device or batteries at many retail or
carrier-provided locations where mobile
devices and batteries are sold. Additional
information regarding specific locations may
be found at:
serious hazard
.
Samsung Mobile Products and
Recycling
Samsung cares for the environment and
encourages its customers to recycle Samsung
mobile devices and genuine Samsung
accessories.
222
UL Certified Travel Charger
.
The Travel Charger for this phone has met
applicable UL safety requirements. Please
adhere to the following safety instructions per UL
guidelines:
Mail It In
The Samsung Mobile Take-Back Program will
provide Samsung customers with a free
recycling mailing label. Just go to
citizenship/
FAILURE TO FOLLOW THE INSTRUCTIONS
OUTLINED MAY LEAD TO SERIOUS PERSONAL
INJURY AND POSSIBLE PROPERTY DAMAGE.
usactivities_environment_samsungrecyclingdirect
follow the instructions to print out a free
pre-paid postage label and then send your
old mobile device or battery to the address
listed, via U.S. Mail, for recycling.
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS - SAVE
THESE INSTRUCTIONS.
DANGER - TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, CAREFULLY
FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS.
Dispose of unwanted electronics through an
approved recycler.
FOR CONNECTION TO A SUPPLY NOT
IN NORTH AMERICA, USE AN
ATTACHMENT PLUG ADAPTOR OF THE
PROPER CONFIGURATION FOR THE
POWER OUTLET.
To find the nearest recycling location, go to
our website:
Or call, (877) 278-0799.
THIS POWER UNIT IS INTENDED TO
BE CORRECTLY ORIENTED IN A
VERTICAL OR HORIZONTAL OR FLOOR
MOUNT POSITION.
Followlocalregulationsregardingdisposal
of mobile devices and batteries
Dispose of your mobile device and batteries in
accordance with local regulations. In some
areas, the disposal of these items in household
or business trash may be prohibited. Help us
protect the environment - recycle!
Display / Touch-Screen
Please note the following information when
using your mobile device:
Warning! Never dispose of batteries in a fire
because they may explode.
Health and Safety Information
223
WARNING REGARDING DISPLAY
Plan (FRP). Changes may affect the performance
of location-based technology on your mobile
device.
The display on your mobile device is made
of glass or acrylic and could break if your
mobile device is dropped or if it receives
significant impact. Do not use if screen is
broken or cracked as this could cause
injury to you.
Certain Samsung mobile devices can also use an
Assisted Global Positioning System (AGPS),
which obtains information from the cellular
network to improve GPS performance. AGPS
uses your wireless service provider's network
and therefore airtime, data charges, and/or
additional charges may apply in accordance with
your service plan. Contact your wireless service
provider for details.
WARRANTY DISCLAIMER: PROPER USE OF A
TOUCH-SCREEN MOBILE DEVICE
If your mobile device has a touch-screen
display, please note that a touch-screen
responds best to a light touch from the pad
of your finger or a non-metallic stylus.
Using excessive force or a metallic object
when pressing on the touch-screen may
damage the tempered glass surface and
void the warranty. For more information,
please refer to the “Standard Limited
Warranty”.
Your Location
Location-based information includes information
that can be used to determine the approximate
location of a mobile device. Mobile devices
which are connected to a wireless network
transmit location-based information. Additionally,
if you use applications that require location-
based information (e.g. driving directions), such
applications transmit location-based information.
The location-based information may be shared
with third-parties, including your wireless
service provider, applications providers,
Samsung, and other third-parties providing
services.
GPS & AGPS
Certain Samsung mobile devices can use a
Global Positioning System (GPS) signal for
location-based applications. A GPS uses
satellites controlled by the U.S. Government that
are subject to changes implemented in
accordance with the Department of Defense
policy and the 2008 Federal Radio navigation
224
Use of AGPS in Emergency Calls
user-programmed functions, which cannot
guarantee connection in all conditions, areas, or
circumstances.
When you make an emergency call, the cellular
network may activate AGPS technology in your
mobile device to tell the emergency responders
your approximate location.
Therefore, you should never rely solely on any
wireless mobile device for essential
communications (medical emergencies, for
example). Before traveling in remote or
AGPS has limitations and might not work in your
area. Therefore:
underdeveloped areas, plan an alternate method
of contacting emergency services personnel.
Remember, to make or receive any calls, the
mobile device must be switched on and in a
service area with adequate signal strength.
•
Always tell the emergency responder your location
to the best of your ability; and
•
Remain on the mobile device for as long as the
emergency responder instructs you.
Navigation
Emergency calls may not be possible on all
wireless mobile device networks or when certain
network services and/or mobile device features
are in use. Check with local service providers.
Maps, directions, and other navigation-data,
including data relating to your current location,
may contain inaccurate or incomplete data, and
circumstances can and do change over time. In
some areas, complete information may not be
available. Therefore, you should always visually
confirm that the navigational instructions are
consistent with what you see before following
them. All users should pay attention to road
conditions, closures, traffic, and all other factors
that may impact safe driving or walking. Always
To make an emergency call:
1. If the mobile device is not on, switch it on.
2. From the Home screen, tap
. Enter
the emergency number for your present
location (for example, 911 or other official
emergency number), then tap
.
Emergency numbers vary by location.
obey posted road signs
.
If certain features are in use (call blocking, for
example), you may first need to deactivate those
features before you can make an emergency
call. Consult your User Manual and your local
cellular service provider. When making an
emergency call, remember to give all the
Emergency Calls
This mobile device, like any wireless mobile
device, operates using radio signals, wireless
and landline networks, as well as
necessary information as accurately as possible.
Health and Safety Information
225
Remember that your mobile device may be the
only means of communication at the scene of an
accident; do not cut off the call until given
permission to do so.
Dust and dirt
Do not expose your mobile device to dust,
dirt, or sand.
Cleaning solutions
Care and Maintenance
Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning
solvents, or strong detergents to clean the
mobile device. Wipe it with a soft cloth
slightly dampened in a mild soap-and-water
solution.
Your mobile device is a product of superior
design and craftsmanship and should be treated
with care. The suggestions below will help you
fulfill any warranty obligations and allow you to
enjoy this product for many years:
Shock or vibration
Keep your Samsung Mobile Device away from:
Liquids of any kind
Do not drop, knock, or shake the mobile
device. Rough handling can break internal
circuit boards.
Keep the mobile device dry. Precipitation,
humidity, and liquids contain minerals that
will corrode electronic circuits. If the mobile
device does get wet, do not accelerate drying
with the use of an oven, microwave, or dryer,
because this may damage the mobile device
and could cause a fire or explosion.
Paint
Do not paint the mobile device. Paint can clog
the device’s moving parts or ventilation
openings and prevent proper operation.
Responsible Listening
Do not use the mobile device with a wet
hand. Doing so may cause an electric shock
to you or damage to the mobile device.
Caution! Avoid potential hearing loss
.
Damage to hearing occurs when a person is
exposed to loud sounds over time. The risk of
hearing loss increases as sound is played louder
and for longer durations. Prolonged exposure to
loud sounds (including music) is the most
common cause of preventable hearing loss.
Some scientific research suggests that using
portable audio devices, such as portable music
Extreme heat or cold
Avoid temperatures below 0°C / 32°F or
above 45°C / 113°F.
Microwaves
Do not try to dry your mobile device in a
microwave oven. Doing so may cause a fire
or explosion.
226
players and cell phones, at high volume settings
for long durations may lead to permanent
noise-induced hearing loss.
•
•
When using headphones, turn the volume down if
you cannot hear the people speaking near you or if
the person sitting next to you can hear what you are
listening to.
This includes the use of headphones (including
headsets, earbuds, and Bluetooth® or other
wireless devices). Exposure to very loud sound
has also been associated in some studies with
tinnitus (a ringing in the ear), hypersensitivity to
sound, and distorted hearing. Individual
susceptibility to noise-induced hearing loss and
potential hearing problem varies. Additionally,
the amount of sound produced by a portable
audio device varies depending on the nature of
the sound, the device settings, and the
Do not turn the volume up to block out noisy
surroundings. If you choose to listen to your portable
device in a noisy environment, use noise-cancelling
headphones to block out background environmental
noise. By blocking background environment noise,
noise cancelling headphones should allow you to
hear the music at lower volumes than when using
earbuds.
•
•
Limit the amount of time you listen. As the volume
increases, less time is required before you hearing
could be affected.
headphones that are used. As a result, there is
no single volume setting that is appropriate for
everyone or for every combination of sound,
settings, and equipment.
Avoid using headphones after exposure to extremely
loud noises, such as rock concerts, that might cause
temporary hearing loss. Temporary hearing loss
might cause unsafe volumes to sound normal.
Do not listen at any volume that causes you
discomfort. If you experience ringing in your ears,
hear muffled speech, or experience any temporary
hearing difficulty after listening to your portable
audio device, discontinue use and consult your
doctor.
You should follow some common sense
recommendations when using any portable
audio device:
•
•
Always turn the volume down before plugging the
earphones into an audio source.
•
Set the volume in a quiet environment and select
the lowest volume at which you can hear
adequately.
•
Be aware that you can adapt to higher volume
settings over time, not realizing that the higher
volume may be harmful to your hearing.
You can obtain additional information on this
subject from the following sources:
Health and Safety Information
227
Email: cdcinfo@cdc.gov
American Academy of Audiology
Internet:
11730 Plaza American Drive, Suite 300
Reston, VA 20190
http://www.cdc.gov/niosh/topics/noise/
default.html
Voice: (800) 222-2336
Email: info@audiology.org
1-888-232-6348 TTY
Internet:
Operating Environment
Remember to follow any special regulations in
force in any area, and always switch your mobile
device off whenever it is forbidden to use it, or
when it may cause interference or danger. When
connecting the mobile device or any accessory
to another device, read its user's guide for
detailed safety instructions. Do not connect
incompatible products.
National Institute on Deafness and Other
Communication Disorders
National Institutes of Health
31 Center Drive, MSC 2320
Bethesda, MD 20892-2320
Email: nidcdinfo@nih.gov
Using Your Mobile Device Near Other
Electronic Devices
Internet:
Most modern electronic equipment is shielded
from Radio Frequency (RF) signals. However,
certain electronic equipment may not be
shielded against the RF signals from your
wireless mobile device. Consult the
National Institute for Occupational Safety
and Health (NIOSH)
395 E Street, S.W., Suite 9200
Patriots Plaza Building
Washington, DC 20201
manufacturer to discuss alternatives.
Voice: 1-800-35-NIOSH
(1-800-356-4674)
1-800-CDC-INFO (1-800-232-4636)
Outside the U.S. 513-533-8328
Implantable Medical Devices
A minimum separation of six (6) inches should
be maintained between a handheld wireless
mobile device and an implantable medical
device, such as a pacemaker or implantable
cardioverter defibrillator, to avoid potential
interference with the device.
228
Persons who have such devices:
Vehicles
•
Should ALWAYS keep the mobile device more than
six (6) inches from their implantable medical device
when the mobile device is turned ON;
RF signals may affect improperly installed or
inadequately shielded electronic systems in
motor vehicles. Check with the manufacturer or
its representative regarding your vehicle before
using your mobile device in a motor vehicle. You
should also consult the manufacturer of any
equipment that has been added to your vehicle.
Posted Facilities
Switch your mobile device off in any facility
where posted notices require you to do so.
Potentially Explosive Environments
Switch your mobile device off when in any area
with a potentially explosive atmosphere and obey
all signs and instructions. Sparks in such areas
could cause an explosion or fire resulting in
bodily injury or even death. Users are advised to
switch the mobile device off while at a refueling
point (service station).
•
•
•
Should not carry the mobile device in a breast
pocket;
Should use the ear opposite the implantable medical
device to minimize the potential for interference;
Should turn the mobile device OFF immediately if
there is any reason to suspect that interference is
taking place;
•
Should read and follow the directions from the
manufacturer of your implantable medical device. If
you have any questions about using your wireless
mobile device with an implantable medical device,
consult your health care provider.
For more information see: http://www.fcc.gov/oet/
.
Users are reminded of the need to observe
restrictions on the use of radio equipment in fuel
depots (fuel storage and distribution areas),
chemical plants, or where blasting operations
are in progress. Areas with a potentially
explosive atmosphere are often, but not always,
clearly marked. They include below deck on
boats, chemical transfer or storage facilities,
vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas (such as
propane or butane), areas where the air contains
chemicals or particles, such as grain, dust, or
Other Medical Devices
If you use any other personal medical devices,
consult the manufacturer of your device to
determine if it is adequately shielded from
external RF energy. Your physician may be able
to assist you in obtaining this information. Switch
your mobile device off in health care facilities
when any regulations posted in these areas
instruct you to do so. Hospitals or health care
facilities may be using equipment that could be
sensitive to external RF energy.
Health and Safety Information
229
metal powders, and any other area where you
would normally be advised to turn off your
vehicle engine.
devices. Not all mobile devices have been rated.
Mobile devices that are rated have the rating on
their box or a label located on the box.
When your Device is Wet
The ratings are not guarantees. Results will vary
depending on the user's hearing device and
hearing loss. If your hearing device happens to
be vulnerable to interference, you may not be
able to use a rated mobile device successfully.
Trying out the mobile device with your hearing
device is the best way to evaluate it for your
personal needs.
Do not turn on your device if it is wet. If your
device is already on, turn it off and remove the
battery immediately (if the device will not turn off
or you cannot remove the battery, leave it as-is).
Then, dry the device with a towel and take it to a
service center.
FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility
(HAC)RegulationsforWireless
Devices
The U.S. Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) has established requirements for digital
wireless mobile devices to be compatible with
hearing aids and other assistive hearing devices.
M-Ratings: Wireless mobile devices rated M3 or
M4 meet FCC requirements and are likely to
generate less interference to hearing devices
than mobile devices that are not labeled. M4 is
the better/higher of the two ratings. M-ratings
refer to enabling acoustic coupling with hearing
aids that do not operate in telecoil mode.
When individuals employing some assistive
hearing devices (hearing aids and cochlear
implants) use wireless mobile devices, they may
detect a buzzing, humming, or whining noise.
Some hearing devices are more immune than
others to this interference noise, and mobile
devices also vary in the amount of interference
they generate.
T-Ratings: Mobile devices rated T3 or T4 meet
FCC requirements and are likely to generate less
interference to hearing devices than mobile
devices that are not labeled. T4 is the better/
higher of the two ratings. T-ratings refer to
enabling inductive coupling with hearing aids
operating in telecoil mode.
Hearing devices may also be rated. Your hearing
aid manufacturer or hearing health professional
may help you find this rating. Higher ratings
mean that the hearing device is relatively
immune to interference noise.
The wireless telephone industry has developed a
rating system for wireless mobile devices to
assist hearing device users find mobile devices
that may be compatible with their hearing
230
Under the current industry standard, American
National Standards Institute (ANSI) C63.19, the
hearing aid and wireless mobile device rating
values are added together to indicate how usable
they are together. For example, if a hearing aid
meets the M2 level rating and the wireless
mobile device meets the M3 level rating, the
sum of the two values equals M5.
The HAC rating and measurement procedure are
described in the American National Standards
Institute (ANSI) C63.19 standard.
HAC for Newer Technologies
This phone has been tested and rated for use
with hearing aids for some of the wireless
technologies that it uses. However, there may be
some newer wireless technologies used in this
phone that have not been tested yet for use with
hearing aids.
Under the standard, this should provide the
hearing aid user with normal use while using the
hearing aid with the particular wireless mobile
device. A sum of 6 or more would indicate
excellent performance.
It is important to try the different features of this
phone thoroughly and in different locations,
using your hearing aid or cochlear implant, to
determine if you hear any interfering noise.
Consult your service provider or the
However, these are not guarantees that all users
will be satisfied. T ratings work similarly.
manufacturer of this phone for information on
hearing aid compatibility. If you have questions
about return or exchange policies, consult your
service provider or phone retailer.
Restricting Children's Access
to Your Mobile Device
M3
+
M2
=
5
Your mobile device is not a toy. Do not allow
children to play with it because they could hurt
themselves and others, damage the mobile
device, or make calls that increase your mobile
device bill.
Keep the mobile device and all its parts and
accessories out of the reach of small children.
T3
+
T2
=
5
Health and Safety Information
231
FCC Notice and Cautions
Other Important Safety
Information
FCC Notice
The mobile device may cause TV or radio
interference if used in close proximity to
receiving equipment. The FCC can require you to
stop using the mobile device if such interference
cannot be eliminated. Vehicles using liquefied
petroleum gas (such as propane or butane) must
comply with the National Fire Protection
Standard (NFPA-58). For a copy of this standard,
contact the National Fire Protection Association.
Cautions
Any changes or modifications to your mobile
device not expressly approved in this document
could void your warranty for this equipment and
void your authority to operate this equipment.
Only use approved batteries, antennas, and
chargers. The use of any unauthorized
•
Only qualified personnel should service the mobile
device or install the mobile device in a vehicle.
Faulty installation or service may be dangerous and
may invalidate any warranty applicable to the
device.
•
•
•
Ensure that any mobile devices or related
equipment installed in your vehicle are securely
mounted.
Check regularly that all wireless mobile device
equipment in your vehicle is mounted and operating
properly.
When using a headset in dry environments, static
electricity can build up in the headset and cause a
small quick static electrical shock. To minimize the
risk of electrostatic discharge from the headset
avoid using the headset in extremely dry
environments or touch a grounded unpainted metal
object to discharge static electricity before inserting
the headset.
accessories may be dangerous and void the
mobile device warranty if said accessories cause
damage or a defect to the mobile device.
Although your mobile device is quite sturdy, it is
a complex piece of equipment and can be
broken. Avoid dropping, hitting, bending, or
sitting on it.
•
Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or
explosive materials in the same compartment as the
mobile device, its parts, or accessories.
232
•
•
For vehicles equipped with an air bag, remember
that an air bag inflates with great force. Do not place
objects, including installed or portable wireless
equipment near or in the area over the air bag or in
the air bag deployment area. If wireless equipment
is improperly installed and the air bag inflates,
serious injury could result.
•
Reduce risk of repetitive motion injuries. When you
repetitively perform actions, such as pressing keys,
drawing characters on a touch screen with your
fingers, or playing games, you may experience
occasional discomfort in your hands, neck,
shoulders, or other parts of your body. When using
your device for extended periods, hold the device
with a relaxed grip, press the keys lightly, and take
frequent breaks. If you continue to have discomfort
during or after such use, stop use and see a
physician.
Switch your mobile device off before boarding an
aircraft. The use of wireless mobile devices in
aircraft is illegal and may be dangerous to the
aircraft's operation. Check with appropriate
authorities before using any function of a mobile
device while on an aircraft.
•
If your device has a camera flash or light, do not use
the flash or light close to the eyes of people or pets.
[122011]
•
•
•
Failure to observe these instructions may lead to the
suspension or denial of cell phone services to the
offender, or legal action, or both.
While using your device, leave some lights on in the
room and do not hold the screen too close to your
eyes.
Seizures or blackouts can occur when you are
exposed to flashing lights while watching videos or
playing games for extended periods. If you feel any
discomfort, stop using the device immediately.
Health and Safety Information
233
Section 14: Warranty Information
damage resulting from excessive force or use of
Standard Limited Warranty
a metallic object when pressing on a touch
screen; (d) equipment that has the serial number
or the enhancement data code removed,
What is covered and for how long?
SAMSUNG TELECOMMUNICATIONS AMERICA,
LLC (“SAMSUNG”) warrants that SAMSUNG’s
handsets and accessories (“Products”) are free
from defects in material and workmanship under
normal use and service for the period
commencing upon the date of purchase by the
first consumer purchaser and continuing for the
following specified period of time after that date:
defaced, damaged, altered or made illegible;
(e) ordinary wear and tear; (f) defects or damage
resulting from the use of Product in conjunction
or connection with accessories, products, or
ancillary/peripheral equipment not furnished or
approved by SAMSUNG; (g) defects or damage
resulting from improper testing, operation,
maintenance, installation, service, or adjustment
not furnished or approved by SAMSUNG;
Phone
1 Year
Batteries
1 Year
(h) defects or damage resulting from external
causes such as collision with an object, fire,
flooding, dirt, windstorm, lightning, earthquake,
exposure to weather conditions, theft, blown
fuse, or improper use of any electrical source;
(i) defects or damage resulting from cellular
signal reception or transmission, or viruses or
other software problems introduced into the
Product; or (j) Product used or purchased outside
the United States. This Limited Warranty covers
batteries only if battery capacity falls below 80%
of rated capacity or the battery leaks, and this
Limited Warranty does not cover any battery if
(i) the battery has been charged by a battery
charger not specified or approved by SAMSUNG
for charging the battery; (ii) any of the seals on
Case/Pouch/Holster
90 Days
Other Phone Accessories 1 Year
What is not covered?
This Limited Warranty is conditioned upon proper
use of the Product.
This Limited Warranty does not cover: (a) defects
or damage resulting from accident, misuse,
abnormal use, abnormal conditions, improper
storage, exposure to liquid, moisture, dampness,
sand or dirt, neglect, or unusual physical,
electrical or electromechanical stress;
(b) scratches, dents and cosmetic damage,
unless caused by SAMSUNG; (c) defects or
234
the battery are broken or show evidence of
tampering; or (iii) the battery has been used in
equipment other than the SAMSUNG phone for
which it is specified.
What must you do to obtain warranty service?
To obtain service under this Limited Warranty,
you must return the Product to an authorized
phone service facility in an adequate container
for shipping, accompanied by the sales receipt or
comparable proof of sale showing the original
date of purchase, the serial number of the
Product and the seller’s name and address.
What are SAMSUNG’s obligations?
During the applicable warranty period, provided
the Product is returned in accordance with the
terms of this Limited Warranty, SAMSUNG will
repair or replace the Product, at SAMSUNG’s sole
option, without charge. SAMSUNG may, at
SAMSUNG’s sole option, use rebuilt,
reconditioned, or new parts or components when
repairing any Product, or may replace the
Product with a rebuilt, reconditioned or new
Product.
To obtain assistance on where to deliver the
Product, please call SAMSUNG Customer Care at
1-888-987-4357. If SAMSUNG determines that
any Product is not covered by this Limited
Warranty, you must pay all parts, shipping, and
labor charges for the repair or return of such
Product.
Repaired/replaced cases, pouches and holsters
will be warranted for a period of ninety (90) days.
All other repaired/replaced Products will be
warranted for a period equal to the remainder of
the original Limited Warranty on the original
Product or for ninety (90) days, whichever is
longer. All replaced Products, parts, components,
boards and equipment shall become the property
of SAMSUNG. Except to any extent expressly
allowed by applicable law, transfer or
You should keep a separate backup copy of any
contents of the Product before delivering the
Product to SAMSUNG for warranty service, as
some or all of the contents may be deleted or
reformatted during the course of warranty
service.
What are the limits on SAMSUNG’s liability?
THIS LIMITED WARRANTY SETS OUT THE FULL
EXTENT OF SAMSUNG’S RESPONSIBILITIES, AND
THE EXCLUSIVE REMEDY REGARDING THE
PRODUCTS.
assignment of this Limited Warranty is
prohibited.
ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT
LIMITATION, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO THE
Warranty Information
235
DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY. IN NO
EVENT SHALL SAMSUNG BE LIABLE FOR
DAMAGES IN EXCESS OF THE PURCHASE PRICE
OF THE PRODUCT OR FOR, WITHOUT
THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT RESTS
SOLELY WITH THE USER AND THE DIRECT
VENDOR, OWNER OR SUPPLIER OF SUCH THIRD-
PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT.
LIMITATION, COMMERCIAL LOSS OF ANY SORT;
LOSS OF USE, TIME, DATA, REPUTATION,
OPPORTUNITY, GOODWILL, PROFITS OR
SAVINGS; INCONVENIENCE; INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR PUNITIVE
DAMAGES; OR DAMAGES ARISING FROM THE
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCT. SOME
STATES AND JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW
LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED
WARRANTY LASTS, OR THE DISCLAIMER OR
LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS AND
DISCLAIMERS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
Nothing in the Product instructions or
information shall be construed to create an
express warranty of any kind with respect to the
Products. No agent, employee, dealer,
representative or reseller is authorized to modify
or extend this Limited Warranty or to make
binding representations or claims, whether in
advertising, presentations or otherwise, on
behalf of SAMSUNG regarding the Products or
this Limited Warranty.
This Limited Warranty gives you specific legal
rights, and you may also have other rights that
vary from state to state.
SAMSUNG MAKES NO WARRANTIES OR
REPRESENTATIONS, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, AS TO THE
QUALITY, CAPABILITIES, OPERATIONS,
PERFORMANCE OR SUITABILITY OF ANY
THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT USED
IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE PRODUCT, OR THE
ABILITY TO INTEGRATE ANY SUCH SOFTWARE OR
EQUIPMENT WITH THE PRODUCT, WHETHER
SUCH THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT
IS INCLUDED WITH THE PRODUCT DISTRIBUTED
BY SAMSUNG OR OTHERWISE. RESPONSIBILITY
FOR THE QUALITY, CAPABILITIES, OPERATIONS,
PERFORMANCE AND SUITABILITY OF ANY SUCH
What is the procedure for resolving disputes?
ALL DISPUTES WITH SAMSUNG ARISING IN ANY
WAY FROM THIS LIMITED WARRANTY OR THE
SALE, CONDITION OR PERFORMANCE OF THE
PRODUCTS SHALL BE RESOLVED EXCLUSIVELY
THROUGH FINAL AND BINDING ARBITRATION,
AND NOT BY A COURT OR JURY.
Any such dispute shall not be combined or
consolidated with a dispute involving any other
person’s or entity’s Product or claim, and
specifically, without limitation of the foregoing,
shall not under any circumstances proceed as
part of a class action. The arbitration shall be
236
conducted before a single arbitrator, whose
award may not exceed, in form or amount, the
relief allowed by the applicable law. The
arbitration shall be conducted according to the
American Arbitration Association (AAA)
Commercial Arbitration Rules applicable to
consumer disputes. This arbitration provision is
entered pursuant to the Federal Arbitration Act.
The laws of the State of Texas, without reference
to its choice of laws principles, shall govern the
interpretation of the Limited Warranty and all
disputes that are subject to this arbitration
provision. The arbitrator shall decide all issues of
interpretation and application of this arbitration
provision and the Limited Warranty.
and expert witness fees, exceed $5,000.00
(“Large Claim”) shall be determined according to
AAA rules. In a Large Claim case, the arbitrator
may grant to the prevailing party, or apportion
among the parties, reasonable attorney fees,
expert witness fees and costs. Judgment may be
entered on the arbitrator’s award in any court of
competent jurisdiction.
This arbitration provision also applies to claims
against SAMSUNG’s employees, representatives
and affiliates if any such claim arises from the
Product’s sale, condition or performance.
You may opt out of this dispute resolution
procedure by providing notice to SAMSUNG no
later than 30 calendar days from the date of the
first consumer purchaser’s purchase of the
Product. To opt out, you must send notice by
e-mail to optout@sta.samsung.com, with the
subject line: “Arbitration Opt Out.” You must
include in the opt out e-mail (a) your name and
address; (b) the date on which the Product was
purchased; (c) the Product model name or model
number; and (d) the IMEI or MEID or Serial
Number, as applicable, if you have it (the IMEI or
MEID or Serial Number can be found (i) on the
Product box; (ii) on the Product information
screen, which can be found under “Settings;”
(iii) on a label on the back of the Product beneath
the battery, if the battery is removable; and (iv) on
the outside of the Product if the battery is not
removable). Alternatively, you may opt out by
For any arbitration in which your total damage
claims, exclusive of attorney fees and expert
witness fees, are $5,000.00 or less (“Small
Claim”), the arbitrator may, if you prevail, award
your reasonable attorney fees, expert witness
fees and costs as part of any award, but may not
grant SAMSUNG its attorney fees, expert witness
fees or costs unless it is determined that the
claim was brought in bad faith. In a Small Claim
case, you shall be required to pay no more than
half of the total administrative, facility and
arbitrator fees, or $50.00 of such fees,
whichever is less, and SAMSUNG shall pay the
remainder of such fees. Administrative, facility
and arbitrator fees for arbitrations in which your
total damage claims, exclusive of attorney fees
Warranty Information
237
calling 1-888-987-4357 no later than 30 calendar
days from the date of the first consumer
Important! Please provide warranty information
(proof of purchase) to Samsung’s
Customer Care Center in order to
provide this service at no charge. If the
warranty has expired on the device,
charges may apply.
purchaser’s purchase of the Product and providing
the same information. These are the only two
forms of notice that will be effective to opt out of
this dispute resolution procedure. Opting out of
this dispute resolution procedure will not affect
the coverage of the Limited Warranty in any way,
and you will continue to enjoy the benefits of the
Limited Warranty.
Samsung Telecommunications America, LLC
1301 E. Lookout Drive
Richardson, Texas 75082
Severability
Phone: 1-800-SAMSUNG
Phone: 1-888-987-HELP (4357)
©2012 Samsung Telecommunications America,
LLC. All rights reserved.
If any portion of this Limited Warranty is held to
be illegal or unenforceable, such partial illegality
or unenforceability shall not affect the
enforceability of the remainder of the Limited
Warranty.
No reproduction in whole or in part allowed
without prior written approval. Specifications and
availability subject to change without notice.
[111611]
Precautions for Transfer and Disposal
If data stored on this device is deleted or
reformatted using the standard methods, the
data only appears to be removed on a superficial
level, and it may be possible for someone to
retrieve and reuse the data by means of special
software.
End User License Agreement
for Software
IMPORTANT. READ CAREFULLY: This End User
License Agreement (“EULA”) is a legal
agreement between you (either an individual or a
single entity) and Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
for software owned by Samsung Electronics Co.,
Ltd. and its affiliated companies and its third
party suppliers and licensors that accompanies
this EULA, which includes computer software
To avoid unintended information leaks and other
problems of this sort, it is recommended that the
device be returned to Samsung’s Customer Care
Center for an Extended File System (EFS) Clear
which will eliminate all user memory and return
all settings to default settings. Please contact the
Samsung Customer Care Center for details.
238
and may include associated media, printed
materials, “online” or electronic documentation
(“Software”).
property laws and treaties. Samsung or its
suppliers own the title, copyright and other
intellectual property rights in the Software. The
Software is licensed, not sold.
BY CLICKING THE “I ACCEPT” BUTTON (OR IF
YOU BYPASS OR OTHERWISE DISABLE THE “I
ACCEPT”, AND STILL INSTALL, COPY,
DOWNLOAD, ACCESS OR OTHERWISE USE THE
SOFTWARE), YOU AGREE TO BE BOUND BY THE
TERMS OF THIS EULA. IF YOU DO NOT ACCEPT
THE TERMS IN THIS EULA, YOU MUST CLICK THE
“DECLINE” BUTTON, AND DISCONTINUE USE OF
THE SOFTWARE.
3. LIMITATIONS ON END USER RIGHTS. You may
not reverse engineer, decompile, disassemble, or
otherwise attempt to discover the source code or
algorithms of, the Software (except and only to
the extent that such activity is expressly
permitted by applicable law not withstanding this
limitation), or modify, or disable any features of,
the Software, or create derivative works based
on the Software. You may not rent, lease, lend,
sublicense or provide commercial hosting
services with the Software.
1. GRANT OF LICENSE. Samsung grants you the
following rights provided that you comply with all
terms and conditions of this EULA: You may
install, use, access, display and run one copy of
the Software on the local hard disk(s) or other
permanent storage media of one computer and
use the Software on a single computer or a
mobile device at a time, and you may not make
the Software available over a network where it
could be used by multiple computers at the
same time. You may make one copy of the
Software in machine-readable form for backup
purposes only; provided that the backup copy
must include all copyright or other proprietary
notices contained on the original.
4. CONSENT TO USE OF DATA. You agree that
Samsung and its affiliates may collect and use
technical information gathered as part of the
product support services related to the Software
provided to you, if any, related to the Software.
Samsung may use this information solely to
improve its products or to provide customized
services or technologies to you and will not
disclose this information in a form that
personally identifies you.
5. UPGRADES. This EULA applies to updates,
supplements and add-on components (if any) of
the Software that Samsung may provide to you
or make available to you after the date you
obtain your initial copy of the Software, unless
we provide other terms along with such upgrade.
2. RESERVATION OF RIGHTS AND OWNERSHIP.
Samsung reserves all rights not expressly
granted to you in this EULA. The Software is
protected by copyright and other intellectual
Warranty Information
239
To use Software identified as an upgrade, you
must first be licensed for the Software identified
by Samsung as eligible for the upgrade. After
upgrading, you may no longer use the Software
that formed the basis for your upgrade eligibility.
termination of this EULA, you must cease all use
of the Software and destroy all copies, full or
partial, of the Software.
9. THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS. Certain
third-party applications may be included with, or
downloaded to this mobile device. SAMSUNG
makes no representations whatsoever about any
of these applications. Since SAMSUNG has no
control over such applications, Purchaser
acknowledges and agrees that SAMSUNG is not
responsible for the availability of such
applications and is not responsible or liable for
any content, advertising, products, services, or
other materials on or available from such
applications. Purchaser expressly acknowledges
and agrees that use of third-party applications is
at Purchaser’s sole risk and that the entire risk of
unsatisfactory quality, performance, accuracy
and effort is with Purchaser. It is up to Purchaser
to take precautions to ensure that whatever
Purchaser selects to use is free of such items as
viruses, worms, Trojan horses, and other items
of a destructive nature. References on this
mobile device to any names, marks, products, or
services of any third-parties are provided solely
as a convenience to Purchaser, and do not
constitute or imply an endorsement,
6. SOFTWARE TRANSFER. You may not transfer
this EULA or the rights to the Software granted
herein to any third party unless it is in connection
with the sale of the mobile device which the
Software accompanied. In such event, the
transfer must include all of the Software
(including all component parts, the media and
printed materials, any upgrades, this EULA) and
you may not retain any copies of the Software.
The transfer may not be an indirect transfer,
such as a consignment. Prior to the transfer, the
end user receiving the Software must agree to all
the EULA terms.
7. EXPORT RESTRICTIONS. You acknowledge
that the Software is subject to export restrictions
of various countries. You agree to comply with all
applicable international and national laws that
apply to the Software, including the U.S. Export
Administration Regulations, as well as end user,
end use, and destination restrictions issued by
U.S. and other governments.
8. TERMINATION. This EULA is effective until
terminated. Your rights under this License will
terminate automatically without notice from
Samsung if you fail to comply with any of the
terms and conditions of this EULA. Upon
sponsorship, or recommendation of, or affiliation
with the third-party or its products and services.
Purchaser agrees that SAMSUNG shall not be
responsible or liable, directly or indirectly, for any
240
damage or loss caused or alleged to caused by,
or in connection with, use of or reliance on any
such third-party content, products, or services
available on or through any such application.
Purchaser acknowledges and agrees that your
use of any third-party application is governed by
such third-party application provider’s Terms of
Use, License Agreement, Privacy Policy, or other
such agreement and that any information or
personal data you provide, whether knowingly or
unknowingly, to such third-party application
provider, will be subject to such third-party
application provider’s privacy policy, if such a
policy exists. SAMSUNG DISCLAIMS ANY
DAMAGE TO YOUR MOBILE DEVICE OR LOSS OF
DATA THAT RESULTS FROM THE DOWNLOADING
OR USE OF SUCH THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS.
SAMSUNG EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY
WARRANTY REGARDING WHETHER
PURCHASER’S PERSONAL INFORMATION IS
CAPTURED BY ANY THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION
PROVIDER OR THE USE TO WHICH SUCH
PERSONAL INFORMATION MAY BE PUT BY SUCH
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER. ANY
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS PROVIDED WITH
THIS MOBILE DEVICE ARE PROVIDED “AS IS”
AND ON AN “AS AVAILABLE” BASIS, WITHOUT
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND FROM SAMSUNG,
EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. TO THE FULLEST
EXTENT POSSIBLE PURSUANT TO APPLICABLE
LAW, SAMSUNG DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
EXPRESS, IMPLIED, OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, SATISFACTORY QUALITY OR
WORKMANLIKE EFFORT, FITNESS FOR A
RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY DISCLOSURE OF
INFORMATION OR ANY OTHER PRACTICES OF
ANY THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER.
10. Disclaimer of Warranty Regarding Third-Party
Applications. SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT
OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS REGARDING
THE AVAILABILITY, USE, TIMELINESS, SECURITY,
VALIDITY, ACCURACY, OR RELIABILITY OF, OR THE
RESULTS OF THE USE OF, OR OTHERWISE
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, RELIABILITY OR
AVAILABILITY, ACCURACY, LACK OF VIRUSES,
QUIET ENJOYMENT, NON-INFRINGEMENT OF
THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR OTHER VIOLATION OF
RIGHTS. SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT
AGAINST INTERFERENCE WITH YOUR
ENJOYMENT OF THE THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION,
THAT THE FUNCTIONS CONTAINED IN THE
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION WILL MEET
RESPECTING, THE CONTENT OF ANY
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION WHETHER SUCH
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION IS INCLUDED WITH
THE PRODUCT DISTRIBUTED BY SAMSUNG, IS
DOWNLOADED, OR OTHERWISE OBTAINED. USE
OF ANY THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION IS DONE AT
PURCHASER’S OWN DISCRETION AND RISK AND
PURCHASER IS SOLELY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY
PURCHASER’S REQUIREMENTS, THAT THE
Warranty Information
241
OPERATION OF THE THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION
WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR-FREE, OR
THAT DEFECTS IN THE THIRD-PARTY
ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO
THE ABOVE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION MAY NOT
APPLY TO YOU. NOT WITHSTANDING THE
APPLICATION WILL BE CORRECTED. PURCHASER
ASSUMES THE ENTIRE COST OF ALL NECESSARY
SERVICING, REPAIR, OR CORRECTION. SOME
JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW EXCLUSIONS OR
LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED
WARRANTY LASTS, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS
OR EXCLUSIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. NO
ADVICE OR INFORMATION, WHETHER ORAL OR
WRITTEN, OBTAINED BY PURCHASER FROM
SAMSUNG SHALL BE DEEMED TO ALTER THIS
DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY REGARDING
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS, OR TO CREATE
ANY WARRANTY.
FOREGOING, SAMSUNG’S TOTAL LIABILITY TO
PURCHASER FOR ALL LOSSES, DAMAGES,
CAUSES OF ACTION, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO THOSE BASED ON CONTRACT, TORT,
OR OTHERWISE, ARISING OUT OF PURCHASER’S
USE OF THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS ON THIS
MOBILE DEVICE, OR ANY OTHER PROVISION OF
THIS EULA, SHALL NOT EXCEED THE AMOUNT
PURCHASER PAID SPECIFICALLY FOR ANY SUCH
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION THAT WAS
INCLUDED WITH THIS MOBILE DEVICE. THE
FOREGOING LIMITATIONS, EXCLUSIONS, AND
DISCLAIMERS (INCLUDING SECTIONS 9, 10, AND
11) SHALL APPLY TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, EVEN IF ANY
REMEDY FAILS ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.
11. Limitation of Liability. SAMSUNG WILL NOT
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OF ANY KIND
ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THE USE OR
THE INABILITY TO USE ANY THIRD-PARTY
APPLICATION, ITS CONTENT OR FUNCTIONALITY,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO DAMAGES
CAUSED BY OR RELATED TO ERRORS,
OMISSIONS, INTERRUPTIONS, DEFECTS, DELAY
IN OPERATION OR TRANSMISSION, COMPUTER
VIRUS, FAILURE TO CONNECT, NETWORK
CHARGES, AND ALL OTHER DIRECT, INDIRECT,
SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
12. U.S. Government End Users Restricted
Rights. The Software is licensed only with
"restricted rights" and as "commercial items"
consisting of "commercial software" and
"commercial software documentation" with only
those rights as are granted to all other end users
pursuant to the terms and conditions herein. All
Software and Products provided to the United
States Government pursuant to solicitations
issued on or after December 1, 1995 is provided
with the commercial rights and restrictions
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES EVEN IF SAMSUNG
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT
242
described elsewhere herein. All Software and
Products provided to the United States
Government pursuant to solicitations issued prior
to December 1, 1995 are provided with
RESTRICTED RIGHTS as provided for in FAR, 48
CFR 52.227-14 (JUNE 1987) or DFAR, 48 CFR
252.227-7013 (OCT 1988), as applicable.
Social Hub
Legal Terms and Privacy
Samsung's Social Hub and (if applicable) the
website where you accessed this Disclaimer
(collectively, the "Service"), is being made
available to you by Samsung Electronics Co.,
Ltd., and its affiliates and suppliers (collectively
"Samsung") subject to the following enclosed
documents:
13. APPLICABLE LAW. This EULA is governed by
the laws of TEXAS, without regard to conflicts of
laws principles. This EULA shall not be governed
by the UN Convention on Contracts for the
International Sale of Goods, the application of
which is expressly excluded. If a dispute,
controversy or difference is not amicably settled,
it shall be finally resolved by arbitration in Seoul,
Korea in accordance with the Arbitration Rules of
the Korean Commercial Arbitration Board. The
award of arbitration shall be final and binding
upon the parties.
•
Social Hub Terms and Conditions which governs
your use of the Service generally;
•
Social Hub End User License Agreement which
specifically governs your use of the software which
forms part of, or enables you to access, the Service;
and
•
Social Hub Privacy Policy which governs our
collection and use of personal information in
connection with your access to and use of the
Service.
14. ENTIRE AGREEMENT; SEVERABILITY. This
EULA is the entire agreement between you and
Samsung relating to the Software and
supersedes all prior or contemporaneous oral or
written communications, proposals and
representations with respect to the Software or
any other subject matter covered by this EULA. If
any provision of this EULA is held to be void,
invalid, unenforceable or illegal, the other
provisions shall continue in full force and effect.
By using the Service, you agree to be bound by
the above documents. Please read through
those documents to make sure you understand
the basis on which Samsung is providing the
Service to you.
You will be able to access additional features
available at socialhub.samsungmobile.com
.
Warranty Information
243
Such Amendments will be effective immediately
and incorporated into the Terms upon sending or
posting of such notice. You are responsible for
regularly reviewing the Terms. Your continued
use of the Service will be deemed to constitute
your acceptance of any and all such
Social Hub Terms and Conditions
Acceptance of the Terms
These Social Hub Terms and Conditions together
with the Social Hub Privacy Policy and Social Hub
End User Licence Agreement (collectively
"Terms") govern your use of Social Hub, which
comprises all content and services accessible
through Social Hub (including third party content
and services), and (if applicable) the website
where you accessed these Terms (collectively
the "Service"). The Terms constitute an
agreement between you and Samsung
Amendments.
Eligibility
To use the Service, you must be at least sixteen
(16) years of age. If you are at least sixteen (16 )
years of age but are a minor for legal purposes
where you live, you must review the Terms and
have your parent or legal guardian accept the
Terms on your behalf in order for you to use the
Service. The person accepting the Terms on your
behalf must be legally competent.
Electronics Co., Ltd., and its affiliates
(collectively "Samsung") with respect to the
Service. By using the Service, you agree to be
legally bound to the Terms.
Your Information
You are not allowed to use the Service if you do
not agree to the Terms. To the extent permitted
by applicable law, Samsung reserves the right to
modify, update, supplement, revise or otherwise
change the Terms, and to impose new or
additional rules, policies, terms or conditions in
relation to the Service, from time to time with or
without notice to you ("Amendments").
When required to provide information in
connection with your use of the Service, you
agree to provide truthful and complete
information. Providing misleading information
about your identity is forbidden. When you first
use the Service, you may be required to create a
username and a password.
Samsung may provide you with notice of the
Amendments by sending an email message to
the email address listed in your account
information (if any), or by posting the notice on
the Social Hub website.
You (and your parent or legal guardian, if you are
a minor) are personally responsible for any use
of the Service with your username and
password.
244
You agree to take due care in protecting your
username and password against misuse by
others and promptly notify Samsung about any
misuse.
if Samsung determines, at its sole discretion,
that you have repeatedly submitted infringing
Materials to the Service.
Using the Service
You agree to:
Termination of Service
Samsung may terminate or restrict your access
to certain parts of the Service if there is an
indication that you have breached the Terms or
at any time in its sole discretion.
•
•
•
Use the Service only for your private,
non-commercial purposes;
Comply with applicable laws, the Terms and good
manners;
Your Material
Not submit unlawful, offensive, abusive,
pornographic, harassing, libelous or other
inappropriate Material;
Except as set forth in the Social Hub Privacy
Policy, Samsung shall not be responsible for any
removal of the information or content you have
submitted in the course of using the Service
("Material") when your access to the Service is
terminated. Your submission of Material in the
course of using the Service does not transfer
ownership rights in the Material to Samsung.
After the Material is removed from the Service by
either you or Samsung, some traces of the
Material may remain and copies of the Material
may still reside within the servers used in
providing the Service. However, Samsung does
not claim ownership in your Material.
•
•
Respect the privacy of others;
Obtain any consents, permission or licenses that
may be required for you to have the legal right to
submit any Material; and
•
Not distribute or post spam, unreasonably large
files, chain letters, pyramid schemes, viruses or any
other technologies that may harm the Service, or
the interest or property of the Service users.
Unauthorized use of the Service (including any
use in contravention of the Terms) is prohibited
and may result in criminal prosecution and/or
civil liability.
You represent and warrant that you have
obtained any consents, permission or licenses
that may be required for you to have the legal
right to submit any Material. Samsung reserves
the right to terminate your access to the Service
Restrictions
You and any third party directed by You must not
display, copy, store, modify, sell, publish or
redistribute the Service (whether all or any
Warranty Information
245
portion of it), and such displaying, copying,
storing, modification, sale, publishing and
redistribution shall be prohibited unless you have
obtained all necessary rights and permissions
from Samsung and the owners and right holders
of such the Service or relevant part.
Actions Required by Law
Samsung may need to comply with lawful
interception and/or data retention requirements
imposed by your country of residence or any
other country in which you use the Service.
Samsung may restrict access to any part of the
Service or terminate your access to the Service,
at any time in its sole discretion if required by
law or by the relevant authorities or regulatory
agencies to do so.
You must not use the Service for any purposes
other than those permitted under the Terms.
Without limiting this restriction, you must not use
the service for any illegal purposes, to make
unsolicited offers or advertisements, to
impersonate or falsely claim affiliation with any
person or entity, to misrepresent, harass,
defraud or defame others, to post obscene or
unreasonably offensive material, to negatively
present the Service, nor for any commercial
purposes.
Third Party Sites and Content
The Service may allow access to sites on the
Internet that are owned or operated by third
parties. Access to such sites does not imply that
Samsung endorses the site or the conduct,
products or services on the site. Upon accessing
any such site, you must review and agree to the
rules of use of the relevant site before using the
site.
Except as expressly permitted by the Terms, and
except to the extent that applicable laws prevent
Samsung from restraining you from doing so,
you are not allowed to disassemble, reverse
engineer, tamper with the Service, transmit
malicious code or collect information of other
users through the Service.
You acknowledge and agree that Samsung has
no control over the content, products or services
of third-party sites and does not assume any
responsibility for or in respect of such content,
products or services. Third party content and
services may be terminated or interrupted at any
time, and Samsung makes no representation or
warranty that any content or service will remain
available for any period of time. Samsung
You may not take any action to interrupt the
functionality of or tamper with the Service or any
content or service contained in or provided
through the Service, or any servers used in
providing the Service, or to unreasonably affect
others' enjoyment of the Service in any way.
246
expressly disclaims any responsibility or liability
for any interruption or suspension of any third
party content or service.
you own initiative and at you own risk, and you
are responsible for complying with all US
federal, state and local laws, rules and
regulations.
In addition, Samsung is neither responsible nor
liable for customer service related to third party
sites. Any question or request for service relating
to third party sites should be made directly to the
relevant site operator.
Dealings with Others
You may interact with other users on or through
the Service. You agree that any such interactions
do not involve Samsung and are solely between
you and the other user(s).
Subscription Information
Use of the Service may involve transmission of
data through your service provider's network.
Your network service provider may charge you
for such data transmission. Samsung assumes
no responsibility for the payment of any such
charges.
Intellectual Property
The Service and related software are protected
under international copyright laws and you are
hereby notified that copyrights are claimed by
Samsung.
Subject to the Terms, Samsung retains all right,
title and interest in the Service and in all
Samsung's products, software and other
properties provided to you or used by you
through the Service.
Availability
The Service may be network dependent -
contact your network service provider for more
information. Samsung reserves the right, in its
sole discretion, to change, improve and correct
the Service. The Service may not be available
during maintenance breaks and other times.
Samsung may also decide to discontinue the
Service or any part thereof in its sole discretion.
In such case you will be provided with prior
notification.
Personal Data
The Social Hub Privacy Policy and the following
additional provisions govern the use of your
personal information. When you access the
Service, Samsung may ask for or otherwise
collect certain personal information such as your
email address along with your user name and
password and, in certain cases, your mobile
phone number so that we can communicate with
you, for example to send notifications of
Samsung does not represent or warrant that the
Service, or any part thereof, is appropriate or
available for use in any particular jurisdiction. If
you choose to access the Service, you do so on
incoming messages. When you use the Service,
Warranty Information
247
certain technical information such as the type
and serial number of your mobile device, Internet
protocol address, your mobile network and
country codes, timezone, technical details of
your client as well as your transactions with
Samsung, for example your acceptance of the
Terms, will be automatically collected by
Samsung.
In connection with certain services accessible
via the Service, Samsung may cooperate with
your operator and other third parties. Samsung
may receive from such third parties certain
device specific non-personal information, such
as device serial number of the devices sold by
the operator with preinstalled software for the
Service. Such information may be used for
aanalyzing the activation of the Service.
The purposes for which Samsung may use such
data are explained in the Social Hub Privacy
Policy. Samsung may also participate with your
selected service providers in maintaining your
contact lists.
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY
THE SERVICE IS PROVIDED ON "AS IS" AND "AS
AVAILABLE" BASIS. TO THE FULLEST EXTENT
PERMITTED BY THE LAW AND SUBJECT TO THE
TERMS, SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT THAT
THE SERVICE WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR
ERROR OR VIRUS-FREE.
The third party services and content you access
through the Service and the telecommunications
carriers and the network through which you
access the Service are provided and hosted by
your selected third party content and service
providers who typically has a privacy policy of its
own. We recommend you familiarize yourself
with your service provider's privacy policy.
Samsung is not responsible for the privacy or
any other practices of such service providers.
Although your messages will be transmitted
through Samsung's servers, Samsung will not
process the content or headers of your
TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY THE
LAW AND SUBJECT TO THE TERMS, NO
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
WARRANTIES OF TITLE OR NON-INFRINGEMENT
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, IS
MADE IN RELATION TO THE AVAILABILITY,
ACCURACY, RELIABILITY, OF THE SERVICE,
INCLUDING ANY INFORMATION OR CONTENT
PROVIDED THROUGH THE SERVICE. YOU
EXPRESSLY AGREE AND ACKNOWLEDGE THAT
THE USE OF THE SERVICE IS AT YOUR SOLE RISK
AND THAT YOU MAY BE EXPOSED TO CONTENT
FROM VARIOUS SOURCES.
messages for any purpose other than as
necessary to deliver and manage your
messages, unless otherwise required by law.
248
SAMSUNG SHALL NOT BE HELD RESPONSIBLE
FOR ANY THIRD PARTY CONTENT OR SERVICE
THAT MAY BE ACCESSED THROUGH THE
SERVICE, NOR SHALL SAMSUNG BE HELD
RESPONSIBLE FOR MALICIOUS CODE
CONTAINED ON OR DISTRIBUTED THROUGH BY
THIRD PARTIES.
APPLY, TO THE EXTENT TO WHICH SAMSUNG IS
ABLE TO DO SO, SAMSUNG LIMITS ITS LIABILITY
UNDER THOSE PROVISIONS TO, AT ITS OPTION,
IN THE CASE OF SERVICES (A) THE SUPPLYING
OF THE SERVICES AGAIN; OR (B) THE PAYMENT
OF THE COST OF HAVING THE SERVICES
SUPPLIED AGAIN AND, IN THE CASE OF GOODS,
(A) THE REPLACEMENT OF THE GOODS OR THE
SUPPLY OF EQUIVALENT GOODS; (B) THE REPAIR
OF THE GOODS; (C) THE PAYMENT OF THE COST
OF REPLACING THE GOODS OR OF ACQUIRING
EQUIVALENT GOODS; OR (D) THE PAYMENT OF
THE COST OF HAVING THE GOODS REPAIRED.
YOU ASSUME FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY
DAMAGES, LOSSES, COSTS, OR HARM ARISING
FROM YOUR USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THE
SERVICE. TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW,
EXCEPT FOR LIABILITY FOR DEATH OR
PERSONAL INJURY CAUSED BY GROSS
NEGLIGENCE OR INTENTIONAL MISCONDUCT,
SAMSUNG DISCLAIMS ALL LIABILITIES WITH
RESPECT TO YOUR USE OF THE SERVICE
(INCLUDING DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
PUNITIVE OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES).
Indemnification
You agree to defend, indemnify and hold
harmless Samsung from and against any and all
third party claims and all liabilities, assessments,
losses, costs or damages resulting from or
arising out of i) your breach of the Terms, ii) your
infringement or violation of any intellectual
property, other rights or privacy of a third party,
iii) misuse of the Service by a third party where
such misuse was made possible due to your
failure to take reasonable measures to protect
your username and password against misuse.
IF THERE IS A CLAIM THAT WE HAVE BREACHED
ANY OF THE PROVISIONS IN THE TERMS, THIS
DOES NOT AFFECT OR INVALIDATE THE OTHER
PROVISIONS.
CERTAIN STATUTORY PROVISIONS UNDER
APPLICABLE LAW MAY IMPLY WARRANTIES OR
CONDITIONS OR IMPOSE OBLIGATIONS UPON
SAMSUNG WHICH CANNOT BE EXCLUDED,
RESTRICTED OR MODIFIED OR CANNOT BE
EXCLUDED, RESTRICTED OR MODIFIED EXCEPT
TO A LIMITED EXTENT. THE TERMS MUST BE
READ SUBJECT TO THESE STATUTORY
Choice of Law
Except where prohibited by applicable law or
provided otherwise herein, the Terms shall be
governed by the laws of the State of New York
without regard to its conflict of law provisions.
PROVISIONS. IF THESE STATUTORY PROVISIONS
Warranty Information
249
You and Samsung agree to submit to the
non-exclusive jurisdiction of the competent
courts in the State of New York to resolve any
legal matters arising from the Terms.
Notwithstanding this, you agree that Samsung
shall still be allowed to apply for injunctive
remedies (or equivalent type of urgent legal
relief) in any jurisdiction.
condition beyond the reasonable control of
Samsung. If there is any conflict between these
Social Hub Terms and Conditions and the Social
Hub Privacy Policy, the provisions of these Social
Hub Terms and Conditions shall prevail. The
provisions of the Terms that are intended to or by
their nature should survive termination of your
use of the Service shall remain valid after any
such termination.
Miscellaneous
Social Hub Privacy Policy
The Terms (including all documents comprising
the Terms) constitute the entire agreement
between you and Samsung, and supersedes any
prior agreement between you and Samsung,
with respect to your use of the Service. Your use
of any third-party content or service accessed
via the Service will be governed by the terms and
conditions furnished with, and applicable to that
content or service. If any provision of the Terms
is held invalid, illegal or unenforceable, that
portion of the Terms shall be construed in a
manner consistent with applicable law to reflect,
as nearly as possible, the original intentions of
the parties, and the remaining portion of the
Terms shall remain in full force and effect.
Samsung's failure to enforce any right or
provision of the Terms will not constitute a
waiver of such provision, or any other provision
of the Terms.
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. ("Samsung") is
committed to protecting the online privacy of
visitors, users and customers to our Social Hub
service. This privacy policy ( "Privacy Policy")
forms part of the Terms which govern your use of
Social Hub(excluding any third party content and
services), and (if applicable) the website where
you accessed this Privacy Policy, (collectively, the
"Service"). The purpose of the Privacy Policy is
to inform you about the types of information we
gather about you when you access or use the
Service, how we may use that information, and if
and how we disclose it to third parties.
All users of the Service are required to provide
true, current, complete and accurate personal
information when prompted and we will reject
and delete any entry that we believe in good faith
to be incorrect, false, falsified, or fraudulent, or
inconsistent with or in violation of the Privacy
Policy.
Samsung will not be liable or responsible for any
failure to fulfill any of its obligations under the
Terms which failure is due to any cause or
250
We will provide you with an opportunity to give
your consent in relation to your use of the
Service. Separate from such consent, your
access or use of the Service will be construed as
your acceptance of the Privacy Policy and of our
collection, use, disclosure, management and
storage of your personal information as
described below. We may, from time to time,
transfer or merge any personal information
collected off-line to our online databases or store
off-line information in an electronic format. We
may also combine personal information we
collect online with information available from
other sources, including information received
from our affiliates, marketing companies, or
advertisers. This Privacy Policy covers all such
personal information and will remain in full force
and effect as long as you are a user of the
Service, even if your use of or participation in
any particular service, feature, function or
promotional activity terminates, expires, ceases,
is suspended or deactivated for any reason.
forms, surveys, and polls. In each such case, you
will know what categories of information we
collect because you will actively provide the
information to us. You may not be able to fully
utilize all of the features or components of the
Service if you choose not to provide certain
information. If you do choose to give us personal
information through the Service, we will collect
and retain that information.
Non-Personal Information
When you use the Service, we may also collect
"non-personal" information. We consider
"non-personal information" to be information
that, by itself, cannot be used to identify or
contact you personally, such as demographic
information (your age, gender, income,
education, profession, zip code, etc.).
Non-personal information may also include
technical information, such as your IP address
and other anonymous data involving your use of
the Service.
Non-personal information may also include
information that you provide us through your use
of the Service, such as the terms you enter into
the search functions of Social Hub, mail inbox
and instant messenger. We reserve the right to
use or disclose non-personal information in any
way we see fit.
INFORMATION THAT WE
COLLECT
Personal Information
We may request that you supply us with
"personal" information, such as your name,
e-mail address, mailing address, home or work
telephone number in the course of you accessing
or using the Service, such as via registration
Warranty Information
251
we believe may be of interest to you. You may
have the opportunity to subscribe to an
USE OF INFORMATION WE
COLLECT
electronic newsletter in which case information
about the Service or our advertisers will be sent
to your e-mail address. We will provide you with
the option to change your preferences and
opt-out of receiving those communications. You
may request at any time that we not e-mail you
in future by clicking the "unsubscribe" link which
is included at the bottom of any e-mail that you
receive from us. If you unsubscribe, we will
make reasonable efforts to discontinue e-mail
communications to you as soon as practicable.
Our Services
We use your personal information to provide you
with any services that you may request or
require, to communicate with you and to allow
you to participate in online surveys. We use
aggregated non-personal information about our
users to understand the demographics of users
of the Service, such as the percentage of male
and female users, the geographic distribution of
our users, the age ranges of our users, a
combination of these and/or other
demographics. We may also use the personal or
non-personal information we collect to analyze
how Service is being used, and to improve the
content of the Service, and for marketing and
promotional efforts.
DISCLOSURE OF
INFORMATION TO THIRD
PARTIES
Aggregate Information
Except as specifically set forth in this Privacy
Policy, we do not share your personal information
with any third party without your permission. We
may disclose aggregate information, such as
demographic information, and our statistical
analyses to third parties, including advertisers or
other business partners. This aggregate
information does not include your personal
information.
E-mail Communications
If you send us an e-mail with questions or
comments, we may use your personal
information to respond to your questions or
comments, and we may save your questions or
comments for future reference. Aside from our
reply to such an e-mail, it is not our standard
practice to send you e-mail unless you request a
particular service that involves e-mail
communications. However, you consent to us
contacting you by e-mail, and sending you
information about products and services which
Service Providers
We sometimes engage unaffiliated businesses to
assist us in providing you certain services. For
example, we may use third parties to provide
252
advertising, marketing and promotional
assistance, provide e-mail services, or facilitate
our online services. In those instances, we may
need to share your personal information with
them.
and using this information, you may visit each
third party advertiser's website directly and
opt-out.
Other Disclosures
We may disclose personal information when we
are required or requested to do so by law, court
order or other government or law enforcement
authority or regulatory agency; to enforce or
apply our rights and agreements; or when we
believe in good faith that disclosing this
information is necessary or advisable, including,
for example, to protect the rights, property, or
safety of the Service and Samsung, our users, or
others.
We require these companies to use your
personal information only to provide the
particular product or service and do not
authorize them to use your personal information
for any other reason. We sometimes offer
promotions in conjunction with a third party
sponsor.
If you choose to participate in those promotions,
we may share your information with the sponsor
if they need it to send you a product or other
special promotion they offer.
CHILDREN
The Service is not designed for use by children
without their parent's supervision. We ask that
anyone under the age of sixteen (16) not submit
any personal information through the Service.
We do not knowingly collect any personal
information from children under the age of
eighteen, and therefore we do not knowingly
distribute such information to third parties.
Third Party Advertisers
We may use third-party advertising companies to
deliver specific advertisements to you. These
companies may collect non-personal information
about your visits to Social Hub in order to provide
advertisements about products and services that
may be of interest to you.
These companies may also aggregate your
non-personal information for use in targeted
advertising, marketing research, and other
similar purposes. These companies may place
their own cookies on your computer. If you want
to prevent a third-party advertiser from collecting
SECURITY OF THE
INFORMATION WE COLLECT
The security of your personal information is
important to us. We maintain physical,
electronic, and procedural safeguards to secure
your personal information. However, there is
always some risk in transmitting information
Warranty Information
253
electronically. The personal information we
collect is stored within databases that we
control.
delete the information from its active database.
We maintain archives for disaster recovery, legal
and other non-marketing purposes.
As we deem appropriate, we use security
measures consistent with industry standards,
such as firewalls and encryption technology, to
protect your information. However, we cannot
guarantee the security of our databases, nor can
we guarantee that information you supply won't
be intercepted while being transmitted to us over
the Internet.
How can I update my profile?
You can help us maintain the accuracy of your
profile by notifying us when you change zip/
postal code, country of residence, age range, or
e-mail address. If at any time you wish to update
your information or stop receiving
communication from us, sign in to the Service
and then select 'update your profile' to change
your preferences.
CHAT ROOMS AND OTHER
PUBLIC AREAS
Our third party service and content providers
may offer chat, user reviews, bulletin boards, or
other public functions and any posting by you is
considered public information available to other
users. Any posting is governed in accordance
with the third party service and content
providers' terms and conditions. You should take
care not to use personal information in your
screen name or other information that might be
publicly available to other users.
CONTESTS AND
SWEEPSTAKES
Registration may be required to enter promotions
such as contests and sweepstakes on Social
Hub. These registration or entry processes may
require your submission of personal information
such as your first and last name, street address,
city, state and zip code, e-mail address,
telephone number and date of birth. The entry
page and/or rules for the promotion will provide
the specific requirements for the promotion. You
may also have the opportunity to opt-in to
special offers from our advertisers in connection
with these promotions.
Archived Information
We maintain archives of web logs, database, and
other systems and information in relation to the
Service. Please note that it is possible some of
this information may remain archived after we
254
ACCURACY OF THE
INFORMATION WE COLLECT
CHANGES TO PRIVACY
POLICY
Any questions you may have regarding this
Privacy Policy, the accuracy of your personal
information or the use of your personal
information, or any requests that we correct,
update, or remove your information in our
databases, should be directed via e-mail to
s.dufresne@Samsung.com, or via regular mail
to:
This Privacy Policy is effective as of May 29,
2010 and complies with Samsung's Corporate
Privacy Policy. We reserve the right to change
this Privacy Policy at any time, and will post any
such changes to this Privacy Policy on the Social
Hub website. Please refer back to the Social Hub
website on a regular basis to obtain the most up
to date Privacy Policy.
Samsung Telecommunications America, LLC
1301 E. Lookout Drive, Richardson, TX 75082
Attn: Customer Support Department
Social Hub End User License
Agreement
1. SOCIAL HUB
After receiving a request to change your
information, we will make reasonable efforts to
ensure that all of your personal information
stored in databases we actively use to operate
the Service will be updated, corrected, changed
or deleted, as appropriate, as soon as reasonably
practicable. However, we reserve the right to
retain in our archival files any information we
remove from or change in our active databases.
We may retain such information to resolve
disputes, troubleshoot problems and enforce our
Terms.
This end user license ("License") allows you to
use Social Hub ("Software") made available on
your mobile device. This License is a legally
binding agreement between you and Samsung
Electronics Co. Ltd. the ("Licensor").
2. LICENSE
2.1 Licensor grants you for the term of this
License a limited, personal, non-exclusive,
non-transferable license to use the Software in
object code executable only form on a single
device for non-commercial uses.
In addition, it is not technologically possible to
remove each and every record of the information
you have provided to us. A copy of your personal
information may exist in a non-erasable form
that will be difficult or impossible for us to locate.
2.2 All rights not expressly granted to you under
this License are reserved to Licensor, and you
agree not to take or permit any action with
respect to the Software that is not expressly
authorised under this License. For the avoidance
Warranty Information
255
of doubt, you have no right to use, incorporate
into other products, copy, modify, translate or
transfer to any third party the Software or any
modification, adaptation or copy of the Software
or any part thereof, nor to decompile, reverse
engineer, or disassemble the binary code of the
Software, either in whole or in part, except as
expressly provided in this License.
4. CONFIDENTIALITY
4.1 The structure, organisation and source code
of the Software are the valuable trade secrets
and proprietary confidential information of
Licensor and its licensors. You agree not to
provide or disclose any such confidential
information in the Software or derived from it to
any third party.
2.3 The Software is licensed to you only. You
may not rent, lease, sub-license, sell, assign,
pledge, transfer or otherwise dispose of the
Software, on a temporary or permanent basis
without the prior written consent of Licensor.
4.2 The provisions of clause 4.1 will not apply to
any information which is:
4.2.1 lawfully obtained free of any duty of
confidentiality (otherwise than directly or
indirectly from Licensor); or
3. OWNERSHIP OF INTELLECTUAL
PROPERTY RIGHTS
3.1 Your only right to use the Software is by
virtue of this License and you acknowledge that
all intellectual property rights in or relating to the
Software and all parts of the Software are and
shall remain the exclusive property of Licensor or
its licensors.
4.2.2 already in your possession, provided that
Licensee can show such possession from written
records (other than as a result of a breach of this
clause 4); or
4.2.3 which you can demonstrate is in the
public domain (other than as a result of a breach
of this clause 4).
4.3 To the extent that any information is
necessarily disclosed pursuant to a statutory or
regulatory obligation or court order, such
disclosure shall not be a breach of this clause 4
provided you do what you can to prevent any
such disclosure.
3.2 You agree that you will not remove or alter
any copyright notices or similar proprietary
devices, including without limitation any
electronic watermarks or other identifiers, that
may be incorporated in the Software or any copy
of the Software.
256
WHICH, BUT FOR SUCH EXCLUSION, WOULD OR
MIGHT SUBSIST IN FAVOUR OF YOU. EXCEPT AS
SET OUT IN THIS LICENSE YOU ASSUME THE
ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
5. WARRANTY AND SUPPORT
The Software is provided "as is" with no
representation, guarantee or warranty of any
kind as to its functionality or that it does not and
will not infringe any third party rights (including
intellectual property rights). Licensor has no
obligation under this License to provide technical
or other support to you.
PERFORMANCE OF THE SOFTWARE.
6.3 SUBJECT TO CLAUSE 6.1 LICENSOR WILL
BE UNDER NO LIABILITY TO YOU WHATSOEVER
(WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE), BREACH OF STATUTORY DUTY,
RESTITUTION OR OTHERWISE) FOR ANY INJURY,
DEATH, DAMAGE OR DIRECT, INDIRECT OR
CONSEQUENTIAL LOSS (ALL THREE OF WHICH
TERMS INCLUDE, WITHOUT LIMITATION, PURE
ECONOMIC LOSS, LOSS OF PROFITS, LOSS OF
BUSINESS, LOSS OF DATA, LOSS OF SAVINGS,
DEPLETION OF GOODWILL AND LIKE LOSS)
HOWSOEVER CAUSED ARISING OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH:
6. LIMITATION AND EXCLUSION OF
LIABILITY
6.1 Licensor does not exclude its liability (if any)
to you:
6.1.1 for personal injury or death resulting from
Licensor's negligence;
6.1.2 for fraud; or
6.1.3 for any matter for which it would be illegal
for Licensor to exclude or to attempt to exclude
its liability.
6.3.1 THE SOFTWARE, OR THE MANUFACTURE
OR SALE OR SUPPLY, OR FAILURE OR DELAY IN
SUPPLY, OF THE SOFTWARE BY LICENSOR OR ON
THE PART OF LICENSOR'S EMPLOYEES, AGENTS
OR SUB-CONTRACTORS;
6.2 LICENSOR MAKES NO EXPRESS
WARRANTIES WITH RESPECT TO THE SOFTWARE
AND LICENSOR HEREBY EXCLUDES (TO THE
FULLEST EXTENT PERMISSIBLE IN LAW), ALL
CONDITIONS, WARRANTIES (INCLUDING
WITHOUT LIMITATION ANY WARRANTY THAT THE
SOFTWARE WILL MEET YOUR REQUIREMENTS
OR THAT ITS OPERATION WILL BE
6.3.2 ANY BREACH BY LICENSOR OF ANY OF
THE EXPRESS OR IMPLIED TERMS OF THIS
LICENSE;
6.3.3 ANY USE MADE OF THE SOFTWARE; OR
UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR FREE) AND
STIPULATIONS, EXPRESS (OTHER THAN THOSE
SET OUT IN THIS LICENSE) OR IMPLIED,
STATUTORY, CUSTOMARY OR OTHERWISE
6.3.4 ANY STATEMENT MADE OR NOT MADE, OR
ADVICE GIVEN OR NOT GIVEN, BY OR ON BEHALF
OF LICENSOR.
Warranty Information
257
6.4 Disclaimer of Certain Damages. IN NO
EVENT SHALL SAMSUNG BE LIABLE TO YOU OR
ANY PARTY RELATED TO YOU FOR ANY INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR PUNITIVE DAMAGES OR LOST
PROFITS, EVEN IF SAMSUNG HAS BEEN ADVISED
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. THIS
LIMITATION WILL APPLY REGARDLESS OF THE
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER FRAUD,
MISREPRESENTATION, BREACH OF CONTRACT,
NEGILIGENCE, PERSONAL INJURY, PRODUCTS
LIABILITY, INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
INFRINGEMENT, OR ANY OTHER THEORY
REGARDLESS OF WHETHER OR NOT SAMSUNG
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES. THIS MEANS THAT YOU WILL
NOT SEEK, AND HEREBY WAIVE, ANY INDIRECT,
SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, TREBLE, OR
PUNITIVE DAMAGES FROM SAMSUNG. THIS
LIMITATION AND WAIVER ALSO APPLIES TO ANY
CLAIMS YOU MAY BRING AGAINST ANY OTHER
PARTY TO THE EXTENT THAT SAMSUNG WOULD
BE REQUIRED TO INDEMNIFY THAT PARTY FOR
SUCH CLAIM.
7. TERM AND TERMINATION
7.1 This License shall commence upon the
earlier of your acceptance of this License or your
activation of the Software and shall continue
until terminated in accordance with clause 7.2 or
otherwise in accordance with this License.
7.2 This License will terminate automatically if
you fail to comply with any term or condition of
this License or if you cease to use the Software
for any reason.
7.3 Upon termination of this License for any
reason whatsoever Licensor retains the right to
permanently disable your access to the
Software.
7.4 The termination of this License howsoever
arising is without prejudice to the rights, duties
and liabilities of either party accrued prior to
termination. Clauses 2.2, 2.3, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7.3, 8,
9 and 10 of this License will continue to be
enforceable notwithstanding termination.
8. GOVERNING LAW AND
JURISDICTION
8.1 The formation, existence, construction,
performance, validity and all aspects whatsoever
of this License or of any term of this License will
be governed by the laws of the State of New
York.
6.5 You acknowledge that the above provisions
of this clause 6 are reasonable for the Software
and you will accept such risk and/or insure
accordingly.
6.6 Any rights that you have as a consumer are
not affected by this clause 6.
258
8.2 The courts in New York City will have non-
exclusive jurisdiction to settle any disputes
which may arise out of or in connection with this
License. The parties irrevocably agree to submit
to that jurisdiction.
10.2 No failure or delay by any party to exercise
any right, power or remedy will operate as a
waiver of it nor will any partial exercise preclude
any further exercise of the same, or of some
other right, power or remedy.
10.3 The parties to this License do not intend
that any of its terms will be enforceable by any
person not a party to it.
9. COMPLIANCE WITH APPLICABLE
LAW
You acknowledge and agree that
10.4 This License contains all the terms which
the parties have agreed in relation to the subject
matter of this License and supersedes any prior
written or oral agreements, representations or
understandings between the parties in relation to
such subject matter.
notwithstanding the fact that this License is
governed by the laws of the Republic of Korea,
you may be subject to additional laws in other
jurisdictions with respect to your use of the
Software. You will comply with the laws of any
jurisdiction that apply to the Software, including
without limitation any applicable export laws or
regulations.
10.5 Licensor reserves the right to revise the
terms of this License by updating the License on
its web site, or by notifying you by post or by
e-mail. You are advised to check the Licensor's
website periodically for notices concerning
revisions. Your continued use of the Software
shall be deemed to constitute acceptance of any
revised terms.
10.GENERAL
10.1 If any clause or part of this License is found
by any court, tribunal, administrative body or
authority of competent jurisdiction to be illegal,
invalid or unenforceable then that provision will,
to the extent required, be severed from this
License and will be ineffective without, as far as
is possible, modifying any other clause or part of
this License and this will not affect any other
provisions of this License which will remain in
full force and effect.
10.6 You will be deemed to have accepted the
terms of this License by using the Software on
any device.
Warranty Information
259
Index
Alarm Tone
Set as 128
Numerics
2G Network
Using 188
3 Sec Pause
Adding 54
3G Network 188
Using 188
411 & More 132
4G Network 188
Using 188
Alerts on Call 190
AllShare
Configuring Settings 133
Receiving Media 133
Transmitting Media 133
Answer Vibration 190
Answering a call 55
Answering Key 190
Application cache and data
Clearing 145
Application Menus
Navigating through 33
Applications 35
411 & More 35
Accounts and Sync 35
AllShare 35
Bejeweled 2 35
Blio 36
A
Accesibility
Activation 70
Accessing
Recently-used applications 34
Voice mail 17
Accounts 132
Accounts and Sync 132
Adding Contacts 92
Add 3 Sec Pause 57
Add to Favorites 97
Adjusting
Call volume 61
Adobe PDF 154
Alarm
Bonus Apps 36
Browser 160
Calendar 36
Clock 37
Contacts 37
Setting 180
Turning Off 181
Downloads 37
260
Files 37
Gallery 37
Google Books 36
Google Search 37
Highlight 38
T-Mobile TV HD 41
Using the Camcorder 121
Using the Camera 115
Video Chat 42
Video Player 159
Videos 42
Visual Voicemail 42
Web 42
Kies air 38
Latitude 38
Lookout Anti-Virus 38
Media Hub 39
Messaging 39
messaging 146
More for Me 39
Music 39
Wi-Fi Calling 42
Zinio Reader 43
Applications and Development 132
Auto Redial 191
Auto Reject
My Device 40
Navigation 40
News & Weather 40
Places 40
Configuration 55
Auto Reject Mode 189
Automatic Answering 190
Auto-sync
Polaris Office 40
Settings 40
Slacker 40
Social Hub 41
Task 41
Task Manager 41
Tetris 42
Enabling 203
B
Back up
My Data 205
Background Color
Text Messages 102
Backup and Restore 205
Battery
T-Mobile Mall 41
T-Mobile Name ID 41
Charging 11
Extending Life 13
261
Installing 11
Low Battery Indicator 13
Removal 11
Saving Power 14
Wall Charger 11
Battery Cover
Sending Contacts Via 171
Sending Namecard 90
Set Visibility 169
Settings 168
Status indicators 168
Switching to Headset during call 62
Turning on and off 168
Visibility 185
Removal 7
Replace 8
Battery Life
Extending 13
Bonus Apps 134
Books 134
Battery Usage 202
Battery Use & Safety 220
Bing
Browser
Adding bookmarks 165
Deleting bookmarks 165
Emptying cookies 165
Entering a URL 163
Navigation 162
Set Search Engine 167
Blio 134
Options 162
Block List 67
Bluetooth 184
Search Engine 167
Settings 166
About 168
Bubble
Activation 184
Options 101
Change Name 169
Deleting a Paired Device 170
Device Name 185
Disable 168
Disconnecting a Paired Device 170
Enable 168
Paring Devices 169
Scan for Devices 169
Scanning for other Devices 185
Sending Contact Information 171
C
Calculator
Scientific Functions 135
Calendar 179
Creating an event 179
Manually Sync Events 136
Settings 179
262
Calibration 195
Call Alert 190
Camcorder 121
Accessing the Video Folder 123
Options 122
Shooting Video 121
Camera 115
Camera Options 116
Options 116
Taking Pictures 115
Care and Maintenance 226
Charging battery 11
Children and Cell Phones 216
Clearing
Application cache and data 145
Configuration
Initial 14
Call Answering/Ending 190
Call Barring 191
Call Forwarding 190
Configuring 190
Call Functions 52
Answering 55
Ending 52
Ending a Call 52
Ending via Status Bar 53
Making a Multi-Party Call 63
Pause Dialing 56
Redialing the last number 57
Wait dialing 57
Call Settings 189
Additional Settings 191
General 189
Connections
Accessing the Internet 162
Contact Entry
Options 87
Call Status Tones 190
Call Volume
Contact List
Options 85
Adjusting 61
Contact Menus
Options 86
Contacts
Caller ID 191
Caller Ringtone
Set as 128
Calls
Adding a Number to Existing 85
Adding Your Facebook Friends 93
Additional Options 94
As a default 89
Making a 52
Multi-party 63
Black List 87
Muting 62
Copying 91
Copying to microSD Card 91
263
Copying to SIM Card 91
Creating a New 80
Default Storage Location 95
Deleting 85
Customizing
Home screens 43
D
Data Roaming 187
Display Options 92
Displaying Contacts by Name 92
Family Name First 92
Filtering 92
Given Name First 92
Groups 95
Joining 88
Activate/Deactivate 187
Deleting
Message Thread 101
Multiple messages 101
Single message 101
Deleting a contact 85
Desk Clock
Configuring 182
Merge with Google 86
New From Keypad 82
Send Namecard Via 87
Sending 90
Sending All 90
Setting Default Location 86
Settings 94
Contacts List 52
Navigation 34
Using 34
Cookies
Display
Icons 23
Settings 23
Status Bar 23
Display / Touch-Screen 223
Displaying your phone number 52
Do cell phones pose a health hazard? 213
Downloading
New application 143
Downloads 136
Internet Downloads 136
Other Downloads 136
E
EDGE Network 188
Email 104
Emptying 165
Corporate Email
Account Syncronization 204
Add Account 204
Creating a Playlist 129
Creating and sending
Messages 98
Composing 106
Configuring Settings 106
Creating an Internet Account 104
Internet Email 104
264
Opening 105
Factory data reset 51
Favorites Tab 97
FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility (HAC)
Regulations for Wireless Devices 230
FCC Notice and Cautions 232
Fixed Dialing Numbers 191
Folder
Opening Internet Email 105
Out of Office Settings 111
Refreshing Messages 105
Sending 94
Emergency Calls 225
Making 53
With SIM 53
Without SIM 53
Creating and Managing 48
Deleting 48
Emoticons 99
Renaming 48
Ending
Font
A call 52
Style 194
Entering Text 69
Font Size
Using SWYPE 70
Caption 160
Erasing files from
Memory card 51
Text Messages 102
Freezing 22
Event Notifications 195
Exchange Email 107
Account Setup 107
Composing 109
Configuring Settings 110
Deleting Message 110
Opening 109
Refreshing Messages 109
Exposure to Radio Frequency (RF) Signals 213
F
Facebook
G
Gallery
Folder Options 119
Image Options 119
Opening 125
Getting Started 6
Battery 11
Battery Cover 7
Locking/Unlocking the Phone 15
microSD card 10
SIM Card 9
Adding Contacts From 93
Video Chat 158
Switching Phone On/Off 15
Voice Mail 17
Factory Data Reset 205
Prior To 205
265
Getting the Fastest Connection 188
Editing a Caller Group 96
Removing an Entry 95
Settings 96
Composing a message 112
Creating and Additional Account 113
Opening 112
GSM 188
H
Health and Safety Information 213
Hearing Aids 190
Highlight
Refreshing 112
Signing In 111
Viewing 112
Google
Settings 138
Account Management Settings 204
Account Syncronization 203
Add Account 203
Adding a Sync Account 203
Create New Account 16
Merge Contacts 86
Hold
Placing a call on hold 62
Home 29
Home Key 28
Home Screen
Overview 29
Retrieving Password 17
Set Search Engine 167
Signing into Your Account 16
Google Books 134
Google mail
see also Gmail 112
Google Maps
Enabling a location source 141
Opening a map 142
Wallpaper 194
Home screens
Customizing 43
Homepage 162
Horizontal Calibration 195
I
Icons
Description 23
Indicator 23
Status 23
GPS & AGPS 224
Groups
Images
Adding an Member to an Existing Group 95
Creating a new caller group 95
Deleting 96
Assigning as a Contact icon 120
Assigning as wallpaper 121
Deleting a Caller Group 96
266
Importing and Exporting
To SIM card 94
Accessing from Notifications 66
Altering Numbers 68
In call
Erasing 68
Incoming Call Volume
Setting 193
Low battery indicator 13
M
Making
Indicator icons 23
International Call 56
International calls
Making 56
Internet 162
Search 163
Internet Call 82
Internet Downloads 136
Internet Email 104
Emergency Calls 53
International calls 56
New call 52
Manage Conference Call 64
Managing Applications 200
Clearing Application Cache 200
Moving Third-party Applications to Card 201
Uninstalling Third-party Applications 201
Market 143
J
Creating a New Account 126
Using 126
Joining
Contact information 88
Media Volume
Setting 193
K
Kies Air
Before Using 172
Kies air 138
L
LinkedIn
Adding Contacts From 93
Live Wallpapers 194
Lock Screen
Memo
Options 146
Memory card
Erasing files from the 51
Memory Usage 202
Merge Calls 63
Merge with Google 86
Message
Viewing Missed Calls 68
Wallpaper 195
Logs 65
Options 99
Read 100
Reply 100
Accessing 65
267
Thread Options 100
Threads 100
Mobile NetworksUse Packet Data 187
Mobile Web 162
Message Search 102
Message threads 100
Messaging
Creating and sending 98
Creating and Sending Text Messages 98
Deleting a message 101
Google Mail 111
Icons on the Status Bar 98
Insert Smiley 99
Options 99
Entering Text in the Mobile Web Browser 163
Navigating with the Mobile Web 162
Using Bookmarks 164
Motion Settings 204
Mounting the SD card 50
Move to SD card 201
Multi-Party Call 63
Dropping One Participant 64
Private conversation 64
Multi-party call
Settings 102
Setting up 63
Signing into Google Mail 111
Text Templates 103
Types of Messages 98
Viewing new 100
microSD Card
Insertion 10
Multi-party calls 63
Music 148
Adding Music 129
Creating a Playlist 129
Editing a Playlist 130
Making a Song a Ringtone 128
Options 128
Removal 10
Player 127
Playing Music 127
Mini Diary
Deleting an entry 147
Options 147
Removing Music 129
Using Playlists 129
Settings 147
Music Files
Missed Call
Removing 130
Viewing from Lock Screen 68
Mobile Networks 187
Data Roaming 187
Transferring 130
My Profile 94
268
Other Downloads 136
Other Important Safety Information 232
Outgoing Call Vibration 190
Outlook 104
Synchronizing 204
Overview
N
Namecard
Send Via 90
Sending 90
Sending All 90
Navigating
Home Screen 29
Application Menus 33
Sub-Menus 34
P
Pause Dialing 56
People
Video Chat 158
Phone
Through Screens 31
Network connection
Adding a new 175
Network Mode
2G Network 188
Icons 23
3G Network 188
Switching on/off 15
Phone number
Finding 52
Phone Options 193
Phone Ringtone 194
Set as 128
New applications
Downloading 143
News & Weather 153
Non-Market Applications 145
Notification Bar 27
Using 27
Photos
Notification Volume
Setting 193
Pico TTS 210
Polaris Office 154
Power Control 14
Power Saving Mode 196
Activate 196
O
On/Off Switch 15
Operating Environment 228
Organizer
Calculator 135
Additional Parameters 196
Setting Launch Levels 196
Power Savings 14
World Clock 181
269
Predictive Text
Using XT9 78
Ringtone
Phone 194
Predictive text
Using XT9 77
S
Samsung Keyboard
Primary Shortcuts 30
Adding and Deleting 44
Proximity Sensor
Activation 190
Settings 208
XT9 Advanced Settings 208
Samsung Keypad 74
ABC Mode 76
Q
Changing the Input Type 75
Enabling 74
Quick Dialing 52
Entering Symbols 77
Symbol/Numeric Mode 76
Samsung Mobile Products and Recycling 222
Save a Number
From Keypad 82
Screen
Home 29
Navigation 31
Screen Lock
Changing 198
R
Recently-used Applications
Accessing 34
Redialing the last number 57
Reducing Exposure
Hands-Free Kits and Other Accessories 215
Reject Call
Rejection Messages 190
Reject Calls
Managing 55
Set Up 197
Screen Rotation
Auto-Rotate 195
Screen Timeout 195
Screens
Adding and Deleting 43
Customizing 43
Rearranging 44
SD card
Connecting to 50
Mounting the 50
Rejection List
Assigning Multiple Numbers 56
Assigning Single Numbers 56
Rejection Messages 190
Reset 205
Device 22
Responsible Listening 226
Restore 205
Restricting Children's Access to Your Mobile
device 231
270
Unmounting 50
Search Engine 167
Select Language 207
Sending a Namecard 90
Set as
Insertion 9
Lock 199
Removal 9
SIM Card Lock
Setting Up 199
Contact icon 119
Smart Practices While Driving 219
Snooze 181
SNS 92
SNS Friends
Viewing 86
Home Screen Wallpaper 119
Lock Screen Wallpaper 119
Setting an alarm 180
Setting up
Voicemail 17
Settings 183
Browser 166
Contact list 94
Social Hub 243
Social Network
Adding Facebook Contacts 93
Resync 93
Display 23
Social Networking
Adding Contacts From 92
Song
Set as 128
Speakerphone
Enabling the GPS Satellites 197
Enabling the sensor aiding 197
Enabling wireless network locations 197
Messaging 102
Mini Diary 147
Setup
Initial 14
Shortcuts
Turning on and off 62
Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) Certification
Information 217
Speed Dial
Adding from Application Screen 45
Adding from Home Screen 46
Deleting from a Screen 46
Managing 45
Primary 30
SIM Card
Changing an entry 58
Making a call 59
Removing an entry 58
Setting up entries 58
Standard Limited Warranty 234
Status Bar 23
Changing Exisitng PIN 199
Importing and Exporting 94
Sub-Menus
Navigation 34
271
Switching to a Bluetooth
During a call 62
SWYPE
T-Mobile Contacts Backup 81
T-Mobile Mall 155
Tools
123ABC Mode 73
Swype
Entering Text 70
Help 208
Camera 115
Transferring Music Files 130
Twitter
Video Chat 158
U
UL Certified Travel Charger 223
Understanding Your Phone 20
Back View 22
Tutorial 208
System Volume
Setting 193
Display 23
T
Task 156
Features 20
Front View 21
Home 29
Uninstalling
Activating 176
Active Icon 176
Disconnecting 176
Text Input
Third-party applications 145
Unknown Sources 145
Unmounting
Methods 69
SD card 50
Text Input Method
Selecting 69
Usage
Battery 202
Text Templates 103
Create Your Own 103
Text-to-speech
Configuration 210
Third-Party Applications 201
Uninstalling 145
Time Management
Calendar 179
Memory 202
USB Connections
As mass storage device 172
USB Settings
As mass storage device 172
272
Use Packet Data 187
Using Favorites
Adding Favorites 165
Deleting a Favorite 165
Editing Favorites 165
W
Wait 57
Wait dialing 57
Wallpapers
Changing 48
Managing 48
Warranty Information 234
WCDMA 188
V
Vibration 193
Web 162
History 166
Setup 193
Web applications
enable downloading 171
Widget
Power Savings 14
Widgets
Video Chat 158
Recording Video 158
Settings 158
Video Conference 113
Videos
Adding and Removing 46
Google Talk 41
Options 118
Voice Input Recognition 209
Voice mail
Accessing 17
Mini Diary 39
Moving to a Different Screen 47
My Account 39
Accessing from another phone 18
Setting up 17
Stopwatch 182
Voice Output
Wi-Fi
Configuring 210
Voicemail 192
Volume Settings
Adjusting 193
VPN
Adding 186
About 174
Advanced settings 175
Connecting to 174
Deactivating 175
Manually Adding Network 184
Manually scan for network 175
Settings 183
Settings 186
273
|
Windmere WCM2025C User Manual
Wadia Digital 581 User Manual
Toshiba W7 User Manual
Seagate ST315005EXM101 RK User Manual
Seagate Constellation ST500NM0001 User Manual
Scotts CD Player SMV300 User Manual
Samsung SGH A767LBAATT User Manual
Pioneer DEH 24UB User Manual
Philips CDR 786 User Manual
Panasonic MN101C00 User Manual